3 \# Source code to NASM documentation
5 \M{category}{Programming}
6 \M{title}{NASM - The Netwide Assembler}
8 \M{author}{The NASM Development Team}
9 \M{license}{All rights reserved. This document is redistributable under the licence given in the file "COPYING" distributed in the NASM archive.}
10 \M{summary}{This file documents NASM, the Netwide Assembler: an assembler targetting the Intel x86 series of processors, with portable source.}
13 \M{infotitle}{The Netwide Assembler for x86}
14 \M{epslogo}{nasmlogo.eps}
20 \IR{-On} \c{-On} option
36 \IR{!=} \c{!=} operator
37 \IR{$, here} \c{$}, Here token
38 \IR{$, prefix} \c{$}, prefix
41 \IR{%%} \c{%%} operator
42 \IR{%+1} \c{%+1} and \c{%-1} syntax
44 \IR{%0} \c{%0} parameter count
46 \IR{&&} \c{&&} operator
48 \IR{..@} \c{..@} symbol prefix
50 \IR{//} \c{//} operator
52 \IR{<<} \c{<<} operator
53 \IR{<=} \c{<=} operator
54 \IR{<>} \c{<>} operator
56 \IR{==} \c{==} operator
58 \IR{>=} \c{>=} operator
59 \IR{>>} \c{>>} operator
60 \IR{?} \c{?} MASM syntax
62 \IR{^^} \c{^^} operator
64 \IR{||} \c{||} operator
66 \IR{%$} \c{%$} and \c{%$$} prefixes
68 \IR{+ opaddition} \c{+} operator, binary
69 \IR{+ opunary} \c{+} operator, unary
70 \IR{+ modifier} \c{+} modifier
71 \IR{- opsubtraction} \c{-} operator, binary
72 \IR{- opunary} \c{-} operator, unary
73 \IR{alignment, in bin sections} alignment, in \c{bin} sections
74 \IR{alignment, in elf sections} alignment, in \c{elf} sections
75 \IR{alignment, in win32 sections} alignment, in \c{win32} sections
76 \IR{alignment, of elf common variables} alignment, of \c{elf} common
78 \IR{alignment, in obj sections} alignment, in \c{obj} sections
79 \IR{a.out, bsd version} \c{a.out}, BSD version
80 \IR{a.out, linux version} \c{a.out}, Linux version
81 \IR{autoconf} Autoconf
83 \IR{bitwise and} bitwise AND
84 \IR{bitwise or} bitwise OR
85 \IR{bitwise xor} bitwise XOR
86 \IR{block ifs} block IFs
87 \IR{borland pascal} Borland, Pascal
88 \IR{borland's win32 compilers} Borland, Win32 compilers
89 \IR{braces, after % sign} braces, after \c{%} sign
91 \IR{c calling convention} C calling convention
92 \IR{c symbol names} C symbol names
93 \IA{critical expressions}{critical expression}
94 \IA{command line}{command-line}
95 \IA{case sensitivity}{case sensitive}
96 \IA{case-sensitive}{case sensitive}
97 \IA{case-insensitive}{case sensitive}
98 \IA{character constants}{character constant}
99 \IR{common object file format} Common Object File Format
100 \IR{common variables, alignment in elf} common variables, alignment
102 \IR{common, elf extensions to} \c{COMMON}, \c{elf} extensions to
103 \IR{common, obj extensions to} \c{COMMON}, \c{obj} extensions to
104 \IR{declaring structure} declaring structures
105 \IR{default-wrt mechanism} default-\c{WRT} mechanism
108 \IR{dll symbols, exporting} DLL symbols, exporting
109 \IR{dll symbols, importing} DLL symbols, importing
111 \IR{dos archive} DOS archive
112 \IR{dos source archive} DOS source archive
113 \IA{effective address}{effective addresses}
114 \IA{effective-address}{effective addresses}
116 \IR{elf, 16-bit code and} ELF, 16-bit code and
117 \IR{elf shared libraries} ELF, shared libraries
118 \IR{executable and linkable format} Executable and Linkable Format
119 \IR{extern, obj extensions to} \c{EXTERN}, \c{obj} extensions to
121 \IR{freelink} FreeLink
122 \IR{functions, c calling convention} functions, C calling convention
123 \IR{functions, pascal calling convention} functions, Pascal calling
125 \IR{global, aoutb extensions to} \c{GLOBAL}, \c{aoutb} extensions to
126 \IR{global, elf extensions to} \c{GLOBAL}, \c{elf} extensions to
127 \IR{global, rdf extensions to} \c{GLOBAL}, \c{rdf} extensions to
129 \IR{got relocations} \c{GOT} relocations
130 \IR{gotoff relocation} \c{GOTOFF} relocations
131 \IR{gotpc relocation} \c{GOTPC} relocations
132 \IR{intel number formats} Intel number formats
133 \IR{linux, elf} Linux, ELF
134 \IR{linux, a.out} Linux, \c{a.out}
135 \IR{linux, as86} Linux, \c{as86}
136 \IR{logical and} logical AND
137 \IR{logical or} logical OR
138 \IR{logical xor} logical XOR
140 \IA{memory reference}{memory references}
142 \IA{misc directory}{misc subdirectory}
143 \IR{misc subdirectory} \c{misc} subdirectory
144 \IR{microsoft omf} Microsoft OMF
145 \IR{mmx registers} MMX registers
146 \IA{modr/m}{modr/m byte}
147 \IR{modr/m byte} ModR/M byte
149 \IR{ms-dos device drivers} MS-DOS device drivers
150 \IR{multipush} \c{multipush} macro
151 \IR{nasm version} NASM version
155 \IR{operating system} operating system
157 \IR{pascal calling convention}Pascal calling convention
158 \IR{passes} passes, assembly
163 \IR{plt} \c{PLT} relocations
164 \IA{pre-defining macros}{pre-define}
165 \IA{preprocessor expressions}{preprocessor, expressions}
166 \IA{preprocessor loops}{preprocessor, loops}
167 \IA{preprocessor variables}{preprocessor, variables}
168 \IA{rdoff subdirectory}{rdoff}
169 \IR{rdoff} \c{rdoff} subdirectory
170 \IR{relocatable dynamic object file format} Relocatable Dynamic
172 \IR{relocations, pic-specific} relocations, PIC-specific
173 \IA{repeating}{repeating code}
174 \IR{section alignment, in elf} section alignment, in \c{elf}
175 \IR{section alignment, in bin} section alignment, in \c{bin}
176 \IR{section alignment, in obj} section alignment, in \c{obj}
177 \IR{section alignment, in win32} section alignment, in \c{win32}
178 \IR{section, elf extensions to} \c{SECTION}, \c{elf} extensions to
179 \IR{section, win32 extensions to} \c{SECTION}, \c{win32} extensions to
180 \IR{segment alignment, in bin} segment alignment, in \c{bin}
181 \IR{segment alignment, in obj} segment alignment, in \c{obj}
182 \IR{segment, obj extensions to} \c{SEGMENT}, \c{elf} extensions to
183 \IR{segment names, borland pascal} segment names, Borland Pascal
184 \IR{shift command} \c{shift} command
186 \IR{sib byte} SIB byte
187 \IR{solaris x86} Solaris x86
188 \IA{standard section names}{standardised section names}
189 \IR{symbols, exporting from dlls} symbols, exporting from DLLs
190 \IR{symbols, importing from dlls} symbols, importing from DLLs
191 \IR{test subdirectory} \c{test} subdirectory
193 \IR{underscore, in c symbols} underscore, in C symbols
195 \IA{sco unix}{unix, sco}
196 \IR{unix, sco} Unix, SCO
197 \IA{unix source archive}{unix, source archive}
198 \IR{unix, source archive} Unix, source archive
199 \IA{unix system v}{unix, system v}
200 \IR{unix, system v} Unix, System V
201 \IR{unixware} UnixWare
203 \IR{version number of nasm} version number of NASM
204 \IR{visual c++} Visual C++
205 \IR{www page} WWW page
208 \IR{windows 95} Windows 95
209 \IR{windows nt} Windows NT
210 \# \IC{program entry point}{entry point, program}
211 \# \IC{program entry point}{start point, program}
212 \# \IC{MS-DOS device drivers}{device drivers, MS-DOS}
213 \# \IC{16-bit mode, versus 32-bit mode}{32-bit mode, versus 16-bit mode}
214 \# \IC{c symbol names}{symbol names, in C}
217 \C{intro} Introduction
219 \H{whatsnasm} What Is NASM?
221 The Netwide Assembler, NASM, is an 80x86 assembler designed for
222 portability and modularity. It supports a range of object file
223 formats, including Linux and \c{NetBSD/FreeBSD} \c{a.out}, \c{ELF},
224 \c{COFF}, Microsoft 16-bit \c{OBJ} and \c{Win32}. It will also output
225 plain binary files. Its syntax is designed to be simple and easy to
226 understand, similar to Intel's but less complex. It supports \c{Pentium},
227 \c{P6}, \c{MMX}, \c{3DNow!}, \c{SSE} and \c{SSE2} opcodes, and has
231 \S{yaasm} Why Yet Another Assembler?
233 The Netwide Assembler grew out of an idea on \i\c{comp.lang.asm.x86}
234 (or possibly \i\c{alt.lang.asm} - I forget which), which was
235 essentially that there didn't seem to be a good \e{free} x86-series
236 assembler around, and that maybe someone ought to write one.
238 \b \i\c{a86} is good, but not free, and in particular you don't get any
239 32-bit capability until you pay. It's DOS only, too.
241 \b \i\c{gas} is free, and ports over DOS and Unix, but it's not
242 very good, since it's designed to be a back end to \i\c{gcc}, which
243 always feeds it correct code. So its error checking is minimal. Also,
244 its syntax is horrible, from the point of view of anyone trying to
245 actually \e{write} anything in it. Plus you can't write 16-bit code in
248 \b \i\c{as86} is Minix- and Linux-specific, and (my version at least)
249 doesn't seem to have much (or any) documentation.
251 \b \i\c{MASM} isn't very good, and it's expensive, and it runs only under
254 \b \i\c{TASM} is better, but still strives for MASM compatibility,
255 which means millions of directives and tons of red tape. And its syntax
256 is essentially MASM's, with the contradictions and quirks that
257 entails (although it sorts out some of those by means of Ideal mode).
258 It's expensive too. And it's DOS-only.
260 So here, for your coding pleasure, is NASM. At present it's
261 still in prototype stage - we don't promise that it can outperform
262 any of these assemblers. But please, \e{please} send us bug reports,
263 fixes, helpful information, and anything else you can get your hands
264 on (and thanks to the many people who've done this already! You all
265 know who you are), and we'll improve it out of all recognition.
269 \S{legal} Licence Conditions
271 Please see the file \c{Licence}, supplied as part of any NASM
272 distribution archive, for the \i{licence} conditions under which you
276 \H{contact} Contact Information
278 The current version of NASM (since about 0.98.08) are maintained by a
279 team of developers, accessible through the \c{nasm-devel} mailing list
280 (see below for the link).
281 If you want to report a bug, please read \k{bugs} first.
283 NASM has a \i{WWW page} at
284 \W{http://www.web-sites.co.uk/nasm}\c{http://www.web-sites.co.uk/nasm},
285 and another, with additional information, at
286 \W{http://nasm.2y.net/}\c{http://nasm.2y.net/}
288 The original authors are \i{e\-mail}able as
289 \W{mailto:jules@dsf.org.uk}\c{jules@dsf.org.uk} and
290 \W{mailto:anakin@pobox.com}\c{anakin@pobox.com}.
291 The latter is no longer involved in the development team.
293 \i{New releases} of NASM are uploaded to the official sites
294 \W{http://www.web-sites.co.uk/nasm}\c{http://www.web-sites.co.uk/nasm}
296 \W{ftp://ftp.kernel.org/pub/software/devel/nasm/}\i\c{ftp.kernel.org}
298 \W{ftp://ibiblio.org/pub/Linux/devel/lang/assemblers/}\i\c{ibiblio.org}.
300 Announcements are posted to
301 \W{news:comp.lang.asm.x86}\i\c{comp.lang.asm.x86},
302 \W{news:alt.lang.asm}\i\c{alt.lang.asm} and
303 \W{news:comp.os.linux.announce}\i\c{comp.os.linux.announce}
305 If you want information about NASM beta releases, and the current
306 development status, please subscribe to the \i\c{nasm-devel} email list
308 \W{http://groups.yahoo.com/group/nasm-devel}\c{http://groups.yahoo.com/group/nasm-devel},
309 \W{http://www.pairlist.net/mailman/listinfo/nasm-devel}\c{http://www.pairlist.net/mailman/listinfo/nasm-devel}
311 \W{http://sourceforge.net/projects/nasm}\c{http://sourceforge.net/projects/nasm}.
313 The preferred list is the list at Sourceforge, which is also the home to
314 the latest nasm source code and releases. The other lists are open, but
315 may not continue to be supported in the long term.
318 \H{install} Installation
320 \S{instdos} \i{Installing} NASM under MS-\i{DOS} or Windows
322 Once you've obtained the \i{DOS archive} for NASM, \i\c{nasmXXX.zip}
323 (where \c{XXX} denotes the version number of NASM contained in the
324 archive), unpack it into its own directory (for example \c{c:\\nasm}).
326 The archive will contain four executable files: the NASM executable
327 files \i\c{nasm.exe} and \i\c{nasmw.exe}, and the NDISASM executable
328 files \i\c{ndisasm.exe} and \i\c{ndisasmw.exe}. In each case, the
329 file whose name ends in \c{w} is a \I{Win32}\c{Win32} executable,
330 designed to run under \I{Windows 95}\c{Windows 95} or \I{Windows NT}
331 \c{Windows NT} Intel, and the other one is a 16-bit \I{DOS}\c{DOS}
334 The only file NASM needs to run is its own executable, so copy
335 (at least) one of \c{nasm.exe} and \c{nasmw.exe} to a directory on
336 your PATH, or alternatively edit \i\c{autoexec.bat} to add the
337 \c{nasm} directory to your \i\c{PATH}. (If you're only installing the
338 \c{Win32} version, you may wish to rename it to \c{nasm.exe}.)
340 That's it - NASM is installed. You don't need the nasm directory
341 to be present to run NASM (unless you've added it to your \c{PATH}),
342 so you can delete it if you need to save space; however, you may
343 want to keep the documentation or test programs.
345 If you've downloaded the \i{DOS source archive}, \i\c{nasmXXXs.zip},
346 the \c{nasm} directory will also contain the full NASM \i{source
347 code}, and a selection of \i{Makefiles} you can (hopefully) use to
348 rebuild your copy of NASM from scratch.
350 Note that the source files \c{insnsa.c}, \c{insnsd.c}, \c{insnsi.h}
351 and \c{insnsn.c} are automatically generated from the master
352 instruction table \c{insns.dat} by a Perl script; the file
353 \c{macros.c} is generated from \c{standard.mac} by another Perl
354 script. Although the NASM 0.98 distribution includes these generated
355 files, you will need to rebuild them (and hence, will need a Perl
356 interpreter) if you change insns.dat, standard.mac or the
357 documentation. It is possible future source distributions may not
358 include these files at all. Ports of \i{Perl} for a variety of
359 platforms, including DOS and Windows, are available from
360 \W{http://www.cpan.org/ports/}\i{www.cpan.org}.
363 \S{instdos} Installing NASM under \i{Unix}
365 Once you've obtained the \i{Unix source archive} for NASM,
366 \i\c{nasm-X.XX.tar.gz} (where \c{X.XX} denotes the version number of
367 NASM contained in the archive), unpack it into a directory such
368 as \c{/usr/local/src}. The archive, when unpacked, will create its
369 own subdirectory \c{nasm-X.XX}.
371 NASM is an \I{Autoconf}\I\c{configure}auto-configuring package: once
372 you've unpacked it, \c{cd} to the directory it's been unpacked into
373 and type \c{./configure}. This shell script will find the best C
374 compiler to use for building NASM and set up \i{Makefiles}
377 Once NASM has auto-configured, you can type \i\c{make} to build the
378 \c{nasm} and \c{ndisasm} binaries, and then \c{make install} to
379 install them in \c{/usr/local/bin} and install the \i{man pages}
380 \i\c{nasm.1} and \i\c{ndisasm.1} in \c{/usr/local/man/man1}.
381 Alternatively, you can give options such as \c{--prefix} to the
382 configure script (see the file \i\c{INSTALL} for more details), or
383 install the programs yourself.
385 NASM also comes with a set of utilities for handling the \c{RDOFF}
386 custom object-file format, which are in the \i\c{rdoff} subdirectory
387 of the NASM archive. You can build these with \c{make rdf} and
388 install them with \c{make rdf_install}, if you want them.
390 If NASM fails to auto-configure, you may still be able to make it
391 compile by using the fall-back Unix makefile \i\c{Makefile.unx}.
392 Copy or rename that file to \c{Makefile} and try typing \c{make}.
393 There is also a Makefile.unx file in the \c{rdoff} subdirectory.
396 \C{running} Running NASM
398 \H{syntax} NASM \i{Command-Line} Syntax
400 To assemble a file, you issue a command of the form
402 \c nasm -f <format> <filename> [-o <output>]
406 \c nasm -f elf myfile.asm
408 will assemble \c{myfile.asm} into an \c{ELF} object file \c{myfile.o}. And
410 \c nasm -f bin myfile.asm -o myfile.com
412 will assemble \c{myfile.asm} into a raw binary file \c{myfile.com}.
414 To produce a listing file, with the hex codes output from NASM
415 displayed on the left of the original sources, use the \c{-l} option
416 to give a listing file name, for example:
418 \c nasm -f coff myfile.asm -l myfile.lst
420 To get further usage instructions from NASM, try typing
424 This will also list the available output file formats, and what they
427 If you use Linux but aren't sure whether your system is \c{a.out}
432 (in the directory in which you put the NASM binary when you
433 installed it). If it says something like
435 \c nasm: ELF 32-bit LSB executable i386 (386 and up) Version 1
437 then your system is \c{ELF}, and you should use the option \c{-f elf}
438 when you want NASM to produce Linux object files. If it says
440 \c nasm: Linux/i386 demand-paged executable (QMAGIC)
442 or something similar, your system is \c{a.out}, and you should use
443 \c{-f aout} instead (Linux \c{a.out} systems have long been obsolete,
444 and are rare these days.)
446 Like Unix compilers and assemblers, NASM is silent unless it
447 goes wrong: you won't see any output at all, unless it gives error
451 \S{opt-o} The \i\c{-o} Option: Specifying the Output File Name
453 NASM will normally choose the name of your output file for you;
454 precisely how it does this is dependent on the object file format.
455 For Microsoft object file formats (\i\c{obj} and \i\c{win32}), it
456 will remove the \c{.asm} \i{extension} (or whatever extension you
457 like to use - NASM doesn't care) from your source file name and
458 substitute \c{.obj}. For Unix object file formats (\i\c{aout},
459 \i\c{coff}, \i\c{elf} and \i\c{as86}) it will substitute \c{.o}. For
460 \i\c{rdf}, it will use \c{.rdf}, and for the \i\c{bin} format it
461 will simply remove the extension, so that \c{myfile.asm} produces
462 the output file \c{myfile}.
464 If the output file already exists, NASM will overwrite it, unless it
465 has the same name as the input file, in which case it will give a
466 warning and use \i\c{nasm.out} as the output file name instead.
468 For situations in which this behaviour is unacceptable, NASM
469 provides the \c{-o} command-line option, which allows you to specify
470 your desired output file name. You invoke \c{-o} by following it
471 with the name you wish for the output file, either with or without
472 an intervening space. For example:
474 \c nasm -f bin program.asm -o program.com
475 \c nasm -f bin driver.asm -odriver.sys
477 Note that this is a small o, and is different from a capital O , which
478 is used to specify the number of optimisation passes required. See \k{opt-On}.
481 \S{opt-f} The \i\c{-f} Option: Specifying the \i{Output File Format}
483 If you do not supply the \c{-f} option to NASM, it will choose an
484 output file format for you itself. In the distribution versions of
485 NASM, the default is always \i\c{bin}; if you've compiled your own
486 copy of NASM, you can redefine \i\c{OF_DEFAULT} at compile time and
487 choose what you want the default to be.
489 Like \c{-o}, the intervening space between \c{-f} and the output
490 file format is optional; so \c{-f elf} and \c{-felf} are both valid.
492 A complete list of the available output file formats can be given by
493 issuing the command \i\c{nasm -hf}.
496 \S{opt-l} The \i\c{-l} Option: Generating a \i{Listing File}
498 If you supply the \c{-l} option to NASM, followed (with the usual
499 optional space) by a file name, NASM will generate a
500 \i{source-listing file} for you, in which addresses and generated
501 code are listed on the left, and the actual source code, with
502 expansions of multi-line macros (except those which specifically
503 request no expansion in source listings: see \k{nolist}) on the
506 \c nasm -f elf myfile.asm -l myfile.lst
509 \S{opt-M} The \i\c{-M} Option: Generate \i{Makefile Dependencies}.
511 This option can be used to generate makefile dependencies on stdout.
512 This can be redirected to a file for further processing. For example:
514 \c NASM -M myfile.asm > myfile.dep
517 \S{opt-F} The \i\c{-F} Option: Selecting a \i{Debugging Format}
519 This option can be used to select a debugging format for the output file.
520 The syntax is the same as for the -f option, except that it produces
521 output in a debugging format.
523 A complete list of the available debug file formats for an output format
524 can be seen by issuing the command \i\c{nasm -f <format> -y}.
526 This option is not built into NASM by default. For information on how
527 to enable it when building from the sources, see \k{dbgfmt}
530 \S{opt-g} The \i\c{-g} Option: Enabling \i{Debug Information}.
532 This option can be used to generate debugging information in the specified
535 See \k{opt-F} for more information.
538 \S{opt-E} The \i\c{-E} Option: Send Errors to a File
540 Under \I{DOS}\c{MS-DOS} it can be difficult (though there are ways) to
541 redirect the standard-error output of a program to a file. Since
542 NASM usually produces its warning and \i{error messages} on
543 \i\c{stderr}, this can make it hard to capture the errors if (for
544 example) you want to load them into an editor.
546 NASM therefore provides the \c{-E} option, taking a filename argument
547 which causes errors to be sent to the specified files rather than
548 standard error. Therefore you can \I{redirecting errors}redirect
549 the errors into a file by typing
551 \c nasm -E myfile.err -f obj myfile.asm
554 \S{opt-s} The \i\c{-s} Option: Send Errors to \i\c{stdout}
556 The \c{-s} option redirects \i{error messages} to \c{stdout} rather
557 than \c{stderr}, so it can be redirected under \I{DOS}\c{MS-DOS}. To
558 assemble the file \c{myfile.asm} and pipe its output to the \c{more}
559 program, you can type:
561 \c nasm -s -f obj myfile.asm | more
563 See also the \c{-E} option, \k{opt-E}.
566 \S{opt-i} The \i\c{-i}\I\c{-I} Option: Include File Search Directories
568 When NASM sees the \i\c{%include} directive in a source file (see
569 \k{include}), it will search for the given file not only in the
570 current directory, but also in any directories specified on the
571 command line by the use of the \c{-i} option. Therefore you can
572 include files from a \i{macro library}, for example, by typing
574 \c nasm -ic:\macrolib\ -f obj myfile.asm
576 (As usual, a space between \c{-i} and the path name is allowed, and
579 NASM, in the interests of complete source-code portability, does not
580 understand the file naming conventions of the OS it is running on;
581 the string you provide as an argument to the \c{-i} option will be
582 prepended exactly as written to the name of the include file.
583 Therefore the trailing backslash in the above example is necessary.
584 Under Unix, a trailing forward slash is similarly necessary.
586 (You can use this to your advantage, if you're really \i{perverse},
587 by noting that the option \c{-ifoo} will cause \c{%include "bar.i"}
588 to search for the file \c{foobar.i}...)
590 If you want to define a \e{standard} \i{include search path},
591 similar to \c{/usr/include} on Unix systems, you should place one or
592 more \c{-i} directives in the \c{NASMENV} environment variable (see
595 For Makefile compatibility with many C compilers, this option can also
596 be specified as \c{-I}.
599 \S{opt-p} The \i\c{-p}\I\c{-P} Option: \I{pre-including files}Pre-Include a File
601 \I\c{%include}NASM allows you to specify files to be
602 \e{pre-included} into your source file, by the use of the \c{-p}
605 \c nasm myfile.asm -p myinc.inc
607 is equivalent to running \c{nasm myfile.asm} and placing the
608 directive \c{%include "myinc.inc"} at the start of the file.
610 For consistency with the \c{-I}, \c{-D} and \c{-U} options, this
611 option can also be specified as \c{-P}.
614 \S{opt-d} The \i\c{-d}\I\c{-D} Option: \I{pre-defining macros}Pre-Define a Macro
616 \I\c{%define}Just as the \c{-p} option gives an alternative to placing
617 \c{%include} directives at the start of a source file, the \c{-d}
618 option gives an alternative to placing a \c{%define} directive. You
621 \c nasm myfile.asm -dFOO=100
623 as an alternative to placing the directive
627 at the start of the file. You can miss off the macro value, as well:
628 the option \c{-dFOO} is equivalent to coding \c{%define FOO}. This
629 form of the directive may be useful for selecting \i{assembly-time
630 options} which are then tested using \c{%ifdef}, for example
633 For Makefile compatibility with many C compilers, this option can also
634 be specified as \c{-D}.
637 \S{opt-u} The \i\c{-u}\I\c{-U} Option: \I{Undefining macros}Undefine a Macro
639 \I\c{%undef}The \c{-u} option undefines a macro that would otherwise
640 have been pre-defined, either automatically or by a \c{-p} or \c{-d}
641 option specified earlier on the command lines.
643 For example, the following command line:
645 \c nasm myfile.asm -dFOO=100 -uFOO
647 would result in \c{FOO} \e{not} being a predefined macro in the
648 program. This is useful to override options specified at a different
651 For Makefile compatibility with many C compilers, this option can also
652 be specified as \c{-U}.
655 \S{opt-e} The \i\c{-e} Option: Preprocess Only
657 NASM allows the \i{preprocessor} to be run on its own, up to a
658 point. Using the \c{-e} option (which requires no arguments) will
659 cause NASM to preprocess its input file, expand all the macro
660 references, remove all the comments and preprocessor directives, and
661 print the resulting file on standard output (or save it to a file,
662 if the \c{-o} option is also used).
664 This option cannot be applied to programs which require the
665 preprocessor to evaluate \I{preprocessor expressions}\i{expressions}
666 which depend on the values of symbols: so code such as
668 \c %assign tablesize ($-tablestart)
670 will cause an error in \i{preprocess-only mode}.
673 \S{opt-a} The \i\c{-a} Option: Don't Preprocess At All
675 If NASM is being used as the back end to a compiler, it might be
676 desirable to \I{suppressing preprocessing}suppress preprocessing
677 completely and assume the compiler has already done it, to save time
678 and increase compilation speeds. The \c{-a} option, requiring no
679 argument, instructs NASM to replace its powerful \i{preprocessor}
680 with a \i{stub preprocessor} which does nothing.
683 \S{opt-On} The \i\c{-On} Option: Specifying \i{Multipass Optimization}.
685 NASM defaults to being a two pass assembler. This means that if you
686 have a complex source file which needs more than 2 passes to assemble
687 correctly, you have to tell it.
689 Using the \c{-O} option, you can tell NASM to carry out multiple passes.
692 \b \c{-O0} strict two-pass assembly, JMP and Jcc are handled more
693 like v0.98, except that backward JMPs are short, if possible.
694 Immediate operands take their long forms if a short form is
697 \b \c{-O1} strict two-pass assembly, but forward branches are assembled
698 with code guaranteed to reach; may produce larger code than
699 -O0, but will produce successful assembly more often if
700 branch offset sizes are not specified.
701 Additionally, immediate operands which will fit in a signed byte
702 are optimised, unless the long form is specified.
704 \b \c{-On} multi-pass optimization, minimize branch offsets; also will
705 minimize signed immediate bytes, overriding size specification
706 when the \c{strict} keyword hasn't been used (see \k{strict}).
707 If 2 <= n <= 3, then there are 5 * n passes, otherwise there
711 Note that this is a capital O, and is different from a small o, which
712 is used to specify the output format. See \k{opt-o}.
715 \S{opt-t} The \i\c{-t} option: Enable TASM Compatibility Mode
717 NASM includes a limited form of compatibility with Borland's \i\c{TASM}.
718 When NASM's \c{-t} option is used, the following changes are made:
720 \b local labels may be prefixed with \c{@@} instead of \c{.}
722 \b TASM-style response files beginning with \c{@} may be specified on
723 the command line. This is different from the \c{-@resp} style that NASM
726 \b size override is supported within brackets. In TASM compatible mode,
727 a size override inside square brackets changes the size of the operand,
728 and not the address type of the operand as it does in NASM syntax. E.g.
729 \c{mov eax,[DWORD val]} is valid syntax in TASM compatibility mode.
730 Note that you lose the ability to override the default address type for
733 \b \c{%arg} preprocessor directive is supported which is similar to
734 TASM's \c{ARG} directive.
736 \b \c{%local} preprocessor directive
738 \b \c{%stacksize} preprocessor directive
740 \b unprefixed forms of some directives supported (\c{arg}, \c{elif},
741 \c{else}, \c{endif}, \c{if}, \c{ifdef}, \c{ifdifi}, \c{ifndef},
742 \c{include}, \c{local})
746 For more information on the directives, see the section on TASM
747 Compatiblity preprocessor directives in \k{tasmcompat}.
750 \S{opt-w} The \i\c{-w} Option: Enable or Disable Assembly \i{Warnings}
752 NASM can observe many conditions during the course of assembly which
753 are worth mentioning to the user, but not a sufficiently severe
754 error to justify NASM refusing to generate an output file. These
755 conditions are reported like errors, but come up with the word
756 `warning' before the message. Warnings do not prevent NASM from
757 generating an output file and returning a success status to the
760 Some conditions are even less severe than that: they are only
761 sometimes worth mentioning to the user. Therefore NASM supports the
762 \c{-w} command-line option, which enables or disables certain
763 classes of assembly warning. Such warning classes are described by a
764 name, for example \c{orphan-labels}; you can enable warnings of
765 this class by the command-line option \c{-w+orphan-labels} and
766 disable it by \c{-w-orphan-labels}.
768 The \i{suppressible warning} classes are:
770 \b \i\c{macro-params} covers warnings about \i{multi-line macros}
771 being invoked with the wrong number of parameters. This warning
772 class is enabled by default; see \k{mlmacover} for an example of why
773 you might want to disable it.
775 \b \i\c{orphan-labels} covers warnings about source lines which
776 contain no instruction but define a label without a trailing colon.
777 NASM does not warn about this somewhat obscure condition by default;
778 see \k{syntax} for an example of why you might want it to.
780 \b \i\c{number-overflow} covers warnings about numeric constants which
781 don't fit in 32 bits (for example, it's easy to type one too many Fs
782 and produce \c{0x7ffffffff} by mistake). This warning class is
786 \S{opt-v} The \i\c{-v} Option: Display \i{Version} Info
788 Typing \c{NASM -v} will display the version of NASM which you are using,
789 and the date on which it was compiled.
791 You will need the version number if you report a bug.
794 \S{nasmenv} The \c{NASMENV} \i{Environment} Variable
796 If you define an environment variable called \c{NASMENV}, the program
797 will interpret it as a list of extra command-line options, which are
798 processed before the real command line. You can use this to define
799 standard search directories for include files, by putting \c{-i}
800 options in the \c{NASMENV} variable.
802 The value of the variable is split up at white space, so that the
803 value \c{-s -ic:\\nasmlib} will be treated as two separate options.
804 However, that means that the value \c{-dNAME="my name"} won't do
805 what you might want, because it will be split at the space and the
806 NASM command-line processing will get confused by the two
807 nonsensical words \c{-dNAME="my} and \c{name"}.
809 To get round this, NASM provides a feature whereby, if you begin the
810 \c{NASMENV} environment variable with some character that isn't a minus
811 sign, then NASM will treat this character as the \i{separator
812 character} for options. So setting the \c{NASMENV} variable to the
813 value \c{!-s!-ic:\\nasmlib} is equivalent to setting it to \c{-s
814 -ic:\\nasmlib}, but \c{!-dNAME="my name"} will work.
816 This environment variable was previously called \c{NASM}. This was
817 changed with version 0.98.31.
820 \H{qstart} \i{Quick Start} for \i{MASM} Users
822 If you're used to writing programs with MASM, or with \i{TASM} in
823 MASM-compatible (non-Ideal) mode, or with \i\c{a86}, this section
824 attempts to outline the major differences between MASM's syntax and
825 NASM's. If you're not already used to MASM, it's probably worth
826 skipping this section.
829 \S{qscs} NASM Is \I{case sensitivity}Case-Sensitive
831 One simple difference is that NASM is case-sensitive. It makes a
832 difference whether you call your label \c{foo}, \c{Foo} or \c{FOO}.
833 If you're assembling to \c{DOS} or \c{OS/2} \c{.OBJ} files, you can
834 invoke the \i\c{UPPERCASE} directive (documented in \k{objfmt}) to
835 ensure that all symbols exported to other code modules are forced
836 to be upper case; but even then, \e{within} a single module, NASM
837 will distinguish between labels differing only in case.
840 \S{qsbrackets} NASM Requires \i{Square Brackets} For \i{Memory References}
842 NASM was designed with simplicity of syntax in mind. One of the
843 \i{design goals} of NASM is that it should be possible, as far as is
844 practical, for the user to look at a single line of NASM code
845 and tell what opcode is generated by it. You can't do this in MASM:
846 if you declare, for example,
851 then the two lines of code
856 generate completely different opcodes, despite having
857 identical-looking syntaxes.
859 NASM avoids this undesirable situation by having a much simpler
860 syntax for memory references. The rule is simply that any access to
861 the \e{contents} of a memory location requires square brackets
862 around the address, and any access to the \e{address} of a variable
863 doesn't. So an instruction of the form \c{mov ax,foo} will
864 \e{always} refer to a compile-time constant, whether it's an \c{EQU}
865 or the address of a variable; and to access the \e{contents} of the
866 variable \c{bar}, you must code \c{mov ax,[bar]}.
868 This also means that NASM has no need for MASM's \i\c{OFFSET}
869 keyword, since the MASM code \c{mov ax,offset bar} means exactly the
870 same thing as NASM's \c{mov ax,bar}. If you're trying to get
871 large amounts of MASM code to assemble sensibly under NASM, you
872 can always code \c{%idefine offset} to make the preprocessor treat
873 the \c{OFFSET} keyword as a no-op.
875 This issue is even more confusing in \i\c{a86}, where declaring a
876 label with a trailing colon defines it to be a `label' as opposed to
877 a `variable' and causes \c{a86} to adopt NASM-style semantics; so in
878 \c{a86}, \c{mov ax,var} has different behaviour depending on whether
879 \c{var} was declared as \c{var: dw 0} (a label) or \c{var dw 0} (a
880 word-size variable). NASM is very simple by comparison:
881 \e{everything} is a label.
883 NASM, in the interests of simplicity, also does not support the
884 \i{hybrid syntaxes} supported by MASM and its clones, such as
885 \c{mov ax,table[bx]}, where a memory reference is denoted by one
886 portion outside square brackets and another portion inside. The
887 correct syntax for the above is \c{mov ax,[table+bx]}. Likewise,
888 \c{mov ax,es:[di]} is wrong and \c{mov ax,[es:di]} is right.
891 \S{qstypes} NASM Doesn't Store \i{Variable Types}
893 NASM, by design, chooses not to remember the types of variables you
894 declare. Whereas MASM will remember, on seeing \c{var dw 0}, that
895 you declared \c{var} as a word-size variable, and will then be able
896 to fill in the \i{ambiguity} in the size of the instruction \c{mov
897 var,2}, NASM will deliberately remember nothing about the symbol
898 \c{var} except where it begins, and so you must explicitly code
899 \c{mov word [var],2}.
901 For this reason, NASM doesn't support the \c{LODS}, \c{MOVS},
902 \c{STOS}, \c{SCAS}, \c{CMPS}, \c{INS}, or \c{OUTS} instructions,
903 but only supports the forms such as \c{LODSB}, \c{MOVSW}, and
904 \c{SCASD}, which explicitly specify the size of the components of
905 the strings being manipulated.
908 \S{qsassume} NASM Doesn't \i\c{ASSUME}
910 As part of NASM's drive for simplicity, it also does not support the
911 \c{ASSUME} directive. NASM will not keep track of what values you
912 choose to put in your segment registers, and will never
913 \e{automatically} generate a \i{segment override} prefix.
916 \S{qsmodel} NASM Doesn't Support \i{Memory Models}
918 NASM also does not have any directives to support different 16-bit
919 memory models. The programmer has to keep track of which functions
920 are supposed to be called with a \i{far call} and which with a
921 \i{near call}, and is responsible for putting the correct form of
922 \c{RET} instruction (\c{RETN} or \c{RETF}; NASM accepts \c{RET}
923 itself as an alternate form for \c{RETN}); in addition, the
924 programmer is responsible for coding CALL FAR instructions where
925 necessary when calling \e{external} functions, and must also keep
926 track of which external variable definitions are far and which are
930 \S{qsfpu} \i{Floating-Point} Differences
932 NASM uses different names to refer to floating-point registers from
933 MASM: where MASM would call them \c{ST(0)}, \c{ST(1)} and so on, and
934 \i\c{a86} would call them simply \c{0}, \c{1} and so on, NASM
935 chooses to call them \c{st0}, \c{st1} etc.
937 As of version 0.96, NASM now treats the instructions with
938 \i{`nowait'} forms in the same way as MASM-compatible assemblers.
939 The idiosyncratic treatment employed by 0.95 and earlier was based
940 on a misunderstanding by the authors.
943 \S{qsother} Other Differences
945 For historical reasons, NASM uses the keyword \i\c{TWORD} where MASM
946 and compatible assemblers use \i\c{TBYTE}.
948 NASM does not declare \i{uninitialised storage} in the same way as
949 MASM: where a MASM programmer might use \c{stack db 64 dup (?)},
950 NASM requires \c{stack resb 64}, intended to be read as `reserve 64
951 bytes'. For a limited amount of compatibility, since NASM treats
952 \c{?} as a valid character in symbol names, you can code \c{? equ 0}
953 and then writing \c{dw ?} will at least do something vaguely useful.
954 \I\c{RESB}\i\c{DUP} is still not a supported syntax, however.
956 In addition to all of this, macros and directives work completely
957 differently to MASM. See \k{preproc} and \k{directive} for further
961 \C{lang} The NASM Language
963 \H{syntax} Layout of a NASM Source Line
965 Like most assemblers, each NASM source line contains (unless it
966 is a macro, a preprocessor directive or an assembler directive: see
967 \k{preproc} and \k{directive}) some combination of the four fields
969 \c label: instruction operands ; comment
971 As usual, most of these fields are optional; the presence or absence
972 of any combination of a label, an instruction and a comment is allowed.
973 Of course, the operand field is either required or forbidden by the
974 presence and nature of the instruction field.
976 NASM uses backslash (\\) as the line continuation character; if a line
977 ends with backslash, the next line is considered to be a part of the
978 backslash-ended line.
980 NASM places no restrictions on white space within a line: labels may
981 have white space before them, or instructions may have no space
982 before them, or anything. The \i{colon} after a label is also
983 optional. (Note that this means that if you intend to code \c{lodsb}
984 alone on a line, and type \c{lodab} by accident, then that's still a
985 valid source line which does nothing but define a label. Running
986 NASM with the command-line option
987 \I{orphan-labels}\c{-w+orphan-labels} will cause it to warn you if
988 you define a label alone on a line without a \i{trailing colon}.)
990 \i{Valid characters} in labels are letters, numbers, \c{_}, \c{$},
991 \c{#}, \c{@}, \c{~}, \c{.}, and \c{?}. The only characters which may
992 be used as the \e{first} character of an identifier are letters,
993 \c{.} (with special meaning: see \k{locallab}), \c{_} and \c{?}.
994 An identifier may also be prefixed with a \I{$, prefix}\c{$} to
995 indicate that it is intended to be read as an identifier and not a
996 reserved word; thus, if some other module you are linking with
997 defines a symbol called \c{eax}, you can refer to \c{$eax} in NASM
998 code to distinguish the symbol from the register.
1000 The instruction field may contain any machine instruction: Pentium
1001 and P6 instructions, FPU instructions, MMX instructions and even
1002 undocumented instructions are all supported. The instruction may be
1003 prefixed by \c{LOCK}, \c{REP}, \c{REPE}/\c{REPZ} or
1004 \c{REPNE}/\c{REPNZ}, in the usual way. Explicit \I{address-size
1005 prefixes}address-size and \i{operand-size prefixes} \c{A16},
1006 \c{A32}, \c{O16} and \c{O32} are provided - one example of their use
1007 is given in \k{mixsize}. You can also use the name of a \I{segment
1008 override}segment register as an instruction prefix: coding
1009 \c{es mov [bx],ax} is equivalent to coding \c{mov [es:bx],ax}. We
1010 recommend the latter syntax, since it is consistent with other
1011 syntactic features of the language, but for instructions such as
1012 \c{LODSB}, which has no operands and yet can require a segment
1013 override, there is no clean syntactic way to proceed apart from
1016 An instruction is not required to use a prefix: prefixes such as
1017 \c{CS}, \c{A32}, \c{LOCK} or \c{REPE} can appear on a line by
1018 themselves, and NASM will just generate the prefix bytes.
1020 In addition to actual machine instructions, NASM also supports a
1021 number of pseudo-instructions, described in \k{pseudop}.
1023 Instruction \i{operands} may take a number of forms: they can be
1024 registers, described simply by the register name (e.g. \c{ax},
1025 \c{bp}, \c{ebx}, \c{cr0}: NASM does not use the \c{gas}-style
1026 syntax in which register names must be prefixed by a \c{%} sign), or
1027 they can be \i{effective addresses} (see \k{effaddr}), constants
1028 (\k{const}) or expressions (\k{expr}).
1030 For \i{floating-point} instructions, NASM accepts a wide range of
1031 syntaxes: you can use two-operand forms like MASM supports, or you
1032 can use NASM's native single-operand forms in most cases. Details of
1033 all forms of each supported instruction are given in
1034 \k{iref}. For example, you can code:
1036 \c fadd st1 ; this sets st0 := st0 + st1
1037 \c fadd st0,st1 ; so does this
1039 \c fadd st1,st0 ; this sets st1 := st1 + st0
1040 \c fadd to st1 ; so does this
1042 Almost any floating-point instruction that references memory must
1043 use one of the prefixes \i\c{DWORD}, \i\c{QWORD} or \i\c{TWORD} to
1044 indicate what size of \i{memory operand} it refers to.
1047 \H{pseudop} \i{Pseudo-Instructions}
1049 Pseudo-instructions are things which, though not real x86 machine
1050 instructions, are used in the instruction field anyway because
1051 that's the most convenient place to put them. The current
1052 pseudo-instructions are \i\c{DB}, \i\c{DW}, \i\c{DD}, \i\c{DQ} and
1053 \i\c{DT}, their \i{uninitialised} counterparts \i\c{RESB},
1054 \i\c{RESW}, \i\c{RESD}, \i\c{RESQ} and \i\c{REST}, the \i\c{INCBIN}
1055 command, the \i\c{EQU} command, and the \i\c{TIMES} prefix.
1058 \S{db} \c{DB} and friends: Declaring Initialised Data
1060 \i\c{DB}, \i\c{DW}, \i\c{DD}, \i\c{DQ} and \i\c{DT} are used, much
1061 as in MASM, to declare initialised data in the output file. They can
1062 be invoked in a wide range of ways:
1063 \I{floating-point}\I{character constant}\I{string constant}
1065 \c db 0x55 ; just the byte 0x55
1066 \c db 0x55,0x56,0x57 ; three bytes in succession
1067 \c db 'a',0x55 ; character constants are OK
1068 \c db 'hello',13,10,'$' ; so are string constants
1069 \c dw 0x1234 ; 0x34 0x12
1070 \c dw 'a' ; 0x41 0x00 (it's just a number)
1071 \c dw 'ab' ; 0x41 0x42 (character constant)
1072 \c dw 'abc' ; 0x41 0x42 0x43 0x00 (string)
1073 \c dd 0x12345678 ; 0x78 0x56 0x34 0x12
1074 \c dd 1.234567e20 ; floating-point constant
1075 \c dq 1.234567e20 ; double-precision float
1076 \c dt 1.234567e20 ; extended-precision float
1078 \c{DQ} and \c{DT} do not accept \i{numeric constants} or string
1079 constants as operands.
1082 \S{resb} \c{RESB} and friends: Declaring \i{Uninitialised} Data
1084 \i\c{RESB}, \i\c{RESW}, \i\c{RESD}, \i\c{RESQ} and \i\c{REST} are
1085 designed to be used in the BSS section of a module: they declare
1086 \e{uninitialised} storage space. Each takes a single operand, which
1087 is the number of bytes, words, doublewords or whatever to reserve.
1088 As stated in \k{qsother}, NASM does not support the MASM/TASM syntax
1089 of reserving uninitialised space by writing \I\c{?}\c{DW ?} or
1090 similar things: this is what it does instead. The operand to a
1091 \c{RESB}-type pseudo-instruction is a \i\e{critical expression}: see
1096 \c buffer: resb 64 ; reserve 64 bytes
1097 \c wordvar: resw 1 ; reserve a word
1098 \c realarray resq 10 ; array of ten reals
1101 \S{incbin} \i\c{INCBIN}: Including External \i{Binary Files}
1103 \c{INCBIN} is borrowed from the old Amiga assembler \i{DevPac}: it
1104 includes a binary file verbatim into the output file. This can be
1105 handy for (for example) including \i{graphics} and \i{sound} data
1106 directly into a game executable file. It can be called in one of
1109 \c incbin "file.dat" ; include the whole file
1110 \c incbin "file.dat",1024 ; skip the first 1024 bytes
1111 \c incbin "file.dat",1024,512 ; skip the first 1024, and
1112 \c ; actually include at most 512
1115 \S{equ} \i\c{EQU}: Defining Constants
1117 \c{EQU} defines a symbol to a given constant value: when \c{EQU} is
1118 used, the source line must contain a label. The action of \c{EQU} is
1119 to define the given label name to the value of its (only) operand.
1120 This definition is absolute, and cannot change later. So, for
1123 \c message db 'hello, world'
1124 \c msglen equ $-message
1126 defines \c{msglen} to be the constant 12. \c{msglen} may not then be
1127 redefined later. This is not a \i{preprocessor} definition either:
1128 the value of \c{msglen} is evaluated \e{once}, using the value of
1129 \c{$} (see \k{expr} for an explanation of \c{$}) at the point of
1130 definition, rather than being evaluated wherever it is referenced
1131 and using the value of \c{$} at the point of reference. Note that
1132 the operand to an \c{EQU} is also a \i{critical expression}
1136 \S{times} \i\c{TIMES}: \i{Repeating} Instructions or Data
1138 The \c{TIMES} prefix causes the instruction to be assembled multiple
1139 times. This is partly present as NASM's equivalent of the \i\c{DUP}
1140 syntax supported by \i{MASM}-compatible assemblers, in that you can
1143 \c zerobuf: times 64 db 0
1145 or similar things; but \c{TIMES} is more versatile than that. The
1146 argument to \c{TIMES} is not just a numeric constant, but a numeric
1147 \e{expression}, so you can do things like
1149 \c buffer: db 'hello, world'
1150 \c times 64-$+buffer db ' '
1152 which will store exactly enough spaces to make the total length of
1153 \c{buffer} up to 64. Finally, \c{TIMES} can be applied to ordinary
1154 instructions, so you can code trivial \i{unrolled loops} in it:
1158 Note that there is no effective difference between \c{times 100 resb
1159 1} and \c{resb 100}, except that the latter will be assembled about
1160 100 times faster due to the internal structure of the assembler.
1162 The operand to \c{TIMES}, like that of \c{EQU} and those of \c{RESB}
1163 and friends, is a critical expression (\k{crit}).
1165 Note also that \c{TIMES} can't be applied to \i{macros}: the reason
1166 for this is that \c{TIMES} is processed after the macro phase, which
1167 allows the argument to \c{TIMES} to contain expressions such as
1168 \c{64-$+buffer} as above. To repeat more than one line of code, or a
1169 complex macro, use the preprocessor \i\c{%rep} directive.
1172 \H{effaddr} Effective Addresses
1174 An \i{effective address} is any operand to an instruction which
1175 \I{memory reference}references memory. Effective addresses, in NASM,
1176 have a very simple syntax: they consist of an expression evaluating
1177 to the desired address, enclosed in \i{square brackets}. For
1182 \c mov ax,[wordvar+1]
1183 \c mov ax,[es:wordvar+bx]
1185 Anything not conforming to this simple system is not a valid memory
1186 reference in NASM, for example \c{es:wordvar[bx]}.
1188 More complicated effective addresses, such as those involving more
1189 than one register, work in exactly the same way:
1191 \c mov eax,[ebx*2+ecx+offset]
1194 NASM is capable of doing \i{algebra} on these effective addresses,
1195 so that things which don't necessarily \e{look} legal are perfectly
1198 \c mov eax,[ebx*5] ; assembles as [ebx*4+ebx]
1199 \c mov eax,[label1*2-label2] ; ie [label1+(label1-label2)]
1201 Some forms of effective address have more than one assembled form;
1202 in most such cases NASM will generate the smallest form it can. For
1203 example, there are distinct assembled forms for the 32-bit effective
1204 addresses \c{[eax*2+0]} and \c{[eax+eax]}, and NASM will generally
1205 generate the latter on the grounds that the former requires four
1206 bytes to store a zero offset.
1208 NASM has a hinting mechanism which will cause \c{[eax+ebx]} and
1209 \c{[ebx+eax]} to generate different opcodes; this is occasionally
1210 useful because \c{[esi+ebp]} and \c{[ebp+esi]} have different
1211 default segment registers.
1213 However, you can force NASM to generate an effective address in a
1214 particular form by the use of the keywords \c{BYTE}, \c{WORD},
1215 \c{DWORD} and \c{NOSPLIT}. If you need \c{[eax+3]} to be assembled
1216 using a double-word offset field instead of the one byte NASM will
1217 normally generate, you can code \c{[dword eax+3]}. Similarly, you
1218 can force NASM to use a byte offset for a small value which it
1219 hasn't seen on the first pass (see \k{crit} for an example of such a
1220 code fragment) by using \c{[byte eax+offset]}. As special cases,
1221 \c{[byte eax]} will code \c{[eax+0]} with a byte offset of zero, and
1222 \c{[dword eax]} will code it with a double-word offset of zero. The
1223 normal form, \c{[eax]}, will be coded with no offset field.
1225 The form described in the previous paragraph is also useful if you
1226 are trying to access data in a 32-bit segment from within 16 bit code.
1227 For more information on this see the section on mixed-size addressing
1228 (\k{mixaddr}). In particular, if you need to access data with a known
1229 offset that is larger than will fit in a 16-bit value, if you don't
1230 specify that it is a dword offset, nasm will cause the high word of
1231 the offset to be lost.
1233 Similarly, NASM will split \c{[eax*2]} into \c{[eax+eax]} because
1234 that allows the offset field to be absent and space to be saved; in
1235 fact, it will also split \c{[eax*2+offset]} into
1236 \c{[eax+eax+offset]}. You can combat this behaviour by the use of
1237 the \c{NOSPLIT} keyword: \c{[nosplit eax*2]} will force
1238 \c{[eax*2+0]} to be generated literally.
1241 \H{const} \i{Constants}
1243 NASM understands four different types of constant: numeric,
1244 character, string and floating-point.
1247 \S{numconst} \i{Numeric Constants}
1249 A numeric constant is simply a number. NASM allows you to specify
1250 numbers in a variety of number bases, in a variety of ways: you can
1251 suffix \c{H}, \c{Q} and \c{B} for \i{hex}, \i{octal} and \i{binary},
1252 or you can prefix \c{0x} for hex in the style of C, or you can
1253 prefix \c{$} for hex in the style of Borland Pascal. Note, though,
1254 that the \I{$, prefix}\c{$} prefix does double duty as a prefix on
1255 identifiers (see \k{syntax}), so a hex number prefixed with a \c{$}
1256 sign must have a digit after the \c{$} rather than a letter.
1260 \c mov ax,100 ; decimal
1261 \c mov ax,0a2h ; hex
1262 \c mov ax,$0a2 ; hex again: the 0 is required
1263 \c mov ax,0xa2 ; hex yet again
1264 \c mov ax,777q ; octal
1265 \c mov ax,10010011b ; binary
1268 \S{chrconst} \i{Character Constants}
1270 A character constant consists of up to four characters enclosed in
1271 either single or double quotes. The type of quote makes no
1272 difference to NASM, except of course that surrounding the constant
1273 with single quotes allows double quotes to appear within it and vice
1276 A character constant with more than one character will be arranged
1277 with \i{little-endian} order in mind: if you code
1281 then the constant generated is not \c{0x61626364}, but
1282 \c{0x64636261}, so that if you were then to store the value into
1283 memory, it would read \c{abcd} rather than \c{dcba}. This is also
1284 the sense of character constants understood by the Pentium's
1285 \i\c{CPUID} instruction (see \k{insCPUID}).
1288 \S{strconst} String Constants
1290 String constants are only acceptable to some pseudo-instructions,
1291 namely the \I\c{DW}\I\c{DD}\I\c{DQ}\I\c{DT}\i\c{DB} family and
1294 A string constant looks like a character constant, only longer. It
1295 is treated as a concatenation of maximum-size character constants
1296 for the conditions. So the following are equivalent:
1298 \c db 'hello' ; string constant
1299 \c db 'h','e','l','l','o' ; equivalent character constants
1301 And the following are also equivalent:
1303 \c dd 'ninechars' ; doubleword string constant
1304 \c dd 'nine','char','s' ; becomes three doublewords
1305 \c db 'ninechars',0,0,0 ; and really looks like this
1307 Note that when used as an operand to \c{db}, a constant like
1308 \c{'ab'} is treated as a string constant despite being short enough
1309 to be a character constant, because otherwise \c{db 'ab'} would have
1310 the same effect as \c{db 'a'}, which would be silly. Similarly,
1311 three-character or four-character constants are treated as strings
1312 when they are operands to \c{dw}.
1315 \S{fltconst} \I{floating-point, constants}Floating-Point Constants
1317 \i{Floating-point} constants are acceptable only as arguments to
1318 \i\c{DD}, \i\c{DQ} and \i\c{DT}. They are expressed in the
1319 traditional form: digits, then a period, then optionally more
1320 digits, then optionally an \c{E} followed by an exponent. The period
1321 is mandatory, so that NASM can distinguish between \c{dd 1}, which
1322 declares an integer constant, and \c{dd 1.0} which declares a
1323 floating-point constant.
1327 \c dd 1.2 ; an easy one
1328 \c dq 1.e10 ; 10,000,000,000
1329 \c dq 1.e+10 ; synonymous with 1.e10
1330 \c dq 1.e-10 ; 0.000 000 000 1
1331 \c dt 3.141592653589793238462 ; pi
1333 NASM cannot do compile-time arithmetic on floating-point constants.
1334 This is because NASM is designed to be portable - although it always
1335 generates code to run on x86 processors, the assembler itself can
1336 run on any system with an ANSI C compiler. Therefore, the assembler
1337 cannot guarantee the presence of a floating-point unit capable of
1338 handling the \i{Intel number formats}, and so for NASM to be able to
1339 do floating arithmetic it would have to include its own complete set
1340 of floating-point routines, which would significantly increase the
1341 size of the assembler for very little benefit.
1344 \H{expr} \i{Expressions}
1346 Expressions in NASM are similar in syntax to those in C.
1348 NASM does not guarantee the size of the integers used to evaluate
1349 expressions at compile time: since NASM can compile and run on
1350 64-bit systems quite happily, don't assume that expressions are
1351 evaluated in 32-bit registers and so try to make deliberate use of
1352 \i{integer overflow}. It might not always work. The only thing NASM
1353 will guarantee is what's guaranteed by ANSI C: you always have \e{at
1354 least} 32 bits to work in.
1356 NASM supports two special tokens in expressions, allowing
1357 calculations to involve the current assembly position: the
1358 \I{$, here}\c{$} and \i\c{$$} tokens. \c{$} evaluates to the assembly
1359 position at the beginning of the line containing the expression; so
1360 you can code an \i{infinite loop} using \c{JMP $}. \c{$$} evaluates
1361 to the beginning of the current section; so you can tell how far
1362 into the section you are by using \c{($-$$)}.
1364 The arithmetic \i{operators} provided by NASM are listed here, in
1365 increasing order of \i{precedence}.
1368 \S{expor} \i\c{|}: \i{Bitwise OR} Operator
1370 The \c{|} operator gives a bitwise OR, exactly as performed by the
1371 \c{OR} machine instruction. Bitwise OR is the lowest-priority
1372 arithmetic operator supported by NASM.
1375 \S{expxor} \i\c{^}: \i{Bitwise XOR} Operator
1377 \c{^} provides the bitwise XOR operation.
1380 \S{expand} \i\c{&}: \i{Bitwise AND} Operator
1382 \c{&} provides the bitwise AND operation.
1385 \S{expshift} \i\c{<<} and \i\c{>>}: \i{Bit Shift} Operators
1387 \c{<<} gives a bit-shift to the left, just as it does in C. So \c{5<<3}
1388 evaluates to 5 times 8, or 40. \c{>>} gives a bit-shift to the
1389 right; in NASM, such a shift is \e{always} unsigned, so that
1390 the bits shifted in from the left-hand end are filled with zero
1391 rather than a sign-extension of the previous highest bit.
1394 \S{expplmi} \I{+ opaddition}\c{+} and \I{- opsubtraction}\c{-}:
1395 \i{Addition} and \i{Subtraction} Operators
1397 The \c{+} and \c{-} operators do perfectly ordinary addition and
1401 \S{expmul} \i\c{*}, \i\c{/}, \i\c{//}, \i\c{%} and \i\c{%%}:
1402 \i{Multiplication} and \i{Division}
1404 \c{*} is the multiplication operator. \c{/} and \c{//} are both
1405 division operators: \c{/} is \i{unsigned division} and \c{//} is
1406 \i{signed division}. Similarly, \c{%} and \c{%%} provide \I{unsigned
1407 modulo}\I{modulo operators}unsigned and
1408 \i{signed modulo} operators respectively.
1410 NASM, like ANSI C, provides no guarantees about the sensible
1411 operation of the signed modulo operator.
1413 Since the \c{%} character is used extensively by the macro
1414 \i{preprocessor}, you should ensure that both the signed and unsigned
1415 modulo operators are followed by white space wherever they appear.
1418 \S{expmul} \i{Unary Operators}: \I{+ opunary}\c{+}, \I{- opunary}\c{-},
1419 \i\c{~} and \i\c{SEG}
1421 The highest-priority operators in NASM's expression grammar are
1422 those which only apply to one argument. \c{-} negates its operand,
1423 \c{+} does nothing (it's provided for symmetry with \c{-}), \c{~}
1424 computes the \i{one's complement} of its operand, and \c{SEG}
1425 provides the \i{segment address} of its operand (explained in more
1426 detail in \k{segwrt}).
1429 \H{segwrt} \i\c{SEG} and \i\c{WRT}
1431 When writing large 16-bit programs, which must be split into
1432 multiple \i{segments}, it is often necessary to be able to refer to
1433 the \I{segment address}segment part of the address of a symbol. NASM
1434 supports the \c{SEG} operator to perform this function.
1436 The \c{SEG} operator returns the \i\e{preferred} segment base of a
1437 symbol, defined as the segment base relative to which the offset of
1438 the symbol makes sense. So the code
1440 \c mov ax,seg symbol
1444 will load \c{ES:BX} with a valid pointer to the symbol \c{symbol}.
1446 Things can be more complex than this: since 16-bit segments and
1447 \i{groups} may \I{overlapping segments}overlap, you might occasionally
1448 want to refer to some symbol using a different segment base from the
1449 preferred one. NASM lets you do this, by the use of the \c{WRT}
1450 (With Reference To) keyword. So you can do things like
1452 \c mov ax,weird_seg ; weird_seg is a segment base
1454 \c mov bx,symbol wrt weird_seg
1456 to load \c{ES:BX} with a different, but functionally equivalent,
1457 pointer to the symbol \c{symbol}.
1459 NASM supports far (inter-segment) calls and jumps by means of the
1460 syntax \c{call segment:offset}, where \c{segment} and \c{offset}
1461 both represent immediate values. So to call a far procedure, you
1462 could code either of
1464 \c call (seg procedure):procedure
1465 \c call weird_seg:(procedure wrt weird_seg)
1467 (The parentheses are included for clarity, to show the intended
1468 parsing of the above instructions. They are not necessary in
1471 NASM supports the syntax \I\c{CALL FAR}\c{call far procedure} as a
1472 synonym for the first of the above usages. \c{JMP} works identically
1473 to \c{CALL} in these examples.
1475 To declare a \i{far pointer} to a data item in a data segment, you
1478 \c dw symbol, seg symbol
1480 NASM supports no convenient synonym for this, though you can always
1481 invent one using the macro processor.
1484 \H{strict} \i\c{STRICT}: Inhibiting Optimization
1486 When assembling with the optimizer set to level 2 or higher (see
1487 \k{opt-On}), NASM will usee size specifiers (\c{BYTE}, \c{WORD},
1488 \c{DWORD}, \c{QWORD}, or \c{TWORD}), but will give them the smallest
1489 possible size. The keyword \c{STRICT} can be used to inhibit
1490 optimization and force a particular operand to be emitted in the
1491 specified size. For example, with the optimizer on, and in
1496 is encoded in three bytes \c{66 6A 21}, whereas
1498 \c push strict dword 33
1500 is encoded in six bytes, with a full dword immediate operand \c{66 68
1503 With the optimizer off, the same code (six bytes) is generated whether
1504 the \c{STRICT} keyword was used or not.
1507 \H{crit} \i{Critical Expressions}
1509 A limitation of NASM is that it is a \i{two-pass assembler}; unlike
1510 TASM and others, it will always do exactly two \I{passes}\i{assembly
1511 passes}. Therefore it is unable to cope with source files that are
1512 complex enough to require three or more passes.
1514 The first pass is used to determine the size of all the assembled
1515 code and data, so that the second pass, when generating all the
1516 code, knows all the symbol addresses the code refers to. So one
1517 thing NASM can't handle is code whose size depends on the value of a
1518 symbol declared after the code in question. For example,
1520 \c times (label-$) db 0
1521 \c label: db 'Where am I?'
1523 The argument to \i\c{TIMES} in this case could equally legally
1524 evaluate to anything at all; NASM will reject this example because
1525 it cannot tell the size of the \c{TIMES} line when it first sees it.
1526 It will just as firmly reject the slightly \I{paradox}paradoxical
1529 \c times (label-$+1) db 0
1530 \c label: db 'NOW where am I?'
1532 in which \e{any} value for the \c{TIMES} argument is by definition
1535 NASM rejects these examples by means of a concept called a
1536 \e{critical expression}, which is defined to be an expression whose
1537 value is required to be computable in the first pass, and which must
1538 therefore depend only on symbols defined before it. The argument to
1539 the \c{TIMES} prefix is a critical expression; for the same reason,
1540 the arguments to the \i\c{RESB} family of pseudo-instructions are
1541 also critical expressions.
1543 Critical expressions can crop up in other contexts as well: consider
1547 \c symbol1 equ symbol2
1550 On the first pass, NASM cannot determine the value of \c{symbol1},
1551 because \c{symbol1} is defined to be equal to \c{symbol2} which NASM
1552 hasn't seen yet. On the second pass, therefore, when it encounters
1553 the line \c{mov ax,symbol1}, it is unable to generate the code for
1554 it because it still doesn't know the value of \c{symbol1}. On the
1555 next line, it would see the \i\c{EQU} again and be able to determine
1556 the value of \c{symbol1}, but by then it would be too late.
1558 NASM avoids this problem by defining the right-hand side of an
1559 \c{EQU} statement to be a critical expression, so the definition of
1560 \c{symbol1} would be rejected in the first pass.
1562 There is a related issue involving \i{forward references}: consider
1565 \c mov eax,[ebx+offset]
1568 NASM, on pass one, must calculate the size of the instruction \c{mov
1569 eax,[ebx+offset]} without knowing the value of \c{offset}. It has no
1570 way of knowing that \c{offset} is small enough to fit into a
1571 one-byte offset field and that it could therefore get away with
1572 generating a shorter form of the \i{effective-address} encoding; for
1573 all it knows, in pass one, \c{offset} could be a symbol in the code
1574 segment, and it might need the full four-byte form. So it is forced
1575 to compute the size of the instruction to accommodate a four-byte
1576 address part. In pass two, having made this decision, it is now
1577 forced to honour it and keep the instruction large, so the code
1578 generated in this case is not as small as it could have been. This
1579 problem can be solved by defining \c{offset} before using it, or by
1580 forcing byte size in the effective address by coding \c{[byte
1584 \H{locallab} \i{Local Labels}
1586 NASM gives special treatment to symbols beginning with a \i{period}.
1587 A label beginning with a single period is treated as a \e{local}
1588 label, which means that it is associated with the previous non-local
1589 label. So, for example:
1591 \c label1 ; some code
1599 \c label2 ; some code
1607 In the above code fragment, each \c{JNE} instruction jumps to the
1608 line immediately before it, because the two definitions of \c{.loop}
1609 are kept separate by virtue of each being associated with the
1610 previous non-local label.
1612 This form of local label handling is borrowed from the old Amiga
1613 assembler \i{DevPac}; however, NASM goes one step further, in
1614 allowing access to local labels from other parts of the code. This
1615 is achieved by means of \e{defining} a local label in terms of the
1616 previous non-local label: the first definition of \c{.loop} above is
1617 really defining a symbol called \c{label1.loop}, and the second
1618 defines a symbol called \c{label2.loop}. So, if you really needed
1621 \c label3 ; some more code
1626 Sometimes it is useful - in a macro, for instance - to be able to
1627 define a label which can be referenced from anywhere but which
1628 doesn't interfere with the normal local-label mechanism. Such a
1629 label can't be non-local because it would interfere with subsequent
1630 definitions of, and references to, local labels; and it can't be
1631 local because the macro that defined it wouldn't know the label's
1632 full name. NASM therefore introduces a third type of label, which is
1633 probably only useful in macro definitions: if a label begins with
1634 the \I{label prefix}special prefix \i\c{..@}, then it does nothing
1635 to the local label mechanism. So you could code
1637 \c label1: ; a non-local label
1638 \c .local: ; this is really label1.local
1639 \c ..@foo: ; this is a special symbol
1640 \c label2: ; another non-local label
1641 \c .local: ; this is really label2.local
1643 \c jmp ..@foo ; this will jump three lines up
1645 NASM has the capacity to define other special symbols beginning with
1646 a double period: for example, \c{..start} is used to specify the
1647 entry point in the \c{obj} output format (see \k{dotdotstart}).
1650 \C{preproc} The NASM \i{Preprocessor}
1652 NASM contains a powerful \i{macro processor}, which supports
1653 conditional assembly, multi-level file inclusion, two forms of macro
1654 (single-line and multi-line), and a `context stack' mechanism for
1655 extra macro power. Preprocessor directives all begin with a \c{%}
1658 The preprocessor collapses all lines which end with a backslash (\\)
1659 character into a single line. Thus:
1661 \c %define THIS_VERY_LONG_MACRO_NAME_IS_DEFINED_TO \\
1664 will work like a single-line macro without the backslash-newline
1667 \H{slmacro} \i{Single-Line Macros}
1669 \S{define} The Normal Way: \I\c{%idefine}\i\c{%define}
1671 Single-line macros are defined using the \c{%define} preprocessor
1672 directive. The definitions work in a similar way to C; so you can do
1675 \c %define ctrl 0x1F &
1676 \c %define param(a,b) ((a)+(a)*(b))
1678 \c mov byte [param(2,ebx)], ctrl 'D'
1680 which will expand to
1682 \c mov byte [(2)+(2)*(ebx)], 0x1F & 'D'
1684 When the expansion of a single-line macro contains tokens which
1685 invoke another macro, the expansion is performed at invocation time,
1686 not at definition time. Thus the code
1688 \c %define a(x) 1+b(x)
1693 will evaluate in the expected way to \c{mov ax,1+2*8}, even though
1694 the macro \c{b} wasn't defined at the time of definition of \c{a}.
1696 Macros defined with \c{%define} are \i{case sensitive}: after
1697 \c{%define foo bar}, only \c{foo} will expand to \c{bar}: \c{Foo} or
1698 \c{FOO} will not. By using \c{%idefine} instead of \c{%define} (the
1699 `i' stands for `insensitive') you can define all the case variants
1700 of a macro at once, so that \c{%idefine foo bar} would cause
1701 \c{foo}, \c{Foo}, \c{FOO}, \c{fOO} and so on all to expand to
1704 There is a mechanism which detects when a macro call has occurred as
1705 a result of a previous expansion of the same macro, to guard against
1706 \i{circular references} and infinite loops. If this happens, the
1707 preprocessor will only expand the first occurrence of the macro.
1710 \c %define a(x) 1+a(x)
1714 the macro \c{a(3)} will expand once, becoming \c{1+a(3)}, and will
1715 then expand no further. This behaviour can be useful: see \k{32c}
1716 for an example of its use.
1718 You can \I{overloading, single-line macros}overload single-line
1719 macros: if you write
1721 \c %define foo(x) 1+x
1722 \c %define foo(x,y) 1+x*y
1724 the preprocessor will be able to handle both types of macro call,
1725 by counting the parameters you pass; so \c{foo(3)} will become
1726 \c{1+3} whereas \c{foo(ebx,2)} will become \c{1+ebx*2}. However, if
1731 then no other definition of \c{foo} will be accepted: a macro with
1732 no parameters prohibits the definition of the same name as a macro
1733 \e{with} parameters, and vice versa.
1735 This doesn't prevent single-line macros being \e{redefined}: you can
1736 perfectly well define a macro with
1740 and then re-define it later in the same source file with
1744 Then everywhere the macro \c{foo} is invoked, it will be expanded
1745 according to the most recent definition. This is particularly useful
1746 when defining single-line macros with \c{%assign} (see \k{assign}).
1748 You can \i{pre-define} single-line macros using the `-d' option on
1749 the NASM command line: see \k{opt-d}.
1752 \S{xdefine} Enhancing %define: \I\c{%xidefine}\i\c{%xdefine}
1754 To have a reference to an embedded single-line macro resolved at the
1755 time that it is embedded, as opposed to when the calling macro is
1756 expanded, you need a different mechanism to the one offered by
1757 \c{%define}. The solution is to use \c{%xdefine}, or it's
1758 \I{case sensitive}case-insensitive counterpart \c{%xidefine}.
1760 Suppose you have the following code:
1763 \c %define isFalse isTrue
1772 In this case, \c{val1} is equal to 0, and \c{val2} is equal to 1.
1773 This is because, when a single-line macro is defined using
1774 \c{%define}, it is expanded only when it is called. As \c{isFalse}
1775 expands to \c{isTrue}, the expansion will be the current value of
1776 \c{isTrue}. The first time it is called that is 0, and the second
1779 If you wanted \c{isFalse} to expand to the value assigned to the
1780 embedded macro \c{isTrue} at the time that \c{isFalse} was defined,
1781 you need to change the above code to use \c{%xdefine}.
1783 \c %xdefine isTrue 1
1784 \c %xdefine isFalse isTrue
1785 \c %xdefine isTrue 0
1789 \c %xdefine isTrue 1
1793 Now, each time that \c{isFalse} is called, it expands to 1,
1794 as that is what the embedded macro \c{isTrue} expanded to at
1795 the time that \c{isFalse} was defined.
1798 \S{concat%+} Concatenating Single Line Macro Tokens: \i\c{%+}
1800 Individual tokens in single line macros can be concatenated, to produce
1801 longer tokens for later processing. This can be useful if there are
1802 several similar macros that perform similar functions.
1804 As an example, consider the following:
1806 \c %define BDASTART 400h ; Start of BIOS data area
1808 \c struc tBIOSDA ; its structure
1814 Now, if we need to access the elements of tBIOSDA in different places,
1817 \c mov ax,BDASTART + tBIOSDA.COM1addr
1818 \c mov bx,BDASTART + tBIOSDA.COM2addr
1820 This will become pretty ugly (and tedious) if used in many places, and
1821 can be reduced in size significantly by using the following macro:
1823 \c ; Macro to access BIOS variables by their names (from tBDA):
1825 \c %define BDA(x) BDASTART + tBIOSDA. %+ x
1827 Now the above code can be written as:
1829 \c mov ax,BDA(COM1addr)
1830 \c mov bx,BDA(COM2addr)
1832 Using this feature, we can simplify references to a lot of macros (and,
1833 in turn, reduce typing errors).
1836 \S{undef} Undefining macros: \i\c{%undef}
1838 Single-line macros can be removed with the \c{%undef} command. For
1839 example, the following sequence:
1846 will expand to the instruction \c{mov eax, foo}, since after
1847 \c{%undef} the macro \c{foo} is no longer defined.
1849 Macros that would otherwise be pre-defined can be undefined on the
1850 command-line using the `-u' option on the NASM command line: see
1854 \S{assign} \i{Preprocessor Variables}: \i\c{%assign}
1856 An alternative way to define single-line macros is by means of the
1857 \c{%assign} command (and its \I{case sensitive}case-insensitive
1858 counterpart \i\c{%iassign}, which differs from \c{%assign} in
1859 exactly the same way that \c{%idefine} differs from \c{%define}).
1861 \c{%assign} is used to define single-line macros which take no
1862 parameters and have a numeric value. This value can be specified in
1863 the form of an expression, and it will be evaluated once, when the
1864 \c{%assign} directive is processed.
1866 Like \c{%define}, macros defined using \c{%assign} can be re-defined
1867 later, so you can do things like
1871 to increment the numeric value of a macro.
1873 \c{%assign} is useful for controlling the termination of \c{%rep}
1874 preprocessor loops: see \k{rep} for an example of this. Another
1875 use for \c{%assign} is given in \k{16c} and \k{32c}.
1877 The expression passed to \c{%assign} is a \i{critical expression}
1878 (see \k{crit}), and must also evaluate to a pure number (rather than
1879 a relocatable reference such as a code or data address, or anything
1880 involving a register).
1883 \H{strlen} \i{String Handling in Macros}: \i\c{%strlen} and \i\c{%substr}
1885 It's often useful to be able to handle strings in macros. NASM
1886 supports two simple string handling macro operators from which
1887 more complex operations can be constructed.
1890 \S{strlen} \i{String Length}: \i\c{%strlen}
1892 The \c{%strlen} macro is like \c{%assign} macro in that it creates
1893 (or redefines) a numeric value to a macro. The difference is that
1894 with \c{%strlen}, the numeric value is the length of a string. An
1895 example of the use of this would be:
1897 \c %strlen charcnt 'my string'
1899 In this example, \c{charcnt} would receive the value 8, just as
1900 if an \c{%assign} had been used. In this example, \c{'my string'}
1901 was a literal string but it could also have been a single-line
1902 macro that expands to a string, as in the following example:
1904 \c %define sometext 'my string'
1905 \c %strlen charcnt sometext
1907 As in the first case, this would result in \c{charcnt} being
1908 assigned the value of 8.
1911 \S{substr} \i{Sub-strings}: \i\c{%substr}
1913 Individual letters in strings can be extracted using \c{%substr}.
1914 An example of its use is probably more useful than the description:
1916 \c %substr mychar 'xyz' 1 ; equivalent to %define mychar 'x'
1917 \c %substr mychar 'xyz' 2 ; equivalent to %define mychar 'y'
1918 \c %substr mychar 'xyz' 3 ; equivalent to %define mychar 'z'
1920 In this example, mychar gets the value of 'y'. As with \c{%strlen}
1921 (see \k{strlen}), the first parameter is the single-line macro to
1922 be created and the second is the string. The third parameter
1923 specifies which character is to be selected. Note that the first
1924 index is 1, not 0 and the last index is equal to the value that
1925 \c{%strlen} would assign given the same string. Index values out
1926 of range result in an empty string.
1929 \H{mlmacro} \i{Multi-Line Macros}: \I\c{%imacro}\i\c{%macro}
1931 Multi-line macros are much more like the type of macro seen in MASM
1932 and TASM: a multi-line macro definition in NASM looks something like
1935 \c %macro prologue 1
1943 This defines a C-like function prologue as a macro: so you would
1944 invoke the macro with a call such as
1946 \c myfunc: prologue 12
1948 which would expand to the three lines of code
1954 The number \c{1} after the macro name in the \c{%macro} line defines
1955 the number of parameters the macro \c{prologue} expects to receive.
1956 The use of \c{%1} inside the macro definition refers to the first
1957 parameter to the macro call. With a macro taking more than one
1958 parameter, subsequent parameters would be referred to as \c{%2},
1961 Multi-line macros, like single-line macros, are \i{case-sensitive},
1962 unless you define them using the alternative directive \c{%imacro}.
1964 If you need to pass a comma as \e{part} of a parameter to a
1965 multi-line macro, you can do that by enclosing the entire parameter
1966 in \I{braces, around macro parameters}braces. So you could code
1975 \c silly 'a', letter_a ; letter_a: db 'a'
1976 \c silly 'ab', string_ab ; string_ab: db 'ab'
1977 \c silly {13,10}, crlf ; crlf: db 13,10
1980 \S{mlmacover} Overloading Multi-Line Macros\I{overloading, multi-line macros}
1982 As with single-line macros, multi-line macros can be overloaded by
1983 defining the same macro name several times with different numbers of
1984 parameters. This time, no exception is made for macros with no
1985 parameters at all. So you could define
1987 \c %macro prologue 0
1994 to define an alternative form of the function prologue which
1995 allocates no local stack space.
1997 Sometimes, however, you might want to `overload' a machine
1998 instruction; for example, you might want to define
2007 so that you could code
2009 \c push ebx ; this line is not a macro call
2010 \c push eax,ecx ; but this one is
2012 Ordinarily, NASM will give a warning for the first of the above two
2013 lines, since \c{push} is now defined to be a macro, and is being
2014 invoked with a number of parameters for which no definition has been
2015 given. The correct code will still be generated, but the assembler
2016 will give a warning. This warning can be disabled by the use of the
2017 \c{-w-macro-params} command-line option (see \k{opt-w}).
2020 \S{maclocal} \i{Macro-Local Labels}
2022 NASM allows you to define labels within a multi-line macro
2023 definition in such a way as to make them local to the macro call: so
2024 calling the same macro multiple times will use a different label
2025 each time. You do this by prefixing \i\c{%%} to the label name. So
2026 you can invent an instruction which executes a \c{RET} if the \c{Z}
2027 flag is set by doing this:
2037 You can call this macro as many times as you want, and every time
2038 you call it NASM will make up a different `real' name to substitute
2039 for the label \c{%%skip}. The names NASM invents are of the form
2040 \c{..@2345.skip}, where the number 2345 changes with every macro
2041 call. The \i\c{..@} prefix prevents macro-local labels from
2042 interfering with the local label mechanism, as described in
2043 \k{locallab}. You should avoid defining your own labels in this form
2044 (the \c{..@} prefix, then a number, then another period) in case
2045 they interfere with macro-local labels.
2048 \S{mlmacgre} \i{Greedy Macro Parameters}
2050 Occasionally it is useful to define a macro which lumps its entire
2051 command line into one parameter definition, possibly after
2052 extracting one or two smaller parameters from the front. An example
2053 might be a macro to write a text string to a file in MS-DOS, where
2054 you might want to be able to write
2056 \c writefile [filehandle],"hello, world",13,10
2058 NASM allows you to define the last parameter of a macro to be
2059 \e{greedy}, meaning that if you invoke the macro with more
2060 parameters than it expects, all the spare parameters get lumped into
2061 the last defined one along with the separating commas. So if you
2064 \c %macro writefile 2+
2070 \c mov cx,%%endstr-%%str
2077 then the example call to \c{writefile} above will work as expected:
2078 the text before the first comma, \c{[filehandle]}, is used as the
2079 first macro parameter and expanded when \c{%1} is referred to, and
2080 all the subsequent text is lumped into \c{%2} and placed after the
2083 The greedy nature of the macro is indicated to NASM by the use of
2084 the \I{+ modifier}\c{+} sign after the parameter count on the
2087 If you define a greedy macro, you are effectively telling NASM how
2088 it should expand the macro given \e{any} number of parameters from
2089 the actual number specified up to infinity; in this case, for
2090 example, NASM now knows what to do when it sees a call to
2091 \c{writefile} with 2, 3, 4 or more parameters. NASM will take this
2092 into account when overloading macros, and will not allow you to
2093 define another form of \c{writefile} taking 4 parameters (for
2096 Of course, the above macro could have been implemented as a
2097 non-greedy macro, in which case the call to it would have had to
2100 \c writefile [filehandle], {"hello, world",13,10}
2102 NASM provides both mechanisms for putting \i{commas in macro
2103 parameters}, and you choose which one you prefer for each macro
2106 See \k{sectmac} for a better way to write the above macro.
2109 \S{mlmacdef} \i{Default Macro Parameters}
2111 NASM also allows you to define a multi-line macro with a \e{range}
2112 of allowable parameter counts. If you do this, you can specify
2113 defaults for \i{omitted parameters}. So, for example:
2115 \c %macro die 0-1 "Painful program death has occurred."
2123 This macro (which makes use of the \c{writefile} macro defined in
2124 \k{mlmacgre}) can be called with an explicit error message, which it
2125 will display on the error output stream before exiting, or it can be
2126 called with no parameters, in which case it will use the default
2127 error message supplied in the macro definition.
2129 In general, you supply a minimum and maximum number of parameters
2130 for a macro of this type; the minimum number of parameters are then
2131 required in the macro call, and then you provide defaults for the
2132 optional ones. So if a macro definition began with the line
2134 \c %macro foobar 1-3 eax,[ebx+2]
2136 then it could be called with between one and three parameters, and
2137 \c{%1} would always be taken from the macro call. \c{%2}, if not
2138 specified by the macro call, would default to \c{eax}, and \c{%3} if
2139 not specified would default to \c{[ebx+2]}.
2141 You may omit parameter defaults from the macro definition, in which
2142 case the parameter default is taken to be blank. This can be useful
2143 for macros which can take a variable number of parameters, since the
2144 \i\c{%0} token (see \k{percent0}) allows you to determine how many
2145 parameters were really passed to the macro call.
2147 This defaulting mechanism can be combined with the greedy-parameter
2148 mechanism; so the \c{die} macro above could be made more powerful,
2149 and more useful, by changing the first line of the definition to
2151 \c %macro die 0-1+ "Painful program death has occurred.",13,10
2153 The maximum parameter count can be infinite, denoted by \c{*}. In
2154 this case, of course, it is impossible to provide a \e{full} set of
2155 default parameters. Examples of this usage are shown in \k{rotate}.
2158 \S{percent0} \i\c{%0}: \I{counting macro parameters}Macro Parameter Counter
2160 For a macro which can take a variable number of parameters, the
2161 parameter reference \c{%0} will return a numeric constant giving the
2162 number of parameters passed to the macro. This can be used as an
2163 argument to \c{%rep} (see \k{rep}) in order to iterate through all
2164 the parameters of a macro. Examples are given in \k{rotate}.
2167 \S{rotate} \i\c{%rotate}: \i{Rotating Macro Parameters}
2169 Unix shell programmers will be familiar with the \I{shift
2170 command}\c{shift} shell command, which allows the arguments passed
2171 to a shell script (referenced as \c{$1}, \c{$2} and so on) to be
2172 moved left by one place, so that the argument previously referenced
2173 as \c{$2} becomes available as \c{$1}, and the argument previously
2174 referenced as \c{$1} is no longer available at all.
2176 NASM provides a similar mechanism, in the form of \c{%rotate}. As
2177 its name suggests, it differs from the Unix \c{shift} in that no
2178 parameters are lost: parameters rotated off the left end of the
2179 argument list reappear on the right, and vice versa.
2181 \c{%rotate} is invoked with a single numeric argument (which may be
2182 an expression). The macro parameters are rotated to the left by that
2183 many places. If the argument to \c{%rotate} is negative, the macro
2184 parameters are rotated to the right.
2186 \I{iterating over macro parameters}So a pair of macros to save and
2187 restore a set of registers might work as follows:
2189 \c %macro multipush 1-*
2198 This macro invokes the \c{PUSH} instruction on each of its arguments
2199 in turn, from left to right. It begins by pushing its first
2200 argument, \c{%1}, then invokes \c{%rotate} to move all the arguments
2201 one place to the left, so that the original second argument is now
2202 available as \c{%1}. Repeating this procedure as many times as there
2203 were arguments (achieved by supplying \c{%0} as the argument to
2204 \c{%rep}) causes each argument in turn to be pushed.
2206 Note also the use of \c{*} as the maximum parameter count,
2207 indicating that there is no upper limit on the number of parameters
2208 you may supply to the \i\c{multipush} macro.
2210 It would be convenient, when using this macro, to have a \c{POP}
2211 equivalent, which \e{didn't} require the arguments to be given in
2212 reverse order. Ideally, you would write the \c{multipush} macro
2213 call, then cut-and-paste the line to where the pop needed to be
2214 done, and change the name of the called macro to \c{multipop}, and
2215 the macro would take care of popping the registers in the opposite
2216 order from the one in which they were pushed.
2218 This can be done by the following definition:
2220 \c %macro multipop 1-*
2229 This macro begins by rotating its arguments one place to the
2230 \e{right}, so that the original \e{last} argument appears as \c{%1}.
2231 This is then popped, and the arguments are rotated right again, so
2232 the second-to-last argument becomes \c{%1}. Thus the arguments are
2233 iterated through in reverse order.
2236 \S{concat} \i{Concatenating Macro Parameters}
2238 NASM can concatenate macro parameters on to other text surrounding
2239 them. This allows you to declare a family of symbols, for example,
2240 in a macro definition. If, for example, you wanted to generate a
2241 table of key codes along with offsets into the table, you could code
2244 \c %macro keytab_entry 2
2246 \c keypos%1 equ $-keytab
2252 \c keytab_entry F1,128+1
2253 \c keytab_entry F2,128+2
2254 \c keytab_entry Return,13
2256 which would expand to
2259 \c keyposF1 equ $-keytab
2261 \c keyposF2 equ $-keytab
2263 \c keyposReturn equ $-keytab
2266 You can just as easily concatenate text on to the other end of a
2267 macro parameter, by writing \c{%1foo}.
2269 If you need to append a \e{digit} to a macro parameter, for example
2270 defining labels \c{foo1} and \c{foo2} when passed the parameter
2271 \c{foo}, you can't code \c{%11} because that would be taken as the
2272 eleventh macro parameter. Instead, you must code
2273 \I{braces, after % sign}\c{%\{1\}1}, which will separate the first
2274 \c{1} (giving the number of the macro parameter) from the second
2275 (literal text to be concatenated to the parameter).
2277 This concatenation can also be applied to other preprocessor in-line
2278 objects, such as macro-local labels (\k{maclocal}) and context-local
2279 labels (\k{ctxlocal}). In all cases, ambiguities in syntax can be
2280 resolved by enclosing everything after the \c{%} sign and before the
2281 literal text in braces: so \c{%\{%foo\}bar} concatenates the text
2282 \c{bar} to the end of the real name of the macro-local label
2283 \c{%%foo}. (This is unnecessary, since the form NASM uses for the
2284 real names of macro-local labels means that the two usages
2285 \c{%\{%foo\}bar} and \c{%%foobar} would both expand to the same
2286 thing anyway; nevertheless, the capability is there.)
2289 \S{mlmaccc} \i{Condition Codes as Macro Parameters}
2291 NASM can give special treatment to a macro parameter which contains
2292 a condition code. For a start, you can refer to the macro parameter
2293 \c{%1} by means of the alternative syntax \i\c{%+1}, which informs
2294 NASM that this macro parameter is supposed to contain a condition
2295 code, and will cause the preprocessor to report an error message if
2296 the macro is called with a parameter which is \e{not} a valid
2299 Far more usefully, though, you can refer to the macro parameter by
2300 means of \i\c{%-1}, which NASM will expand as the \e{inverse}
2301 condition code. So the \c{retz} macro defined in \k{maclocal} can be
2302 replaced by a general \i{conditional-return macro} like this:
2312 This macro can now be invoked using calls like \c{retc ne}, which
2313 will cause the conditional-jump instruction in the macro expansion
2314 to come out as \c{JE}, or \c{retc po} which will make the jump a
2317 The \c{%+1} macro-parameter reference is quite happy to interpret
2318 the arguments \c{CXZ} and \c{ECXZ} as valid condition codes;
2319 however, \c{%-1} will report an error if passed either of these,
2320 because no inverse condition code exists.
2323 \S{nolist} \i{Disabling Listing Expansion}\I\c{.nolist}
2325 When NASM is generating a listing file from your program, it will
2326 generally expand multi-line macros by means of writing the macro
2327 call and then listing each line of the expansion. This allows you to
2328 see which instructions in the macro expansion are generating what
2329 code; however, for some macros this clutters the listing up
2332 NASM therefore provides the \c{.nolist} qualifier, which you can
2333 include in a macro definition to inhibit the expansion of the macro
2334 in the listing file. The \c{.nolist} qualifier comes directly after
2335 the number of parameters, like this:
2337 \c %macro foo 1.nolist
2341 \c %macro bar 1-5+.nolist a,b,c,d,e,f,g,h
2343 \H{condasm} \i{Conditional Assembly}\I\c{%if}
2345 Similarly to the C preprocessor, NASM allows sections of a source
2346 file to be assembled only if certain conditions are met. The general
2347 syntax of this feature looks like this:
2350 \c ; some code which only appears if <condition> is met
2351 \c %elif<condition2>
2352 \c ; only appears if <condition> is not met but <condition2> is
2354 \c ; this appears if neither <condition> nor <condition2> was met
2357 The \i\c{%else} clause is optional, as is the \i\c{%elif} clause.
2358 You can have more than one \c{%elif} clause as well.
2361 \S{ifdef} \i\c{%ifdef}: Testing Single-Line Macro Existence\I{testing,
2362 single-line macro existence}
2364 Beginning a conditional-assembly block with the line \c{%ifdef
2365 MACRO} will assemble the subsequent code if, and only if, a
2366 single-line macro called \c{MACRO} is defined. If not, then the
2367 \c{%elif} and \c{%else} blocks (if any) will be processed instead.
2369 For example, when debugging a program, you might want to write code
2372 \c ; perform some function
2374 \c writefile 2,"Function performed successfully",13,10
2376 \c ; go and do something else
2378 Then you could use the command-line option \c{-dDEBUG} to create a
2379 version of the program which produced debugging messages, and remove
2380 the option to generate the final release version of the program.
2382 You can test for a macro \e{not} being defined by using
2383 \i\c{%ifndef} instead of \c{%ifdef}. You can also test for macro
2384 definitions in \c{%elif} blocks by using \i\c{%elifdef} and
2388 \S{ifmacro} \i\c{ifmacro}: Testing Multi-Line Macro
2389 Existence\I{testing, multi-line macro existence}
2391 The \c{%ifmacro} directive operates in the same way as the \c{%ifdef}
2392 directive, except that it checks for the existence of a multi-line macro.
2394 For example, you may be working with a large project and not have control
2395 over the macros in a library. You may want to create a macro with one
2396 name if it doesn't already exist, and another name if one with that name
2399 The \c{%ifmacro} is considered true if defining a macro with the given name
2400 and number of arguments would cause a definitions conflict. For example:
2402 \c %ifmacro MyMacro 1-3
2404 \c %error "MyMacro 1-3" causes a conflict with an existing macro.
2408 \c %macro MyMacro 1-3
2410 \c ; insert code to define the macro
2416 This will create the macro "MyMacro 1-3" if no macro already exists which
2417 would conflict with it, and emits a warning if there would be a definition
2420 You can test for the macro not existing by using the \i\c{%ifnmacro} instead
2421 of \c{%ifmacro}. Additional tests can be performed in \c{%elif} blocks by using
2422 \i\c{%elifmacro} and \i\c{%elifnmacro}.
2425 \S{ifctx} \i\c{%ifctx}: Testing the Context Stack\I{testing, context
2428 The conditional-assembly construct \c{%ifctx ctxname} will cause the
2429 subsequent code to be assembled if and only if the top context on
2430 the preprocessor's context stack has the name \c{ctxname}. As with
2431 \c{%ifdef}, the inverse and \c{%elif} forms \i\c{%ifnctx},
2432 \i\c{%elifctx} and \i\c{%elifnctx} are also supported.
2434 For more details of the context stack, see \k{ctxstack}. For a
2435 sample use of \c{%ifctx}, see \k{blockif}.
2438 \S{if} \i\c{%if}: Testing Arbitrary Numeric Expressions\I{testing,
2439 arbitrary numeric expressions}
2441 The conditional-assembly construct \c{%if expr} will cause the
2442 subsequent code to be assembled if and only if the value of the
2443 numeric expression \c{expr} is non-zero. An example of the use of
2444 this feature is in deciding when to break out of a \c{%rep}
2445 preprocessor loop: see \k{rep} for a detailed example.
2447 The expression given to \c{%if}, and its counterpart \i\c{%elif}, is
2448 a critical expression (see \k{crit}).
2450 \c{%if} extends the normal NASM expression syntax, by providing a
2451 set of \i{relational operators} which are not normally available in
2452 expressions. The operators \i\c{=}, \i\c{<}, \i\c{>}, \i\c{<=},
2453 \i\c{>=} and \i\c{<>} test equality, less-than, greater-than,
2454 less-or-equal, greater-or-equal and not-equal respectively. The
2455 C-like forms \i\c{==} and \i\c{!=} are supported as alternative
2456 forms of \c{=} and \c{<>}. In addition, low-priority logical
2457 operators \i\c{&&}, \i\c{^^} and \i\c{||} are provided, supplying
2458 \i{logical AND}, \i{logical XOR} and \i{logical OR}. These work like
2459 the C logical operators (although C has no logical XOR), in that
2460 they always return either 0 or 1, and treat any non-zero input as 1
2461 (so that \c{^^}, for example, returns 1 if exactly one of its inputs
2462 is zero, and 0 otherwise). The relational operators also return 1
2463 for true and 0 for false.
2466 \S{ifidn} \i\c{%ifidn} and \i\c{%ifidni}: Testing Exact Text
2467 Identity\I{testing, exact text identity}
2469 The construct \c{%ifidn text1,text2} will cause the subsequent code
2470 to be assembled if and only if \c{text1} and \c{text2}, after
2471 expanding single-line macros, are identical pieces of text.
2472 Differences in white space are not counted.
2474 \c{%ifidni} is similar to \c{%ifidn}, but is \i{case-insensitive}.
2476 For example, the following macro pushes a register or number on the
2477 stack, and allows you to treat \c{IP} as a real register:
2479 \c %macro pushparam 1
2490 Like most other \c{%if} constructs, \c{%ifidn} has a counterpart
2491 \i\c{%elifidn}, and negative forms \i\c{%ifnidn} and \i\c{%elifnidn}.
2492 Similarly, \c{%ifidni} has counterparts \i\c{%elifidni},
2493 \i\c{%ifnidni} and \i\c{%elifnidni}.
2496 \S{iftyp} \i\c{%ifid}, \i\c{%ifnum}, \i\c{%ifstr}: Testing Token
2497 Types\I{testing, token types}
2499 Some macros will want to perform different tasks depending on
2500 whether they are passed a number, a string, or an identifier. For
2501 example, a string output macro might want to be able to cope with
2502 being passed either a string constant or a pointer to an existing
2505 The conditional assembly construct \c{%ifid}, taking one parameter
2506 (which may be blank), assembles the subsequent code if and only if
2507 the first token in the parameter exists and is an identifier.
2508 \c{%ifnum} works similarly, but tests for the token being a numeric
2509 constant; \c{%ifstr} tests for it being a string.
2511 For example, the \c{writefile} macro defined in \k{mlmacgre} can be
2512 extended to take advantage of \c{%ifstr} in the following fashion:
2514 \c %macro writefile 2-3+
2523 \c %%endstr: mov dx,%%str
2524 \c mov cx,%%endstr-%%str
2535 Then the \c{writefile} macro can cope with being called in either of
2536 the following two ways:
2538 \c writefile [file], strpointer, length
2539 \c writefile [file], "hello", 13, 10
2541 In the first, \c{strpointer} is used as the address of an
2542 already-declared string, and \c{length} is used as its length; in
2543 the second, a string is given to the macro, which therefore declares
2544 it itself and works out the address and length for itself.
2546 Note the use of \c{%if} inside the \c{%ifstr}: this is to detect
2547 whether the macro was passed two arguments (so the string would be a
2548 single string constant, and \c{db %2} would be adequate) or more (in
2549 which case, all but the first two would be lumped together into
2550 \c{%3}, and \c{db %2,%3} would be required).
2552 \I\c{%ifnid}\I\c{%elifid}\I\c{%elifnid}\I\c{%ifnnum}\I\c{%elifnum}
2553 \I\c{%elifnnum}\I\c{%ifnstr}\I\c{%elifstr}\I\c{%elifnstr}
2554 The usual \c{%elifXXX}, \c{%ifnXXX} and \c{%elifnXXX} versions exist
2555 for each of \c{%ifid}, \c{%ifnum} and \c{%ifstr}.
2558 \S{pperror} \i\c{%error}: Reporting \i{User-Defined Errors}
2560 The preprocessor directive \c{%error} will cause NASM to report an
2561 error if it occurs in assembled code. So if other users are going to
2562 try to assemble your source files, you can ensure that they define
2563 the right macros by means of code like this:
2565 \c %ifdef SOME_MACRO
2567 \c %elifdef SOME_OTHER_MACRO
2568 \c ; do some different setup
2570 \c %error Neither SOME_MACRO nor SOME_OTHER_MACRO was defined.
2573 Then any user who fails to understand the way your code is supposed
2574 to be assembled will be quickly warned of their mistake, rather than
2575 having to wait until the program crashes on being run and then not
2576 knowing what went wrong.
2579 \H{rep} \i{Preprocessor Loops}\I{repeating code}: \i\c{%rep}
2581 NASM's \c{TIMES} prefix, though useful, cannot be used to invoke a
2582 multi-line macro multiple times, because it is processed by NASM
2583 after macros have already been expanded. Therefore NASM provides
2584 another form of loop, this time at the preprocessor level: \c{%rep}.
2586 The directives \c{%rep} and \i\c{%endrep} (\c{%rep} takes a numeric
2587 argument, which can be an expression; \c{%endrep} takes no
2588 arguments) can be used to enclose a chunk of code, which is then
2589 replicated as many times as specified by the preprocessor:
2593 \c inc word [table+2*i]
2597 This will generate a sequence of 64 \c{INC} instructions,
2598 incrementing every word of memory from \c{[table]} to
2601 For more complex termination conditions, or to break out of a repeat
2602 loop part way along, you can use the \i\c{%exitrep} directive to
2603 terminate the loop, like this:
2618 \c fib_number equ ($-fibonacci)/2
2620 This produces a list of all the Fibonacci numbers that will fit in
2621 16 bits. Note that a maximum repeat count must still be given to
2622 \c{%rep}. This is to prevent the possibility of NASM getting into an
2623 infinite loop in the preprocessor, which (on multitasking or
2624 multi-user systems) would typically cause all the system memory to
2625 be gradually used up and other applications to start crashing.
2628 \H{include} \i{Including Other Files}
2630 Using, once again, a very similar syntax to the C preprocessor,
2631 NASM's preprocessor lets you include other source files into your
2632 code. This is done by the use of the \i\c{%include} directive:
2634 \c %include "macros.mac"
2636 will include the contents of the file \c{macros.mac} into the source
2637 file containing the \c{%include} directive.
2639 Include files are \I{searching for include files}searched for in the
2640 current directory (the directory you're in when you run NASM, as
2641 opposed to the location of the NASM executable or the location of
2642 the source file), plus any directories specified on the NASM command
2643 line using the \c{-i} option.
2645 The standard C idiom for preventing a file being included more than
2646 once is just as applicable in NASM: if the file \c{macros.mac} has
2649 \c %ifndef MACROS_MAC
2650 \c %define MACROS_MAC
2651 \c ; now define some macros
2654 then including the file more than once will not cause errors,
2655 because the second time the file is included nothing will happen
2656 because the macro \c{MACROS_MAC} will already be defined.
2658 You can force a file to be included even if there is no \c{%include}
2659 directive that explicitly includes it, by using the \i\c{-p} option
2660 on the NASM command line (see \k{opt-p}).
2663 \H{ctxstack} The \i{Context Stack}
2665 Having labels that are local to a macro definition is sometimes not
2666 quite powerful enough: sometimes you want to be able to share labels
2667 between several macro calls. An example might be a \c{REPEAT} ...
2668 \c{UNTIL} loop, in which the expansion of the \c{REPEAT} macro
2669 would need to be able to refer to a label which the \c{UNTIL} macro
2670 had defined. However, for such a macro you would also want to be
2671 able to nest these loops.
2673 NASM provides this level of power by means of a \e{context stack}.
2674 The preprocessor maintains a stack of \e{contexts}, each of which is
2675 characterised by a name. You add a new context to the stack using
2676 the \i\c{%push} directive, and remove one using \i\c{%pop}. You can
2677 define labels that are local to a particular context on the stack.
2680 \S{pushpop} \i\c{%push} and \i\c{%pop}: \I{creating
2681 contexts}\I{removing contexts}Creating and Removing Contexts
2683 The \c{%push} directive is used to create a new context and place it
2684 on the top of the context stack. \c{%push} requires one argument,
2685 which is the name of the context. For example:
2689 This pushes a new context called \c{foobar} on the stack. You can
2690 have several contexts on the stack with the same name: they can
2691 still be distinguished.
2693 The directive \c{%pop}, requiring no arguments, removes the top
2694 context from the context stack and destroys it, along with any
2695 labels associated with it.
2698 \S{ctxlocal} \i{Context-Local Labels}
2700 Just as the usage \c{%%foo} defines a label which is local to the
2701 particular macro call in which it is used, the usage \I{%$}\c{%$foo}
2702 is used to define a label which is local to the context on the top
2703 of the context stack. So the \c{REPEAT} and \c{UNTIL} example given
2704 above could be implemented by means of:
2720 and invoked by means of, for example,
2728 which would scan every fourth byte of a string in search of the byte
2731 If you need to define, or access, labels local to the context
2732 \e{below} the top one on the stack, you can use \I{%$$}\c{%$$foo}, or
2733 \c{%$$$foo} for the context below that, and so on.
2736 \S{ctxdefine} \i{Context-Local Single-Line Macros}
2738 NASM also allows you to define single-line macros which are local to
2739 a particular context, in just the same way:
2741 \c %define %$localmac 3
2743 will define the single-line macro \c{%$localmac} to be local to the
2744 top context on the stack. Of course, after a subsequent \c{%push},
2745 it can then still be accessed by the name \c{%$$localmac}.
2748 \S{ctxrepl} \i\c{%repl}: \I{renaming contexts}Renaming a Context
2750 If you need to change the name of the top context on the stack (in
2751 order, for example, to have it respond differently to \c{%ifctx}),
2752 you can execute a \c{%pop} followed by a \c{%push}; but this will
2753 have the side effect of destroying all context-local labels and
2754 macros associated with the context that was just popped.
2756 NASM provides the directive \c{%repl}, which \e{replaces} a context
2757 with a different name, without touching the associated macros and
2758 labels. So you could replace the destructive code
2763 with the non-destructive version \c{%repl newname}.
2766 \S{blockif} Example Use of the \i{Context Stack}: \i{Block IFs}
2768 This example makes use of almost all the context-stack features,
2769 including the conditional-assembly construct \i\c{%ifctx}, to
2770 implement a block IF statement as a set of macros.
2786 \c %error "expected `if' before `else'"
2800 \c %error "expected `if' or `else' before `endif'"
2805 This code is more robust than the \c{REPEAT} and \c{UNTIL} macros
2806 given in \k{ctxlocal}, because it uses conditional assembly to check
2807 that the macros are issued in the right order (for example, not
2808 calling \c{endif} before \c{if}) and issues a \c{%error} if they're
2811 In addition, the \c{endif} macro has to be able to cope with the two
2812 distinct cases of either directly following an \c{if}, or following
2813 an \c{else}. It achieves this, again, by using conditional assembly
2814 to do different things depending on whether the context on top of
2815 the stack is \c{if} or \c{else}.
2817 The \c{else} macro has to preserve the context on the stack, in
2818 order to have the \c{%$ifnot} referred to by the \c{if} macro be the
2819 same as the one defined by the \c{endif} macro, but has to change
2820 the context's name so that \c{endif} will know there was an
2821 intervening \c{else}. It does this by the use of \c{%repl}.
2823 A sample usage of these macros might look like:
2845 The block-\c{IF} macros handle nesting quite happily, by means of
2846 pushing another context, describing the inner \c{if}, on top of the
2847 one describing the outer \c{if}; thus \c{else} and \c{endif} always
2848 refer to the last unmatched \c{if} or \c{else}.
2851 \H{stdmac} \i{Standard Macros}
2853 NASM defines a set of standard macros, which are already defined
2854 when it starts to process any source file. If you really need a
2855 program to be assembled with no pre-defined macros, you can use the
2856 \i\c{%clear} directive to empty the preprocessor of everything.
2858 Most \i{user-level assembler directives} (see \k{directive}) are
2859 implemented as macros which invoke primitive directives; these are
2860 described in \k{directive}. The rest of the standard macro set is
2864 \S{stdmacver} \i\c{__NASM_MAJOR__}, \i\c{__NASM_MINOR__},
2865 \i\c{__NASM_SUBMINOR__} and \i\c{___NASM_PATCHLEVEL__}: \i{NASM Version}
2867 The single-line macros \c{__NASM_MAJOR__}, \c{__NASM_MINOR__},
2868 \c{__NASM_SUBMINOR__} and \c{___NASM_PATCHLEVEL__} expand to the
2869 major, minor, subminor and patch level parts of the \i{version
2870 number of NASM} being used. So, under NASM 0.98.32p1 for
2871 example, \c{__NASM_MAJOR__} would be defined to be 0, \c{__NASM_MINOR__}
2872 would be defined as 98, \c{__NASM_SUBMINOR__} would be defined to 32,
2873 and \c{___NASM_PATCHLEVEL__} would be defined as 1.
2876 \S{stdmacverid} \i\c{__NASM_VERSION_ID__}: \i{NASM Version ID}
2878 The single-line macro \c{__NASM_VERSION_ID__} expands to a dword integer
2879 representing the full version number of the version of nasm being used.
2880 The value is the equivalent to \c{__NASM_MAJOR__}, \c{__NASM_MINOR__},
2881 \c{__NASM_SUBMINOR__} and \c{___NASM_PATCHLEVEL__} concatenated to
2882 produce a single doubleword. Hence, for 0.98.32p1, the returned number
2883 would be equivalent to:
2891 Note that the above lines are generate exactly the same code, the second
2892 line is used just to give an indication of the order that the separate
2893 values will be present in memory.
2896 \S{stdmacverstr} \i\c{__NASM_VER__}: \i{NASM Version string}
2898 The single-line macro \c{__NASM_VER__} expands to a string which defines
2899 the version number of nasm being used. So, under NASM 0.98.32 for example,
2908 \S{fileline} \i\c{__FILE__} and \i\c{__LINE__}: File Name and Line Number
2910 Like the C preprocessor, NASM allows the user to find out the file
2911 name and line number containing the current instruction. The macro
2912 \c{__FILE__} expands to a string constant giving the name of the
2913 current input file (which may change through the course of assembly
2914 if \c{%include} directives are used), and \c{__LINE__} expands to a
2915 numeric constant giving the current line number in the input file.
2917 These macros could be used, for example, to communicate debugging
2918 information to a macro, since invoking \c{__LINE__} inside a macro
2919 definition (either single-line or multi-line) will return the line
2920 number of the macro \e{call}, rather than \e{definition}. So to
2921 determine where in a piece of code a crash is occurring, for
2922 example, one could write a routine \c{stillhere}, which is passed a
2923 line number in \c{EAX} and outputs something like `line 155: still
2924 here'. You could then write a macro
2926 \c %macro notdeadyet 0
2935 and then pepper your code with calls to \c{notdeadyet} until you
2936 find the crash point.
2939 \S{struc} \i\c{STRUC} and \i\c{ENDSTRUC}: \i{Declaring Structure} Data Types
2941 The core of NASM contains no intrinsic means of defining data
2942 structures; instead, the preprocessor is sufficiently powerful that
2943 data structures can be implemented as a set of macros. The macros
2944 \c{STRUC} and \c{ENDSTRUC} are used to define a structure data type.
2946 \c{STRUC} takes one parameter, which is the name of the data type.
2947 This name is defined as a symbol with the value zero, and also has
2948 the suffix \c{_size} appended to it and is then defined as an
2949 \c{EQU} giving the size of the structure. Once \c{STRUC} has been
2950 issued, you are defining the structure, and should define fields
2951 using the \c{RESB} family of pseudo-instructions, and then invoke
2952 \c{ENDSTRUC} to finish the definition.
2954 For example, to define a structure called \c{mytype} containing a
2955 longword, a word, a byte and a string of bytes, you might code
2966 The above code defines six symbols: \c{mt_long} as 0 (the offset
2967 from the beginning of a \c{mytype} structure to the longword field),
2968 \c{mt_word} as 4, \c{mt_byte} as 6, \c{mt_str} as 7, \c{mytype_size}
2969 as 39, and \c{mytype} itself as zero.
2971 The reason why the structure type name is defined at zero is a side
2972 effect of allowing structures to work with the local label
2973 mechanism: if your structure members tend to have the same names in
2974 more than one structure, you can define the above structure like this:
2985 This defines the offsets to the structure fields as \c{mytype.long},
2986 \c{mytype.word}, \c{mytype.byte} and \c{mytype.str}.
2988 NASM, since it has no \e{intrinsic} structure support, does not
2989 support any form of period notation to refer to the elements of a
2990 structure once you have one (except the above local-label notation),
2991 so code such as \c{mov ax,[mystruc.mt_word]} is not valid.
2992 \c{mt_word} is a constant just like any other constant, so the
2993 correct syntax is \c{mov ax,[mystruc+mt_word]} or \c{mov
2994 ax,[mystruc+mytype.word]}.
2997 \S{istruc} \i\c{ISTRUC}, \i\c{AT} and \i\c{IEND}: Declaring
2998 \i{Instances of Structures}
3000 Having defined a structure type, the next thing you typically want
3001 to do is to declare instances of that structure in your data
3002 segment. NASM provides an easy way to do this in the \c{ISTRUC}
3003 mechanism. To declare a structure of type \c{mytype} in a program,
3004 you code something like this:
3009 \c at mt_long, dd 123456
3010 \c at mt_word, dw 1024
3011 \c at mt_byte, db 'x'
3012 \c at mt_str, db 'hello, world', 13, 10, 0
3016 The function of the \c{AT} macro is to make use of the \c{TIMES}
3017 prefix to advance the assembly position to the correct point for the
3018 specified structure field, and then to declare the specified data.
3019 Therefore the structure fields must be declared in the same order as
3020 they were specified in the structure definition.
3022 If the data to go in a structure field requires more than one source
3023 line to specify, the remaining source lines can easily come after
3024 the \c{AT} line. For example:
3026 \c at mt_str, db 123,134,145,156,167,178,189
3029 Depending on personal taste, you can also omit the code part of the
3030 \c{AT} line completely, and start the structure field on the next
3034 \c db 'hello, world'
3038 \S{align} \i\c{ALIGN} and \i\c{ALIGNB}: Data Alignment
3040 The \c{ALIGN} and \c{ALIGNB} macros provides a convenient way to
3041 align code or data on a word, longword, paragraph or other boundary.
3042 (Some assemblers call this directive \i\c{EVEN}.) The syntax of the
3043 \c{ALIGN} and \c{ALIGNB} macros is
3045 \c align 4 ; align on 4-byte boundary
3046 \c align 16 ; align on 16-byte boundary
3047 \c align 8,db 0 ; pad with 0s rather than NOPs
3048 \c align 4,resb 1 ; align to 4 in the BSS
3049 \c alignb 4 ; equivalent to previous line
3051 Both macros require their first argument to be a power of two; they
3052 both compute the number of additional bytes required to bring the
3053 length of the current section up to a multiple of that power of two,
3054 and then apply the \c{TIMES} prefix to their second argument to
3055 perform the alignment.
3057 If the second argument is not specified, the default for \c{ALIGN}
3058 is \c{NOP}, and the default for \c{ALIGNB} is \c{RESB 1}. So if the
3059 second argument is specified, the two macros are equivalent.
3060 Normally, you can just use \c{ALIGN} in code and data sections and
3061 \c{ALIGNB} in BSS sections, and never need the second argument
3062 except for special purposes.
3064 \c{ALIGN} and \c{ALIGNB}, being simple macros, perform no error
3065 checking: they cannot warn you if their first argument fails to be a
3066 power of two, or if their second argument generates more than one
3067 byte of code. In each of these cases they will silently do the wrong
3070 \c{ALIGNB} (or \c{ALIGN} with a second argument of \c{RESB 1}) can
3071 be used within structure definitions:
3088 This will ensure that the structure members are sensibly aligned
3089 relative to the base of the structure.
3091 A final caveat: \c{ALIGN} and \c{ALIGNB} work relative to the
3092 beginning of the \e{section}, not the beginning of the address space
3093 in the final executable. Aligning to a 16-byte boundary when the
3094 section you're in is only guaranteed to be aligned to a 4-byte
3095 boundary, for example, is a waste of effort. Again, NASM does not
3096 check that the section's alignment characteristics are sensible for
3097 the use of \c{ALIGN} or \c{ALIGNB}.
3100 \H{tasmcompat} \i{TASM Compatible Preprocessor Directives}
3102 The following preprocessor directives may only be used when TASM
3103 compatibility is turned on using the \c{-t} command line switch
3104 (This switch is described in \k{opt-t}.)
3106 \b\c{%arg} (see \k{arg})
3108 \b\c{%stacksize} (see \k{stacksize})
3110 \b\c{%local} (see \k{local})
3113 \S{arg} \i\c{%arg} Directive
3115 The \c{%arg} directive is used to simplify the handling of
3116 parameters passed on the stack. Stack based parameter passing
3117 is used by many high level languages, including C, C++ and Pascal.
3119 While NASM comes with macros which attempt to duplicate this
3120 functionality (see \k{16cmacro}), the syntax is not particularly
3121 convenient to use and is not TASM compatible. Here is an example
3122 which shows the use of \c{%arg} without any external macros:
3126 \c %push mycontext ; save the current context
3127 \c %stacksize large ; tell NASM to use bp
3128 \c %arg i:word, j_ptr:word
3135 \c %pop ; restore original context
3137 This is similar to the procedure defined in \k{16cmacro} and adds
3138 the value in i to the value pointed to by j_ptr and returns the
3139 sum in the ax register. See \k{pushpop} for an explanation of
3140 \c{push} and \c{pop} and the use of context stacks.
3143 \S{stacksize} \i\c{%stacksize} Directive
3145 The \c{%stacksize} directive is used in conjunction with the
3146 \c{%arg} (see \k{arg}) and the \c{%local} (see \k{local}) directives.
3147 It tells NASM the default size to use for subsequent \c{%arg} and
3148 \c{%local} directives. The \c{%stacksize} directive takes one
3149 required argument which is one of \c{flat}, \c{large} or \c{small}.
3153 This form causes NASM to use stack-based parameter addressing
3154 relative to \c{ebp} and it assumes that a near form of call was used
3155 to get to this label (i.e. that \c{eip} is on the stack).
3159 This form uses \c{bp} to do stack-based parameter addressing and
3160 assumes that a far form of call was used to get to this address
3161 (i.e. that \c{ip} and \c{cs} are on the stack).
3165 This form also uses \c{bp} to address stack parameters, but it is
3166 different from \c{large} because it also assumes that the old value
3167 of bp is pushed onto the stack (i.e. it expects an \c{ENTER}
3168 instruction). In other words, it expects that \c{bp}, \c{ip} and
3169 \c{cs} are on the top of the stack, underneath any local space which
3170 may have been allocated by \c{ENTER}. This form is probably most
3171 useful when used in combination with the \c{%local} directive
3175 \S{local} \i\c{%local} Directive
3177 The \c{%local} directive is used to simplify the use of local
3178 temporary stack variables allocated in a stack frame. Automatic
3179 local variables in C are an example of this kind of variable. The
3180 \c{%local} directive is most useful when used with the \c{%stacksize}
3181 (see \k{stacksize} and is also compatible with the \c{%arg} directive
3182 (see \k{arg}). It allows simplified reference to variables on the
3183 stack which have been allocated typically by using the \c{ENTER}
3184 instruction (see \k{insENTER} for a description of that instruction).
3185 An example of its use is the following:
3189 \c %push mycontext ; save the current context
3190 \c %stacksize small ; tell NASM to use bp
3191 \c %assign %$localsize 0 ; see text for explanation
3192 \c %local old_ax:word, old_dx:word
3194 \c enter %$localsize,0 ; see text for explanation
3195 \c mov [old_ax],ax ; swap ax & bx
3196 \c mov [old_dx],dx ; and swap dx & cx
3201 \c leave ; restore old bp
3204 \c %pop ; restore original context
3206 The \c{%$localsize} variable is used internally by the
3207 \c{%local} directive and \e{must} be defined within the
3208 current context before the \c{%local} directive may be used.
3209 Failure to do so will result in one expression syntax error for
3210 each \c{%local} variable declared. It then may be used in
3211 the construction of an appropriately sized ENTER instruction
3212 as shown in the example.
3214 \H{otherpreproc} \i{Other Preprocessor Directives}
3216 NASM also has preprocessor directives which allow access to
3217 information from external sources. Currently they include:
3219 The following preprocessor directive is supported to allow NASM to
3220 correctly handle output of the cpp C language preprocessor.
3222 \b\c{%line} enables NAsM to correctly handle the output of the cpp
3223 C language preprocessor (see \k{line}).
3225 \b\c{%!} enables NASM to read in the value of an environment variable,
3226 which can then be used in your program (see \k{getenv}).
3228 \S{line} \i\c{%line} Directive
3230 The \c{%line} directive is used to notify NASM that the input line
3231 corresponds to a specific line number in another file. Typically
3232 this other file would be an original source file, with the current
3233 NASM input being the output of a pre-processor. The \c{%line}
3234 directive allows NASM to output messages which indicate the line
3235 number of the original source file, instead of the file that is being
3238 This preprocessor directive is not generally of use to programmers,
3239 by may be of interest to preprocessor authors. The usage of the
3240 \c{%line} preprocessor directive is as follows:
3242 \c %line nnn[+mmm] [filename]
3244 In this directive, \c{nnn} indentifies the line of the original source
3245 file which this line corresponds to. \c{mmm} is an optional parameter
3246 which specifies a line increment value; each line of the input file
3247 read in is considered to correspond to \c{mmm} lines of the original
3248 source file. Finally, \c{filename} is an optional parameter which
3249 specifies the file name of the original source file.
3251 After reading a \c{%line} preprocessor directive, NASM will report
3252 all file name and line numbers relative to the values specified
3256 \S{getenv} \i\c{%!}\c{<env>}: Read an environment variable.
3258 The \c{%!<env>} directive makes it possible to read the value of an
3259 environment variable at assembly time. This could, for example, be used
3260 to store the contents of an environment variable into a string, which
3261 could be used at some other point in your code.
3263 For example, suppose that you have an environment variable \c{FOO}, and
3264 you want the contents of \c{FOO} to be embedded in your program. You
3265 could do that as follows:
3267 \c %define FOO %!FOO
3270 \c tmpstr db quote FOO quote
3272 At the time of writing, this will generate an "unterminated string"
3273 warning at the time of defining "quote", and it will add a space
3274 before and after the string that is read in. I was unable to find
3275 a simple workaround (although a workaround can be created using a
3276 multi-line macro), so I believe that you will need to either learn how
3277 to create more complex macros, or allow for the extra spaces if you
3278 make use of this feature in that way.
3281 \C{directive} \i{Assembler Directives}
3283 NASM, though it attempts to avoid the bureaucracy of assemblers like
3284 MASM and TASM, is nevertheless forced to support a \e{few}
3285 directives. These are described in this chapter.
3287 NASM's directives come in two types: \I{user-level
3288 directives}\e{user-level} directives and \I{primitive
3289 directives}\e{primitive} directives. Typically, each directive has a
3290 user-level form and a primitive form. In almost all cases, we
3291 recommend that users use the user-level forms of the directives,
3292 which are implemented as macros which call the primitive forms.
3294 Primitive directives are enclosed in square brackets; user-level
3297 In addition to the universal directives described in this chapter,
3298 each object file format can optionally supply extra directives in
3299 order to control particular features of that file format. These
3300 \I{format-specific directives}\e{format-specific} directives are
3301 documented along with the formats that implement them, in \k{outfmt}.
3304 \H{bits} \i\c{BITS}: Specifying Target \i{Processor Mode}
3306 The \c{BITS} directive specifies whether NASM should generate code
3307 \I{16-bit mode, versus 32-bit mode}designed to run on a processor
3308 operating in 16-bit mode, or code designed to run on a processor
3309 operating in 32-bit mode. The syntax is \c{BITS 16} or \c{BITS 32}.
3311 In most cases, you should not need to use \c{BITS} explicitly. The
3312 \c{aout}, \c{coff}, \c{elf} and \c{win32} object formats, which are
3313 designed for use in 32-bit operating systems, all cause NASM to
3314 select 32-bit mode by default. The \c{obj} object format allows you
3315 to specify each segment you define as either \c{USE16} or \c{USE32},
3316 and NASM will set its operating mode accordingly, so the use of the
3317 \c{BITS} directive is once again unnecessary.
3319 The most likely reason for using the \c{BITS} directive is to write
3320 32-bit code in a flat binary file; this is because the \c{bin}
3321 output format defaults to 16-bit mode in anticipation of it being
3322 used most frequently to write DOS \c{.COM} programs, DOS \c{.SYS}
3323 device drivers and boot loader software.
3325 You do \e{not} need to specify \c{BITS 32} merely in order to use
3326 32-bit instructions in a 16-bit DOS program; if you do, the
3327 assembler will generate incorrect code because it will be writing
3328 code targeted at a 32-bit platform, to be run on a 16-bit one.
3330 When NASM is in \c{BITS 16} state, instructions which use 32-bit
3331 data are prefixed with an 0x66 byte, and those referring to 32-bit
3332 addresses have an 0x67 prefix. In \c{BITS 32} state, the reverse is
3333 true: 32-bit instructions require no prefixes, whereas instructions
3334 using 16-bit data need an 0x66 and those working on 16-bit addresses
3337 The \c{BITS} directive has an exactly equivalent primitive form,
3338 \c{[BITS 16]} and \c{[BITS 32]}. The user-level form is a macro
3339 which has no function other than to call the primitive form.
3342 \S{USE16 & USE32} \i\c{USE16} & \i\c{USE32}: Aliases for BITS
3344 The `\c{USE16}' and `\c{USE32}' directives can be used in place of
3345 `\c{BITS 16}' and `\c{BITS 32}', for compatibility with other assemblers.
3348 \H{section} \i\c{SECTION} or \i\c{SEGMENT}: Changing and \i{Defining
3351 \I{changing sections}\I{switching between sections}The \c{SECTION}
3352 directive (\c{SEGMENT} is an exactly equivalent synonym) changes
3353 which section of the output file the code you write will be
3354 assembled into. In some object file formats, the number and names of
3355 sections are fixed; in others, the user may make up as many as they
3356 wish. Hence \c{SECTION} may sometimes give an error message, or may
3357 define a new section, if you try to switch to a section that does
3360 The Unix object formats, and the \c{bin} object format, all support
3361 the \i{standardised section names} \c{.text}, \c{.data} and \c{.bss}
3362 for the code, data and uninitialised-data sections. The \c{obj}
3363 format, by contrast, does not recognise these section names as being
3364 special, and indeed will strip off the leading period of any section
3368 \S{sectmac} The \i\c{__SECT__} Macro
3370 The \c{SECTION} directive is unusual in that its user-level form
3371 functions differently from its primitive form. The primitive form,
3372 \c{[SECTION xyz]}, simply switches the current target section to the
3373 one given. The user-level form, \c{SECTION xyz}, however, first
3374 defines the single-line macro \c{__SECT__} to be the primitive
3375 \c{[SECTION]} directive which it is about to issue, and then issues
3376 it. So the user-level directive
3380 expands to the two lines
3382 \c %define __SECT__ [SECTION .text]
3385 Users may find it useful to make use of this in their own macros.
3386 For example, the \c{writefile} macro defined in \k{mlmacgre} can be
3387 usefully rewritten in the following more sophisticated form:
3389 \c %macro writefile 2+
3399 \c mov cx,%%endstr-%%str
3406 This form of the macro, once passed a string to output, first
3407 switches temporarily to the data section of the file, using the
3408 primitive form of the \c{SECTION} directive so as not to modify
3409 \c{__SECT__}. It then declares its string in the data section, and
3410 then invokes \c{__SECT__} to switch back to \e{whichever} section
3411 the user was previously working in. It thus avoids the need, in the
3412 previous version of the macro, to include a \c{JMP} instruction to
3413 jump over the data, and also does not fail if, in a complicated
3414 \c{OBJ} format module, the user could potentially be assembling the
3415 code in any of several separate code sections.
3418 \H{absolute} \i\c{ABSOLUTE}: Defining Absolute Labels
3420 The \c{ABSOLUTE} directive can be thought of as an alternative form
3421 of \c{SECTION}: it causes the subsequent code to be directed at no
3422 physical section, but at the hypothetical section starting at the
3423 given absolute address. The only instructions you can use in this
3424 mode are the \c{RESB} family.
3426 \c{ABSOLUTE} is used as follows:
3434 This example describes a section of the PC BIOS data area, at
3435 segment address 0x40: the above code defines \c{kbuf_chr} to be
3436 0x1A, \c{kbuf_free} to be 0x1C, and \c{kbuf} to be 0x1E.
3438 The user-level form of \c{ABSOLUTE}, like that of \c{SECTION},
3439 redefines the \i\c{__SECT__} macro when it is invoked.
3441 \i\c{STRUC} and \i\c{ENDSTRUC} are defined as macros which use
3442 \c{ABSOLUTE} (and also \c{__SECT__}).
3444 \c{ABSOLUTE} doesn't have to take an absolute constant as an
3445 argument: it can take an expression (actually, a \i{critical
3446 expression}: see \k{crit}) and it can be a value in a segment. For
3447 example, a TSR can re-use its setup code as run-time BSS like this:
3449 \c org 100h ; it's a .COM program
3451 \c jmp setup ; setup code comes last
3453 \c ; the resident part of the TSR goes here
3455 \c ; now write the code that installs the TSR here
3459 \c runtimevar1 resw 1
3460 \c runtimevar2 resd 20
3464 This defines some variables `on top of' the setup code, so that
3465 after the setup has finished running, the space it took up can be
3466 re-used as data storage for the running TSR. The symbol `tsr_end'
3467 can be used to calculate the total size of the part of the TSR that
3468 needs to be made resident.
3471 \H{extern} \i\c{EXTERN}: \i{Importing Symbols} from Other Modules
3473 \c{EXTERN} is similar to the MASM directive \c{EXTRN} and the C
3474 keyword \c{extern}: it is used to declare a symbol which is not
3475 defined anywhere in the module being assembled, but is assumed to be
3476 defined in some other module and needs to be referred to by this
3477 one. Not every object-file format can support external variables:
3478 the \c{bin} format cannot.
3480 The \c{EXTERN} directive takes as many arguments as you like. Each
3481 argument is the name of a symbol:
3484 \c extern _sscanf,_fscanf
3486 Some object-file formats provide extra features to the \c{EXTERN}
3487 directive. In all cases, the extra features are used by suffixing a
3488 colon to the symbol name followed by object-format specific text.
3489 For example, the \c{obj} format allows you to declare that the
3490 default segment base of an external should be the group \c{dgroup}
3491 by means of the directive
3493 \c extern _variable:wrt dgroup
3495 The primitive form of \c{EXTERN} differs from the user-level form
3496 only in that it can take only one argument at a time: the support
3497 for multiple arguments is implemented at the preprocessor level.
3499 You can declare the same variable as \c{EXTERN} more than once: NASM
3500 will quietly ignore the second and later redeclarations. You can't
3501 declare a variable as \c{EXTERN} as well as something else, though.
3504 \H{global} \i\c{GLOBAL}: \i{Exporting Symbols} to Other Modules
3506 \c{GLOBAL} is the other end of \c{EXTERN}: if one module declares a
3507 symbol as \c{EXTERN} and refers to it, then in order to prevent
3508 linker errors, some other module must actually \e{define} the
3509 symbol and declare it as \c{GLOBAL}. Some assemblers use the name
3510 \i\c{PUBLIC} for this purpose.
3512 The \c{GLOBAL} directive applying to a symbol must appear \e{before}
3513 the definition of the symbol.
3515 \c{GLOBAL} uses the same syntax as \c{EXTERN}, except that it must
3516 refer to symbols which \e{are} defined in the same module as the
3517 \c{GLOBAL} directive. For example:
3523 \c{GLOBAL}, like \c{EXTERN}, allows object formats to define private
3524 extensions by means of a colon. The \c{elf} object format, for
3525 example, lets you specify whether global data items are functions or
3528 \c global hashlookup:function, hashtable:data
3530 Like \c{EXTERN}, the primitive form of \c{GLOBAL} differs from the
3531 user-level form only in that it can take only one argument at a
3535 \H{common} \i\c{COMMON}: Defining Common Data Areas
3537 The \c{COMMON} directive is used to declare \i\e{common variables}.
3538 A common variable is much like a global variable declared in the
3539 uninitialised data section, so that
3543 is similar in function to
3550 The difference is that if more than one module defines the same
3551 common variable, then at link time those variables will be
3552 \e{merged}, and references to \c{intvar} in all modules will point
3553 at the same piece of memory.
3555 Like \c{GLOBAL} and \c{EXTERN}, \c{COMMON} supports object-format
3556 specific extensions. For example, the \c{obj} format allows common
3557 variables to be NEAR or FAR, and the \c{elf} format allows you to
3558 specify the alignment requirements of a common variable:
3560 \c common commvar 4:near ; works in OBJ
3561 \c common intarray 100:4 ; works in ELF: 4 byte aligned
3563 Once again, like \c{EXTERN} and \c{GLOBAL}, the primitive form of
3564 \c{COMMON} differs from the user-level form only in that it can take
3565 only one argument at a time.
3568 \H{CPU} \i\c{CPU}: Defining CPU Dependencies
3570 The \i\c{CPU} directive restricts assembly to those instructions which
3571 are available on the specified CPU.
3575 \b\c{CPU 8086} Assemble only 8086 instruction set
3577 \b\c{CPU 186} Assemble instructions up to the 80186 instruction set
3579 \b\c{CPU 286} Assemble instructions up to the 286 instruction set
3581 \b\c{CPU 386} Assemble instructions up to the 386 instruction set
3583 \b\c{CPU 486} 486 instruction set
3585 \b\c{CPU 586} Pentium instruction set
3587 \b\c{CPU PENTIUM} Same as 586
3589 \b\c{CPU 686} P6 instruction set
3591 \b\c{CPU PPRO} Same as 686
3593 \b\c{CPU P2} Same as 686
3595 \b\c{CPU P3} Pentium III and Katmai instruction sets
3597 \b\c{CPU KATMAI} Same as P3
3599 \b\c{CPU P4} Pentium 4 (Willamette) instruction set
3601 \b\c{CPU WILLAMETTE} Same as P4
3603 \b\c{CPU IA64} IA64 CPU (in x86 mode) instruction set
3605 All options are case insensitive. All instructions will be selected
3606 only if they apply to the selected CPU or lower. By default, all
3607 instructions are available.
3610 \C{outfmt} \i{Output Formats}
3612 NASM is a portable assembler, designed to be able to compile on any
3613 ANSI C-supporting platform and produce output to run on a variety of
3614 Intel x86 operating systems. For this reason, it has a large number
3615 of available output formats, selected using the \i\c{-f} option on
3616 the NASM \i{command line}. Each of these formats, along with its
3617 extensions to the base NASM syntax, is detailed in this chapter.
3619 As stated in \k{opt-o}, NASM chooses a \i{default name} for your
3620 output file based on the input file name and the chosen output
3621 format. This will be generated by removing the \i{extension}
3622 (\c{.asm}, \c{.s}, or whatever you like to use) from the input file
3623 name, and substituting an extension defined by the output format.
3624 The extensions are given with each format below.
3627 \H{binfmt} \i\c{bin}: \i{Flat-Form Binary}\I{pure binary} Output
3629 The \c{bin} format does not produce object files: it generates
3630 nothing in the output file except the code you wrote. Such `pure
3631 binary' files are used by \i{MS-DOS}: \i\c{.COM} executables and
3632 \i\c{.SYS} device drivers are pure binary files. Pure binary output
3633 is also useful for \i{operating system} and \i{boot loader}
3636 The \c{bin} format supports \i{multiple section names}. For details of
3637 how nasm handles sections in the \c{bin} format, see \k{multisec}.
3639 Using the \c{bin} format puts NASM by default into 16-bit mode (see
3640 \k{bits}). In order to use \c{bin} to write 32-bit code such as an
3641 OS kernel, you need to explicitly issue the \I\c{BITS}\c{BITS 32}
3644 \c{bin} has no default output file name extension: instead, it
3645 leaves your file name as it is once the original extension has been
3646 removed. Thus, the default is for NASM to assemble \c{binprog.asm}
3647 into a binary file called \c{binprog}.
3650 \S{org} \i\c{ORG}: Binary File \i{Program Origin}
3652 The \c{bin} format provides an additional directive to the list
3653 given in \k{directive}: \c{ORG}. The function of the \c{ORG}
3654 directive is to specify the origin address which NASM will assume
3655 the program begins at when it is loaded into memory.
3657 For example, the following code will generate the longword
3664 Unlike the \c{ORG} directive provided by MASM-compatible assemblers,
3665 which allows you to jump around in the object file and overwrite
3666 code you have already generated, NASM's \c{ORG} does exactly what
3667 the directive says: \e{origin}. Its sole function is to specify one
3668 offset which is added to all internal address references within the
3669 section; it does not permit any of the trickery that MASM's version
3670 does. See \k{proborg} for further comments.
3673 \S{binseg} \c{bin} Extensions to the \c{SECTION}
3674 Directive\I{SECTION, bin extensions to}
3676 The \c{bin} output format extends the \c{SECTION} (or \c{SEGMENT})
3677 directive to allow you to specify the alignment requirements of
3678 segments. This is done by appending the \i\c{ALIGN} qualifier to the
3679 end of the section-definition line. For example,
3681 \c section .data align=16
3683 switches to the section \c{.data} and also specifies that it must be
3684 aligned on a 16-byte boundary.
3686 The parameter to \c{ALIGN} specifies how many low bits of the
3687 section start address must be forced to zero. The alignment value
3688 given may be any power of two.\I{section alignment, in
3689 bin}\I{segment alignment, in bin}\I{alignment, in bin sections}
3692 \S{multisec} \c{Multisection}\I{bin, multisection} support for the BIN format.
3694 The \c{bin} format allows the use of multiple sections, which are
3695 ordered according to a few basic rules.
3697 \b Any code which comes before an explicit \c{SECTION} directive
3698 is directed by default into the \c{.text} section.
3700 \b If a \c{.text} section is not given an \c{ORG} statement, it is
3701 allocated \c{ORG 0} by default.
3703 \b Sections which have an \c{ORG} statement, explicit or implicit,
3704 are placed in the order of the \c{ORG} statement. The code is padded
3705 with 0s to give the correct offsets within the output file.
3707 \b If a section has multiple \c{ORG} statements, the last \c{ORG} statement
3708 is applied to the entire section, without affecting the order in
3709 which the separate parts of the section are put together at assembly
3712 \b Sections without an \c{ORG} statement will be placed after those which
3713 do have one, and they will be placed in the order that they are first
3716 \b The \c{.data} section does not follow any special rules, unlike the
3717 \c{.text} and \c{.bss} sections.
3719 \b The \c{.bss} section will be placed after all other sections.
3721 \b All sections are aligned on dword boundaries, unless a higher level
3722 of alignment has been specified.
3724 \b Sections cannot overlap.
3727 \H{objfmt} \i\c{obj}: \i{Microsoft OMF}\I{OMF} Object Files
3729 The \c{obj} file format (NASM calls it \c{obj} rather than \c{omf}
3730 for historical reasons) is the one produced by \i{MASM} and
3731 \i{TASM}, which is typically fed to 16-bit DOS linkers to produce
3732 \i\c{.EXE} files. It is also the format used by \i{OS/2}.
3734 \c{obj} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.obj}.
3736 \c{obj} is not exclusively a 16-bit format, though: NASM has full
3737 support for the 32-bit extensions to the format. In particular,
3738 32-bit \c{obj} format files are used by \i{Borland's Win32
3739 compilers}, instead of using Microsoft's newer \i\c{win32} object
3742 The \c{obj} format does not define any special segment names: you
3743 can call your segments anything you like. Typical names for segments
3744 in \c{obj} format files are \c{CODE}, \c{DATA} and \c{BSS}.
3746 If your source file contains code before specifying an explicit
3747 \c{SEGMENT} directive, then NASM will invent its own segment called
3748 \i\c{__NASMDEFSEG} for you.
3750 When you define a segment in an \c{obj} file, NASM defines the
3751 segment name as a symbol as well, so that you can access the segment
3752 address of the segment. So, for example:
3761 \c mov ax,data ; get segment address of data
3762 \c mov ds,ax ; and move it into DS
3763 \c inc word [dvar] ; now this reference will work
3766 The \c{obj} format also enables the use of the \i\c{SEG} and
3767 \i\c{WRT} operators, so that you can write code which does things
3772 \c mov ax,seg foo ; get preferred segment of foo
3774 \c mov ax,data ; a different segment
3776 \c mov ax,[ds:foo] ; this accesses `foo'
3777 \c mov [es:foo wrt data],bx ; so does this
3780 \S{objseg} \c{obj} Extensions to the \c{SEGMENT}
3781 Directive\I{SEGMENT, obj extensions to}
3783 The \c{obj} output format extends the \c{SEGMENT} (or \c{SECTION})
3784 directive to allow you to specify various properties of the segment
3785 you are defining. This is done by appending extra qualifiers to the
3786 end of the segment-definition line. For example,
3788 \c segment code private align=16
3790 defines the segment \c{code}, but also declares it to be a private
3791 segment, and requires that the portion of it described in this code
3792 module must be aligned on a 16-byte boundary.
3794 The available qualifiers are:
3796 \b \i\c{PRIVATE}, \i\c{PUBLIC}, \i\c{COMMON} and \i\c{STACK} specify
3797 the combination characteristics of the segment. \c{PRIVATE} segments
3798 do not get combined with any others by the linker; \c{PUBLIC} and
3799 \c{STACK} segments get concatenated together at link time; and
3800 \c{COMMON} segments all get overlaid on top of each other rather
3801 than stuck end-to-end.
3803 \b \i\c{ALIGN} is used, as shown above, to specify how many low bits
3804 of the segment start address must be forced to zero. The alignment
3805 value given may be any power of two from 1 to 4096; in reality, the
3806 only values supported are 1, 2, 4, 16, 256 and 4096, so if 8 is
3807 specified it will be rounded up to 16, and 32, 64 and 128 will all
3808 be rounded up to 256, and so on. Note that alignment to 4096-byte
3809 boundaries is a \i{PharLap} extension to the format and may not be
3810 supported by all linkers.\I{section alignment, in OBJ}\I{segment
3811 alignment, in OBJ}\I{alignment, in OBJ sections}
3813 \b \i\c{CLASS} can be used to specify the segment class; this feature
3814 indicates to the linker that segments of the same class should be
3815 placed near each other in the output file. The class name can be any
3816 word, e.g. \c{CLASS=CODE}.
3818 \b \i\c{OVERLAY}, like \c{CLASS}, is specified with an arbitrary word
3819 as an argument, and provides overlay information to an
3820 overlay-capable linker.
3822 \b Segments can be declared as \i\c{USE16} or \i\c{USE32}, which has
3823 the effect of recording the choice in the object file and also
3824 ensuring that NASM's default assembly mode when assembling in that
3825 segment is 16-bit or 32-bit respectively.
3827 \b When writing \i{OS/2} object files, you should declare 32-bit
3828 segments as \i\c{FLAT}, which causes the default segment base for
3829 anything in the segment to be the special group \c{FLAT}, and also
3830 defines the group if it is not already defined.
3832 \b The \c{obj} file format also allows segments to be declared as
3833 having a pre-defined absolute segment address, although no linkers
3834 are currently known to make sensible use of this feature;
3835 nevertheless, NASM allows you to declare a segment such as
3836 \c{SEGMENT SCREEN ABSOLUTE=0xB800} if you need to. The \i\c{ABSOLUTE}
3837 and \c{ALIGN} keywords are mutually exclusive.
3839 NASM's default segment attributes are \c{PUBLIC}, \c{ALIGN=1}, no
3840 class, no overlay, and \c{USE16}.
3843 \S{group} \i\c{GROUP}: Defining Groups of Segments\I{segments, groups of}
3845 The \c{obj} format also allows segments to be grouped, so that a
3846 single segment register can be used to refer to all the segments in
3847 a group. NASM therefore supplies the \c{GROUP} directive, whereby
3856 \c ; some uninitialised data
3858 \c group dgroup data bss
3860 which will define a group called \c{dgroup} to contain the segments
3861 \c{data} and \c{bss}. Like \c{SEGMENT}, \c{GROUP} causes the group
3862 name to be defined as a symbol, so that you can refer to a variable
3863 \c{var} in the \c{data} segment as \c{var wrt data} or as \c{var wrt
3864 dgroup}, depending on which segment value is currently in your
3867 If you just refer to \c{var}, however, and \c{var} is declared in a
3868 segment which is part of a group, then NASM will default to giving
3869 you the offset of \c{var} from the beginning of the \e{group}, not
3870 the \e{segment}. Therefore \c{SEG var}, also, will return the group
3871 base rather than the segment base.
3873 NASM will allow a segment to be part of more than one group, but
3874 will generate a warning if you do this. Variables declared in a
3875 segment which is part of more than one group will default to being
3876 relative to the first group that was defined to contain the segment.
3878 A group does not have to contain any segments; you can still make
3879 \c{WRT} references to a group which does not contain the variable
3880 you are referring to. OS/2, for example, defines the special group
3881 \c{FLAT} with no segments in it.
3884 \S{uppercase} \i\c{UPPERCASE}: Disabling Case Sensitivity in Output
3886 Although NASM itself is \i{case sensitive}, some OMF linkers are
3887 not; therefore it can be useful for NASM to output single-case
3888 object files. The \c{UPPERCASE} format-specific directive causes all
3889 segment, group and symbol names that are written to the object file
3890 to be forced to upper case just before being written. Within a
3891 source file, NASM is still case-sensitive; but the object file can
3892 be written entirely in upper case if desired.
3894 \c{UPPERCASE} is used alone on a line; it requires no parameters.
3897 \S{import} \i\c{IMPORT}: Importing DLL Symbols\I{DLL symbols,
3898 importing}\I{symbols, importing from DLLs}
3900 The \c{IMPORT} format-specific directive defines a symbol to be
3901 imported from a DLL, for use if you are writing a DLL's \i{import
3902 library} in NASM. You still need to declare the symbol as \c{EXTERN}
3903 as well as using the \c{IMPORT} directive.
3905 The \c{IMPORT} directive takes two required parameters, separated by
3906 white space, which are (respectively) the name of the symbol you
3907 wish to import and the name of the library you wish to import it
3910 \c import WSAStartup wsock32.dll
3912 A third optional parameter gives the name by which the symbol is
3913 known in the library you are importing it from, in case this is not
3914 the same as the name you wish the symbol to be known by to your code
3915 once you have imported it. For example:
3917 \c import asyncsel wsock32.dll WSAAsyncSelect
3920 \S{export} \i\c{EXPORT}: Exporting DLL Symbols\I{DLL symbols,
3921 exporting}\I{symbols, exporting from DLLs}
3923 The \c{EXPORT} format-specific directive defines a global symbol to
3924 be exported as a DLL symbol, for use if you are writing a DLL in
3925 NASM. You still need to declare the symbol as \c{GLOBAL} as well as
3926 using the \c{EXPORT} directive.
3928 \c{EXPORT} takes one required parameter, which is the name of the
3929 symbol you wish to export, as it was defined in your source file. An
3930 optional second parameter (separated by white space from the first)
3931 gives the \e{external} name of the symbol: the name by which you
3932 wish the symbol to be known to programs using the DLL. If this name
3933 is the same as the internal name, you may leave the second parameter
3936 Further parameters can be given to define attributes of the exported
3937 symbol. These parameters, like the second, are separated by white
3938 space. If further parameters are given, the external name must also
3939 be specified, even if it is the same as the internal name. The
3940 available attributes are:
3942 \b \c{resident} indicates that the exported name is to be kept
3943 resident by the system loader. This is an optimisation for
3944 frequently used symbols imported by name.
3946 \b \c{nodata} indicates that the exported symbol is a function which
3947 does not make use of any initialised data.
3949 \b \c{parm=NNN}, where \c{NNN} is an integer, sets the number of
3950 parameter words for the case in which the symbol is a call gate
3951 between 32-bit and 16-bit segments.
3953 \b An attribute which is just a number indicates that the symbol
3954 should be exported with an identifying number (ordinal), and gives
3960 \c export myfunc TheRealMoreFormalLookingFunctionName
3961 \c export myfunc myfunc 1234 ; export by ordinal
3962 \c export myfunc myfunc resident parm=23 nodata
3965 \S{dotdotstart} \i\c{..start}: Defining the \i{Program Entry
3968 \c{OMF} linkers require exactly one of the object files being linked to
3969 define the program entry point, where execution will begin when the
3970 program is run. If the object file that defines the entry point is
3971 assembled using NASM, you specify the entry point by declaring the
3972 special symbol \c{..start} at the point where you wish execution to
3976 \S{objextern} \c{obj} Extensions to the \c{EXTERN}
3977 Directive\I{EXTERN, obj extensions to}
3979 If you declare an external symbol with the directive
3983 then references such as \c{mov ax,foo} will give you the offset of
3984 \c{foo} from its preferred segment base (as specified in whichever
3985 module \c{foo} is actually defined in). So to access the contents of
3986 \c{foo} you will usually need to do something like
3988 \c mov ax,seg foo ; get preferred segment base
3989 \c mov es,ax ; move it into ES
3990 \c mov ax,[es:foo] ; and use offset `foo' from it
3992 This is a little unwieldy, particularly if you know that an external
3993 is going to be accessible from a given segment or group, say
3994 \c{dgroup}. So if \c{DS} already contained \c{dgroup}, you could
3997 \c mov ax,[foo wrt dgroup]
3999 However, having to type this every time you want to access \c{foo}
4000 can be a pain; so NASM allows you to declare \c{foo} in the
4003 \c extern foo:wrt dgroup
4005 This form causes NASM to pretend that the preferred segment base of
4006 \c{foo} is in fact \c{dgroup}; so the expression \c{seg foo} will
4007 now return \c{dgroup}, and the expression \c{foo} is equivalent to
4010 This \I{default-WRT mechanism}default-\c{WRT} mechanism can be used
4011 to make externals appear to be relative to any group or segment in
4012 your program. It can also be applied to common variables: see
4016 \S{objcommon} \c{obj} Extensions to the \c{COMMON}
4017 Directive\I{COMMON, obj extensions to}
4019 The \c{obj} format allows common variables to be either near\I{near
4020 common variables} or far\I{far common variables}; NASM allows you to
4021 specify which your variables should be by the use of the syntax
4023 \c common nearvar 2:near ; `nearvar' is a near common
4024 \c common farvar 10:far ; and `farvar' is far
4026 Far common variables may be greater in size than 64Kb, and so the
4027 OMF specification says that they are declared as a number of
4028 \e{elements} of a given size. So a 10-byte far common variable could
4029 be declared as ten one-byte elements, five two-byte elements, two
4030 five-byte elements or one ten-byte element.
4032 Some \c{OMF} linkers require the \I{element size, in common
4033 variables}\I{common variables, element size}element size, as well as
4034 the variable size, to match when resolving common variables declared
4035 in more than one module. Therefore NASM must allow you to specify
4036 the element size on your far common variables. This is done by the
4039 \c common c_5by2 10:far 5 ; two five-byte elements
4040 \c common c_2by5 10:far 2 ; five two-byte elements
4042 If no element size is specified, the default is 1. Also, the \c{FAR}
4043 keyword is not required when an element size is specified, since
4044 only far commons may have element sizes at all. So the above
4045 declarations could equivalently be
4047 \c common c_5by2 10:5 ; two five-byte elements
4048 \c common c_2by5 10:2 ; five two-byte elements
4050 In addition to these extensions, the \c{COMMON} directive in \c{obj}
4051 also supports default-\c{WRT} specification like \c{EXTERN} does
4052 (explained in \k{objextern}). So you can also declare things like
4054 \c common foo 10:wrt dgroup
4055 \c common bar 16:far 2:wrt data
4056 \c common baz 24:wrt data:6
4059 \H{win32fmt} \i\c{win32}: Microsoft Win32 Object Files
4061 The \c{win32} output format generates Microsoft Win32 object files,
4062 suitable for passing to Microsoft linkers such as \i{Visual C++}.
4063 Note that Borland Win32 compilers do not use this format, but use
4064 \c{obj} instead (see \k{objfmt}).
4066 \c{win32} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.obj}.
4068 Note that although Microsoft say that Win32 object files follow the
4069 \c{COFF} (Common Object File Format) standard, the object files produced
4070 by Microsoft Win32 compilers are not compatible with COFF linkers
4071 such as DJGPP's, and vice versa. This is due to a difference of
4072 opinion over the precise semantics of PC-relative relocations. To
4073 produce COFF files suitable for DJGPP, use NASM's \c{coff} output
4074 format; conversely, the \c{coff} format does not produce object
4075 files that Win32 linkers can generate correct output from.
4078 \S{win32sect} \c{win32} Extensions to the \c{SECTION}
4079 Directive\I{SECTION, win32 extensions to}
4081 Like the \c{obj} format, \c{win32} allows you to specify additional
4082 information on the \c{SECTION} directive line, to control the type
4083 and properties of sections you declare. Section types and properties
4084 are generated automatically by NASM for the \i{standard section names}
4085 \c{.text}, \c{.data} and \c{.bss}, but may still be overridden by
4088 The available qualifiers are:
4090 \b \c{code}, or equivalently \c{text}, defines the section to be a
4091 code section. This marks the section as readable and executable, but
4092 not writable, and also indicates to the linker that the type of the
4095 \b \c{data} and \c{bss} define the section to be a data section,
4096 analogously to \c{code}. Data sections are marked as readable and
4097 writable, but not executable. \c{data} declares an initialised data
4098 section, whereas \c{bss} declares an uninitialised data section.
4100 \b \c{rdata} declares an initialised data section that is readable
4101 but not writable. Microsoft compilers use this section to place
4104 \b \c{info} defines the section to be an \i{informational section},
4105 which is not included in the executable file by the linker, but may
4106 (for example) pass information \e{to} the linker. For example,
4107 declaring an \c{info}-type section called \i\c{.drectve} causes the
4108 linker to interpret the contents of the section as command-line
4111 \b \c{align=}, used with a trailing number as in \c{obj}, gives the
4112 \I{section alignment, in win32}\I{alignment, in win32
4113 sections}alignment requirements of the section. The maximum you may
4114 specify is 64: the Win32 object file format contains no means to
4115 request a greater section alignment than this. If alignment is not
4116 explicitly specified, the defaults are 16-byte alignment for code
4117 sections, 8-byte alignment for rdata sections and 4-byte alignment
4118 for data (and BSS) sections.
4119 Informational sections get a default alignment of 1 byte (no
4120 alignment), though the value does not matter.
4122 The defaults assumed by NASM if you do not specify the above
4125 \c section .text code align=16
4126 \c section .data data align=4
4127 \c section .rdata rdata align=8
4128 \c section .bss bss align=4
4130 Any other section name is treated by default like \c{.text}.
4133 \H{cofffmt} \i\c{coff}: \i{Common Object File Format}
4135 The \c{coff} output type produces \c{COFF} object files suitable for
4136 linking with the \i{DJGPP} linker.
4138 \c{coff} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
4140 The \c{coff} format supports the same extensions to the \c{SECTION}
4141 directive as \c{win32} does, except that the \c{align} qualifier and
4142 the \c{info} section type are not supported.
4145 \H{elffmt} \i\c{elf}: \I{ELF}\I{linux, elf}\i{Executable and Linkable
4146 Format} Object Files
4148 The \c{elf} output format generates \c{ELF32} (Executable and Linkable
4149 Format) object files, as used by Linux as well as \i{Unix System V},
4150 including \i{Solaris x86}, \i{UnixWare} and \i{SCO Unix}. \c{elf}
4151 provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
4154 \S{elfsect} \c{elf} Extensions to the \c{SECTION}
4155 Directive\I{SECTION, elf extensions to}
4157 Like the \c{obj} format, \c{elf} allows you to specify additional
4158 information on the \c{SECTION} directive line, to control the type
4159 and properties of sections you declare. Section types and properties
4160 are generated automatically by NASM for the \i{standard section
4161 names} \i\c{.text}, \i\c{.data} and \i\c{.bss}, but may still be
4162 overridden by these qualifiers.
4164 The available qualifiers are:
4166 \b \i\c{alloc} defines the section to be one which is loaded into
4167 memory when the program is run. \i\c{noalloc} defines it to be one
4168 which is not, such as an informational or comment section.
4170 \b \i\c{exec} defines the section to be one which should have execute
4171 permission when the program is run. \i\c{noexec} defines it as one
4174 \b \i\c{write} defines the section to be one which should be writable
4175 when the program is run. \i\c{nowrite} defines it as one which should
4178 \b \i\c{progbits} defines the section to be one with explicit contents
4179 stored in the object file: an ordinary code or data section, for
4180 example, \i\c{nobits} defines the section to be one with no explicit
4181 contents given, such as a BSS section.
4183 \b \c{align=}, used with a trailing number as in \c{obj}, gives the
4184 \I{section alignment, in elf}\I{alignment, in elf sections}alignment
4185 requirements of the section.
4187 The defaults assumed by NASM if you do not specify the above
4190 \c section .text progbits alloc exec nowrite align=16
4191 \c section .rodata progbits alloc noexec nowrite align=4
4192 \c section .data progbits alloc noexec write align=4
4193 \c section .bss nobits alloc noexec write align=4
4194 \c section other progbits alloc noexec nowrite align=1
4196 (Any section name other than \c{.text}, \c{.rodata}, \c{.data} and
4197 \c{.bss} is treated by default like \c{other} in the above code.)
4200 \S{elfwrt} \i{Position-Independent Code}\I{PIC}: \c{elf} Special
4201 Symbols and \i\c{WRT}
4203 The \c{ELF} specification contains enough features to allow
4204 position-independent code (PIC) to be written, which makes \i{ELF
4205 shared libraries} very flexible. However, it also means NASM has to
4206 be able to generate a variety of strange relocation types in ELF
4207 object files, if it is to be an assembler which can write PIC.
4209 Since \c{ELF} does not support segment-base references, the \c{WRT}
4210 operator is not used for its normal purpose; therefore NASM's
4211 \c{elf} output format makes use of \c{WRT} for a different purpose,
4212 namely the PIC-specific \I{relocations, PIC-specific}relocation
4215 \c{elf} defines five special symbols which you can use as the
4216 right-hand side of the \c{WRT} operator to obtain PIC relocation
4217 types. They are \i\c{..gotpc}, \i\c{..gotoff}, \i\c{..got},
4218 \i\c{..plt} and \i\c{..sym}. Their functions are summarised here:
4220 \b Referring to the symbol marking the global offset table base
4221 using \c{wrt ..gotpc} will end up giving the distance from the
4222 beginning of the current section to the global offset table.
4223 (\i\c{_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_} is the standard symbol name used to
4224 refer to the \i{GOT}.) So you would then need to add \i\c{$$} to the
4225 result to get the real address of the GOT.
4227 \b Referring to a location in one of your own sections using \c{wrt
4228 ..gotoff} will give the distance from the beginning of the GOT to
4229 the specified location, so that adding on the address of the GOT
4230 would give the real address of the location you wanted.
4232 \b Referring to an external or global symbol using \c{wrt ..got}
4233 causes the linker to build an entry \e{in} the GOT containing the
4234 address of the symbol, and the reference gives the distance from the
4235 beginning of the GOT to the entry; so you can add on the address of
4236 the GOT, load from the resulting address, and end up with the
4237 address of the symbol.
4239 \b Referring to a procedure name using \c{wrt ..plt} causes the
4240 linker to build a \i{procedure linkage table} entry for the symbol,
4241 and the reference gives the address of the \i{PLT} entry. You can
4242 only use this in contexts which would generate a PC-relative
4243 relocation normally (i.e. as the destination for \c{CALL} or
4244 \c{JMP}), since ELF contains no relocation type to refer to PLT
4247 \b Referring to a symbol name using \c{wrt ..sym} causes NASM to
4248 write an ordinary relocation, but instead of making the relocation
4249 relative to the start of the section and then adding on the offset
4250 to the symbol, it will write a relocation record aimed directly at
4251 the symbol in question. The distinction is a necessary one due to a
4252 peculiarity of the dynamic linker.
4254 A fuller explanation of how to use these relocation types to write
4255 shared libraries entirely in NASM is given in \k{picdll}.
4258 \S{elfglob} \c{elf} Extensions to the \c{GLOBAL} Directive\I{GLOBAL,
4259 elf extensions to}\I{GLOBAL, aoutb extensions to}
4261 \c{ELF} object files can contain more information about a global symbol
4262 than just its address: they can contain the \I{symbol sizes,
4263 specifying}\I{size, of symbols}size of the symbol and its \I{symbol
4264 types, specifying}\I{type, of symbols}type as well. These are not
4265 merely debugger conveniences, but are actually necessary when the
4266 program being written is a \i{shared library}. NASM therefore
4267 supports some extensions to the \c{GLOBAL} directive, allowing you
4268 to specify these features.
4270 You can specify whether a global variable is a function or a data
4271 object by suffixing the name with a colon and the word
4272 \i\c{function} or \i\c{data}. (\i\c{object} is a synonym for
4273 \c{data}.) For example:
4275 \c global hashlookup:function, hashtable:data
4277 exports the global symbol \c{hashlookup} as a function and
4278 \c{hashtable} as a data object.
4280 You can also specify the size of the data associated with the
4281 symbol, as a numeric expression (which may involve labels, and even
4282 forward references) after the type specifier. Like this:
4284 \c global hashtable:data (hashtable.end - hashtable)
4287 \c db this,that,theother ; some data here
4290 This makes NASM automatically calculate the length of the table and
4291 place that information into the \c{ELF} symbol table.
4293 Declaring the type and size of global symbols is necessary when
4294 writing shared library code. For more information, see
4298 \S{elfcomm} \c{elf} Extensions to the \c{COMMON} Directive
4299 \I{COMMON, elf extensions to}
4301 \c{ELF} also allows you to specify alignment requirements \I{common
4302 variables, alignment in elf}\I{alignment, of elf common variables}on
4303 common variables. This is done by putting a number (which must be a
4304 power of two) after the name and size of the common variable,
4305 separated (as usual) by a colon. For example, an array of
4306 doublewords would benefit from 4-byte alignment:
4308 \c common dwordarray 128:4
4310 This declares the total size of the array to be 128 bytes, and
4311 requires that it be aligned on a 4-byte boundary.
4314 \S{elf16} 16-bit code and ELF
4315 \I{ELF, 16-bit code and}
4317 The \c{ELF32} specification doesn't provide relocations for 8- and
4318 16-bit values, but the GNU \c{ld} linker adds these as an extension.
4319 NASM can generate GNU-compatible relocations, to allow 16-bit code to
4320 be linked as ELF using GNU \c{ld}. If NASM is used with the
4321 \c{-w+gnu-elf-extensions} option, a warning is issued when one of
4322 these relocations is generated.
4324 \H{aoutfmt} \i\c{aout}: Linux \I{a.out, Linux version}\I{linux, a.out}\c{a.out} Object Files
4326 The \c{aout} format generates \c{a.out} object files, in the form used
4327 by early Linux systems (current Linux systems use ELF, see
4328 \k{elffmt}.) These differ from other \c{a.out} object files in that
4329 the magic number in the first four bytes of the file is
4330 different; also, some implementations of \c{a.out}, for example
4331 NetBSD's, support position-independent code, which Linux's
4332 implementation does not.
4334 \c{a.out} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
4336 \c{a.out} is a very simple object format. It supports no special
4337 directives, no special symbols, no use of \c{SEG} or \c{WRT}, and no
4338 extensions to any standard directives. It supports only the three
4339 \i{standard section names} \i\c{.text}, \i\c{.data} and \i\c{.bss}.
4342 \H{aoutfmt} \i\c{aoutb}: \i{NetBSD}/\i{FreeBSD}/\i{OpenBSD}
4343 \I{a.out, BSD version}\c{a.out} Object Files
4345 The \c{aoutb} format generates \c{a.out} object files, in the form
4346 used by the various free \c{BSD Unix} clones, \c{NetBSD}, \c{FreeBSD}
4347 and \c{OpenBSD}. For simple object files, this object format is exactly
4348 the same as \c{aout} except for the magic number in the first four bytes
4349 of the file. However, the \c{aoutb} format supports
4350 \I{PIC}\i{position-independent code} in the same way as the \c{elf}
4351 format, so you can use it to write \c{BSD} \i{shared libraries}.
4353 \c{aoutb} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
4355 \c{aoutb} supports no special directives, no special symbols, and
4356 only the three \i{standard section names} \i\c{.text}, \i\c{.data}
4357 and \i\c{.bss}. However, it also supports the same use of \i\c{WRT} as
4358 \c{elf} does, to provide position-independent code relocation types.
4359 See \k{elfwrt} for full documentation of this feature.
4361 \c{aoutb} also supports the same extensions to the \c{GLOBAL}
4362 directive as \c{elf} does: see \k{elfglob} for documentation of
4366 \H{as86fmt} \c{as86}: \i{Minix}/Linux\I{linux, as86} \i\c{as86} Object Files
4368 The Minix/Linux 16-bit assembler \c{as86} has its own non-standard
4369 object file format. Although its companion linker \i\c{ld86} produces
4370 something close to ordinary \c{a.out} binaries as output, the object
4371 file format used to communicate between \c{as86} and \c{ld86} is not
4374 NASM supports this format, just in case it is useful, as \c{as86}.
4375 \c{as86} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
4377 \c{as86} is a very simple object format (from the NASM user's point
4378 of view). It supports no special directives, no special symbols, no
4379 use of \c{SEG} or \c{WRT}, and no extensions to any standard
4380 directives. It supports only the three \i{standard section names}
4381 \i\c{.text}, \i\c{.data} and \i\c{.bss}.
4384 \H{rdffmt} \I{RDOFF}\i\c{rdf}: \i{Relocatable Dynamic Object File
4387 The \c{rdf} output format produces \c{RDOFF} object files. \c{RDOFF}
4388 (Relocatable Dynamic Object File Format) is a home-grown object-file
4389 format, designed alongside NASM itself and reflecting in its file
4390 format the internal structure of the assembler.
4392 \c{RDOFF} is not used by any well-known operating systems. Those
4393 writing their own systems, however, may well wish to use \c{RDOFF}
4394 as their object format, on the grounds that it is designed primarily
4395 for simplicity and contains very little file-header bureaucracy.
4397 The Unix NASM archive, and the DOS archive which includes sources,
4398 both contain an \I{rdoff subdirectory}\c{rdoff} subdirectory holding
4399 a set of RDOFF utilities: an RDF linker, an \c{RDF} static-library
4400 manager, an RDF file dump utility, and a program which will load and
4401 execute an RDF executable under Linux.
4403 \c{rdf} supports only the \i{standard section names} \i\c{.text},
4404 \i\c{.data} and \i\c{.bss}.
4407 \S{rdflib} Requiring a Library: The \i\c{LIBRARY} Directive
4409 \c{RDOFF} contains a mechanism for an object file to demand a given
4410 library to be linked to the module, either at load time or run time.
4411 This is done by the \c{LIBRARY} directive, which takes one argument
4412 which is the name of the module:
4414 \c library mylib.rdl
4417 \S{rdfmod} Specifying a Module Name: The \i\c{MODULE} Directive
4419 Special \c{RDOFF} header record is used to store the name of the module.
4420 It can be used, for example, by run-time loader to perform dynamic
4421 linking. \c{MODULE} directive takes one argument which is the name
4426 Note that when you statically link modules and tell linker to strip
4427 the symbols from output file, all module names will be stripped too.
4428 To avoid it, you should start module names with \I{$, prefix}\c{$}, like:
4430 \c module $kernel.core
4433 \S{rdfglob} \c{rdf} Extensions to the \c{GLOBAL} directive\I{GLOBAL,
4436 \c{RDOFF} global symbols can contain additional information needed by
4437 the static linker. You can mark a global symbol as exported, thus
4438 telling the linker do not strip it from target executable or library
4439 file. Like in \c{ELF}, you can also specify whether an exported symbol
4440 is a procedure (function) or data object.
4442 Suffixing the name with a colon and the word \i\c{export} you make the
4445 \c global sys_open:export
4447 To specify that exported symbol is a procedure (function), you add the
4448 word \i\c{proc} or \i\c{function} after declaration:
4450 \c global sys_open:export proc
4452 Similarly, to specify exported data object, add the word \i\c{data}
4453 or \i\c{object} to the directive:
4455 \c global kernel_ticks:export data
4458 \H{dbgfmt} \i\c{dbg}: Debugging Format
4460 The \c{dbg} output format is not built into NASM in the default
4461 configuration. If you are building your own NASM executable from the
4462 sources, you can define \i\c{OF_DBG} in \c{outform.h} or on the
4463 compiler command line, and obtain the \c{dbg} output format.
4465 The \c{dbg} format does not output an object file as such; instead,
4466 it outputs a text file which contains a complete list of all the
4467 transactions between the main body of NASM and the output-format
4468 back end module. It is primarily intended to aid people who want to
4469 write their own output drivers, so that they can get a clearer idea
4470 of the various requests the main program makes of the output driver,
4471 and in what order they happen.
4473 For simple files, one can easily use the \c{dbg} format like this:
4475 \c nasm -f dbg filename.asm
4477 which will generate a diagnostic file called \c{filename.dbg}.
4478 However, this will not work well on files which were designed for a
4479 different object format, because each object format defines its own
4480 macros (usually user-level forms of directives), and those macros
4481 will not be defined in the \c{dbg} format. Therefore it can be
4482 useful to run NASM twice, in order to do the preprocessing with the
4483 native object format selected:
4485 \c nasm -e -f rdf -o rdfprog.i rdfprog.asm
4486 \c nasm -a -f dbg rdfprog.i
4488 This preprocesses \c{rdfprog.asm} into \c{rdfprog.i}, keeping the
4489 \c{rdf} object format selected in order to make sure RDF special
4490 directives are converted into primitive form correctly. Then the
4491 preprocessed source is fed through the \c{dbg} format to generate
4492 the final diagnostic output.
4494 This workaround will still typically not work for programs intended
4495 for \c{obj} format, because the \c{obj} \c{SEGMENT} and \c{GROUP}
4496 directives have side effects of defining the segment and group names
4497 as symbols; \c{dbg} will not do this, so the program will not
4498 assemble. You will have to work around that by defining the symbols
4499 yourself (using \c{EXTERN}, for example) if you really need to get a
4500 \c{dbg} trace of an \c{obj}-specific source file.
4502 \c{dbg} accepts any section name and any directives at all, and logs
4503 them all to its output file.
4506 \C{16bit} Writing 16-bit Code (DOS, Windows 3/3.1)
4508 This chapter attempts to cover some of the common issues encountered
4509 when writing 16-bit code to run under \c{MS-DOS} or \c{Windows 3.x}. It
4510 covers how to link programs to produce \c{.EXE} or \c{.COM} files,
4511 how to write \c{.SYS} device drivers, and how to interface assembly
4512 language code with 16-bit C compilers and with Borland Pascal.
4515 \H{exefiles} Producing \i\c{.EXE} Files
4517 Any large program written under DOS needs to be built as a \c{.EXE}
4518 file: only \c{.EXE} files have the necessary internal structure
4519 required to span more than one 64K segment. \i{Windows} programs,
4520 also, have to be built as \c{.EXE} files, since Windows does not
4521 support the \c{.COM} format.
4523 In general, you generate \c{.EXE} files by using the \c{obj} output
4524 format to produce one or more \i\c{.OBJ} files, and then linking
4525 them together using a linker. However, NASM also supports the direct
4526 generation of simple DOS \c{.EXE} files using the \c{bin} output
4527 format (by using \c{DB} and \c{DW} to construct the \c{.EXE} file
4528 header), and a macro package is supplied to do this. Thanks to
4529 Yann Guidon for contributing the code for this.
4531 NASM may also support \c{.EXE} natively as another output format in
4535 \S{objexe} Using the \c{obj} Format To Generate \c{.EXE} Files
4537 This section describes the usual method of generating \c{.EXE} files
4538 by linking \c{.OBJ} files together.
4540 Most 16-bit programming language packages come with a suitable
4541 linker; if you have none of these, there is a free linker called
4542 \i{VAL}\I{linker, free}, available in \c{LZH} archive format from
4543 \W{ftp://x2ftp.oulu.fi/pub/msdos/programming/lang/}\i\c{x2ftp.oulu.fi}.
4544 An LZH archiver can be found at
4545 \W{ftp://ftp.simtel.net/pub/simtelnet/msdos/arcers}\i\c{ftp.simtel.net}.
4546 There is another `free' linker (though this one doesn't come with
4547 sources) called \i{FREELINK}, available from
4548 \W{http://www.pcorner.com/tpc/old/3-101.html}\i\c{www.pcorner.com}.
4549 A third, \i\c{djlink}, written by DJ Delorie, is available at
4550 \W{http://www.delorie.com/djgpp/16bit/djlink/}\i\c{www.delorie.com}.
4551 A fourth linker, \i\c{ALINK}, written by Anthony A.J. Williams, is
4552 available at \W{http://alink.sourceforge.net}\i\c{alink.sourceforge.net}.
4554 When linking several \c{.OBJ} files into a \c{.EXE} file, you should
4555 ensure that exactly one of them has a start point defined (using the
4556 \I{program entry point}\i\c{..start} special symbol defined by the
4557 \c{obj} format: see \k{dotdotstart}). If no module defines a start
4558 point, the linker will not know what value to give the entry-point
4559 field in the output file header; if more than one defines a start
4560 point, the linker will not know \e{which} value to use.
4562 An example of a NASM source file which can be assembled to a
4563 \c{.OBJ} file and linked on its own to a \c{.EXE} is given here. It
4564 demonstrates the basic principles of defining a stack, initialising
4565 the segment registers, and declaring a start point. This file is
4566 also provided in the \I{test subdirectory}\c{test} subdirectory of
4567 the NASM archives, under the name \c{objexe.asm}.
4578 This initial piece of code sets up \c{DS} to point to the data
4579 segment, and initialises \c{SS} and \c{SP} to point to the top of
4580 the provided stack. Notice that interrupts are implicitly disabled
4581 for one instruction after a move into \c{SS}, precisely for this
4582 situation, so that there's no chance of an interrupt occurring
4583 between the loads of \c{SS} and \c{SP} and not having a stack to
4586 Note also that the special symbol \c{..start} is defined at the
4587 beginning of this code, which means that will be the entry point
4588 into the resulting executable file.
4594 The above is the main program: load \c{DS:DX} with a pointer to the
4595 greeting message (\c{hello} is implicitly relative to the segment
4596 \c{data}, which was loaded into \c{DS} in the setup code, so the
4597 full pointer is valid), and call the DOS print-string function.
4602 This terminates the program using another DOS system call.
4606 \c hello: db 'hello, world', 13, 10, '$'
4608 The data segment contains the string we want to display.
4610 \c segment stack stack
4614 The above code declares a stack segment containing 64 bytes of
4615 uninitialised stack space, and points \c{stacktop} at the top of it.
4616 The directive \c{segment stack stack} defines a segment \e{called}
4617 \c{stack}, and also of \e{type} \c{STACK}. The latter is not
4618 necessary to the correct running of the program, but linkers are
4619 likely to issue warnings or errors if your program has no segment of
4622 The above file, when assembled into a \c{.OBJ} file, will link on
4623 its own to a valid \c{.EXE} file, which when run will print `hello,
4624 world' and then exit.
4627 \S{binexe} Using the \c{bin} Format To Generate \c{.EXE} Files
4629 The \c{.EXE} file format is simple enough that it's possible to
4630 build a \c{.EXE} file by writing a pure-binary program and sticking
4631 a 32-byte header on the front. This header is simple enough that it
4632 can be generated using \c{DB} and \c{DW} commands by NASM itself, so
4633 that you can use the \c{bin} output format to directly generate
4636 Included in the NASM archives, in the \I{misc subdirectory}\c{misc}
4637 subdirectory, is a file \i\c{exebin.mac} of macros. It defines three
4638 macros: \i\c{EXE_begin}, \i\c{EXE_stack} and \i\c{EXE_end}.
4640 To produce a \c{.EXE} file using this method, you should start by
4641 using \c{%include} to load the \c{exebin.mac} macro package into
4642 your source file. You should then issue the \c{EXE_begin} macro call
4643 (which takes no arguments) to generate the file header data. Then
4644 write code as normal for the \c{bin} format - you can use all three
4645 standard sections \c{.text}, \c{.data} and \c{.bss}. At the end of
4646 the file you should call the \c{EXE_end} macro (again, no arguments),
4647 which defines some symbols to mark section sizes, and these symbols
4648 are referred to in the header code generated by \c{EXE_begin}.
4650 In this model, the code you end up writing starts at \c{0x100}, just
4651 like a \c{.COM} file - in fact, if you strip off the 32-byte header
4652 from the resulting \c{.EXE} file, you will have a valid \c{.COM}
4653 program. All the segment bases are the same, so you are limited to a
4654 64K program, again just like a \c{.COM} file. Note that an \c{ORG}
4655 directive is issued by the \c{EXE_begin} macro, so you should not
4656 explicitly issue one of your own.
4658 You can't directly refer to your segment base value, unfortunately,
4659 since this would require a relocation in the header, and things
4660 would get a lot more complicated. So you should get your segment
4661 base by copying it out of \c{CS} instead.
4663 On entry to your \c{.EXE} file, \c{SS:SP} are already set up to
4664 point to the top of a 2Kb stack. You can adjust the default stack
4665 size of 2Kb by calling the \c{EXE_stack} macro. For example, to
4666 change the stack size of your program to 64 bytes, you would call
4669 A sample program which generates a \c{.EXE} file in this way is
4670 given in the \c{test} subdirectory of the NASM archive, as
4674 \H{comfiles} Producing \i\c{.COM} Files
4676 While large DOS programs must be written as \c{.EXE} files, small
4677 ones are often better written as \c{.COM} files. \c{.COM} files are
4678 pure binary, and therefore most easily produced using the \c{bin}
4682 \S{combinfmt} Using the \c{bin} Format To Generate \c{.COM} Files
4684 \c{.COM} files expect to be loaded at offset \c{100h} into their
4685 segment (though the segment may change). Execution then begins at
4686 \I\c{ORG}\c{100h}, i.e. right at the start of the program. So to
4687 write a \c{.COM} program, you would create a source file looking
4695 \c ; put your code here
4699 \c ; put data items here
4703 \c ; put uninitialised data here
4705 The \c{bin} format puts the \c{.text} section first in the file, so
4706 you can declare data or BSS items before beginning to write code if
4707 you want to and the code will still end up at the front of the file
4710 The BSS (uninitialised data) section does not take up space in the
4711 \c{.COM} file itself: instead, addresses of BSS items are resolved
4712 to point at space beyond the end of the file, on the grounds that
4713 this will be free memory when the program is run. Therefore you
4714 should not rely on your BSS being initialised to all zeros when you
4717 To assemble the above program, you should use a command line like
4719 \c nasm myprog.asm -fbin -o myprog.com
4721 The \c{bin} format would produce a file called \c{myprog} if no
4722 explicit output file name were specified, so you have to override it
4723 and give the desired file name.
4726 \S{comobjfmt} Using the \c{obj} Format To Generate \c{.COM} Files
4728 If you are writing a \c{.COM} program as more than one module, you
4729 may wish to assemble several \c{.OBJ} files and link them together
4730 into a \c{.COM} program. You can do this, provided you have a linker
4731 capable of outputting \c{.COM} files directly (\i{TLINK} does this),
4732 or alternatively a converter program such as \i\c{EXE2BIN} to
4733 transform the \c{.EXE} file output from the linker into a \c{.COM}
4736 If you do this, you need to take care of several things:
4738 \b The first object file containing code should start its code
4739 segment with a line like \c{RESB 100h}. This is to ensure that the
4740 code begins at offset \c{100h} relative to the beginning of the code
4741 segment, so that the linker or converter program does not have to
4742 adjust address references within the file when generating the
4743 \c{.COM} file. Other assemblers use an \i\c{ORG} directive for this
4744 purpose, but \c{ORG} in NASM is a format-specific directive to the
4745 \c{bin} output format, and does not mean the same thing as it does
4746 in MASM-compatible assemblers.
4748 \b You don't need to define a stack segment.
4750 \b All your segments should be in the same group, so that every time
4751 your code or data references a symbol offset, all offsets are
4752 relative to the same segment base. This is because, when a \c{.COM}
4753 file is loaded, all the segment registers contain the same value.
4756 \H{sysfiles} Producing \i\c{.SYS} Files
4758 \i{MS-DOS device drivers} - \c{.SYS} files - are pure binary files,
4759 similar to \c{.COM} files, except that they start at origin zero
4760 rather than \c{100h}. Therefore, if you are writing a device driver
4761 using the \c{bin} format, you do not need the \c{ORG} directive,
4762 since the default origin for \c{bin} is zero. Similarly, if you are
4763 using \c{obj}, you do not need the \c{RESB 100h} at the start of
4766 \c{.SYS} files start with a header structure, containing pointers to
4767 the various routines inside the driver which do the work. This
4768 structure should be defined at the start of the code segment, even
4769 though it is not actually code.
4771 For more information on the format of \c{.SYS} files, and the data
4772 which has to go in the header structure, a list of books is given in
4773 the Frequently Asked Questions list for the newsgroup
4774 \W{news:comp.os.msdos.programmer}\i\c{comp.os.msdos.programmer}.
4777 \H{16c} Interfacing to 16-bit C Programs
4779 This section covers the basics of writing assembly routines that
4780 call, or are called from, C programs. To do this, you would
4781 typically write an assembly module as a \c{.OBJ} file, and link it
4782 with your C modules to produce a \i{mixed-language program}.
4785 \S{16cunder} External Symbol Names
4787 \I{C symbol names}\I{underscore, in C symbols}C compilers have the
4788 convention that the names of all global symbols (functions or data)
4789 they define are formed by prefixing an underscore to the name as it
4790 appears in the C program. So, for example, the function a C
4791 programmer thinks of as \c{printf} appears to an assembly language
4792 programmer as \c{_printf}. This means that in your assembly
4793 programs, you can define symbols without a leading underscore, and
4794 not have to worry about name clashes with C symbols.
4796 If you find the underscores inconvenient, you can define macros to
4797 replace the \c{GLOBAL} and \c{EXTERN} directives as follows:
4813 (These forms of the macros only take one argument at a time; a
4814 \c{%rep} construct could solve this.)
4816 If you then declare an external like this:
4820 then the macro will expand it as
4823 \c %define printf _printf
4825 Thereafter, you can reference \c{printf} as if it was a symbol, and
4826 the preprocessor will put the leading underscore on where necessary.
4828 The \c{cglobal} macro works similarly. You must use \c{cglobal}
4829 before defining the symbol in question, but you would have had to do
4830 that anyway if you used \c{GLOBAL}.
4833 \S{16cmodels} \i{Memory Models}
4835 NASM contains no mechanism to support the various C memory models
4836 directly; you have to keep track yourself of which one you are
4837 writing for. This means you have to keep track of the following
4840 \b In models using a single code segment (tiny, small and compact),
4841 functions are near. This means that function pointers, when stored
4842 in data segments or pushed on the stack as function arguments, are
4843 16 bits long and contain only an offset field (the \c{CS} register
4844 never changes its value, and always gives the segment part of the
4845 full function address), and that functions are called using ordinary
4846 near \c{CALL} instructions and return using \c{RETN} (which, in
4847 NASM, is synonymous with \c{RET} anyway). This means both that you
4848 should write your own routines to return with \c{RETN}, and that you
4849 should call external C routines with near \c{CALL} instructions.
4851 \b In models using more than one code segment (medium, large and
4852 huge), functions are far. This means that function pointers are 32
4853 bits long (consisting of a 16-bit offset followed by a 16-bit
4854 segment), and that functions are called using \c{CALL FAR} (or
4855 \c{CALL seg:offset}) and return using \c{RETF}. Again, you should
4856 therefore write your own routines to return with \c{RETF} and use
4857 \c{CALL FAR} to call external routines.
4859 \b In models using a single data segment (tiny, small and medium),
4860 data pointers are 16 bits long, containing only an offset field (the
4861 \c{DS} register doesn't change its value, and always gives the
4862 segment part of the full data item address).
4864 \b In models using more than one data segment (compact, large and
4865 huge), data pointers are 32 bits long, consisting of a 16-bit offset
4866 followed by a 16-bit segment. You should still be careful not to
4867 modify \c{DS} in your routines without restoring it afterwards, but
4868 \c{ES} is free for you to use to access the contents of 32-bit data
4869 pointers you are passed.
4871 \b The huge memory model allows single data items to exceed 64K in
4872 size. In all other memory models, you can access the whole of a data
4873 item just by doing arithmetic on the offset field of the pointer you
4874 are given, whether a segment field is present or not; in huge model,
4875 you have to be more careful of your pointer arithmetic.
4877 \b In most memory models, there is a \e{default} data segment, whose
4878 segment address is kept in \c{DS} throughout the program. This data
4879 segment is typically the same segment as the stack, kept in \c{SS},
4880 so that functions' local variables (which are stored on the stack)
4881 and global data items can both be accessed easily without changing
4882 \c{DS}. Particularly large data items are typically stored in other
4883 segments. However, some memory models (though not the standard
4884 ones, usually) allow the assumption that \c{SS} and \c{DS} hold the
4885 same value to be removed. Be careful about functions' local
4886 variables in this latter case.
4888 In models with a single code segment, the segment is called
4889 \i\c{_TEXT}, so your code segment must also go by this name in order
4890 to be linked into the same place as the main code segment. In models
4891 with a single data segment, or with a default data segment, it is
4895 \S{16cfunc} Function Definitions and Function Calls
4897 \I{functions, C calling convention}The \i{C calling convention} in
4898 16-bit programs is as follows. In the following description, the
4899 words \e{caller} and \e{callee} are used to denote the function
4900 doing the calling and the function which gets called.
4902 \b The caller pushes the function's parameters on the stack, one
4903 after another, in reverse order (right to left, so that the first
4904 argument specified to the function is pushed last).
4906 \b The caller then executes a \c{CALL} instruction to pass control
4907 to the callee. This \c{CALL} is either near or far depending on the
4910 \b The callee receives control, and typically (although this is not
4911 actually necessary, in functions which do not need to access their
4912 parameters) starts by saving the value of \c{SP} in \c{BP} so as to
4913 be able to use \c{BP} as a base pointer to find its parameters on
4914 the stack. However, the caller was probably doing this too, so part
4915 of the calling convention states that \c{BP} must be preserved by
4916 any C function. Hence the callee, if it is going to set up \c{BP} as
4917 a \i\e{frame pointer}, must push the previous value first.
4919 \b The callee may then access its parameters relative to \c{BP}.
4920 The word at \c{[BP]} holds the previous value of \c{BP} as it was
4921 pushed; the next word, at \c{[BP+2]}, holds the offset part of the
4922 return address, pushed implicitly by \c{CALL}. In a small-model
4923 (near) function, the parameters start after that, at \c{[BP+4]}; in
4924 a large-model (far) function, the segment part of the return address
4925 lives at \c{[BP+4]}, and the parameters begin at \c{[BP+6]}. The
4926 leftmost parameter of the function, since it was pushed last, is
4927 accessible at this offset from \c{BP}; the others follow, at
4928 successively greater offsets. Thus, in a function such as \c{printf}
4929 which takes a variable number of parameters, the pushing of the
4930 parameters in reverse order means that the function knows where to
4931 find its first parameter, which tells it the number and type of the
4934 \b The callee may also wish to decrease \c{SP} further, so as to
4935 allocate space on the stack for local variables, which will then be
4936 accessible at negative offsets from \c{BP}.
4938 \b The callee, if it wishes to return a value to the caller, should
4939 leave the value in \c{AL}, \c{AX} or \c{DX:AX} depending on the size
4940 of the value. Floating-point results are sometimes (depending on the
4941 compiler) returned in \c{ST0}.
4943 \b Once the callee has finished processing, it restores \c{SP} from
4944 \c{BP} if it had allocated local stack space, then pops the previous
4945 value of \c{BP}, and returns via \c{RETN} or \c{RETF} depending on
4948 \b When the caller regains control from the callee, the function
4949 parameters are still on the stack, so it typically adds an immediate
4950 constant to \c{SP} to remove them (instead of executing a number of
4951 slow \c{POP} instructions). Thus, if a function is accidentally
4952 called with the wrong number of parameters due to a prototype
4953 mismatch, the stack will still be returned to a sensible state since
4954 the caller, which \e{knows} how many parameters it pushed, does the
4957 It is instructive to compare this calling convention with that for
4958 Pascal programs (described in \k{16bpfunc}). Pascal has a simpler
4959 convention, since no functions have variable numbers of parameters.
4960 Therefore the callee knows how many parameters it should have been
4961 passed, and is able to deallocate them from the stack itself by
4962 passing an immediate argument to the \c{RET} or \c{RETF}
4963 instruction, so the caller does not have to do it. Also, the
4964 parameters are pushed in left-to-right order, not right-to-left,
4965 which means that a compiler can give better guarantees about
4966 sequence points without performance suffering.
4968 Thus, you would define a function in C style in the following way.
4969 The following example is for small model:
4976 \c sub sp,0x40 ; 64 bytes of local stack space
4977 \c mov bx,[bp+4] ; first parameter to function
4981 \c mov sp,bp ; undo "sub sp,0x40" above
4985 For a large-model function, you would replace \c{RET} by \c{RETF},
4986 and look for the first parameter at \c{[BP+6]} instead of
4987 \c{[BP+4]}. Of course, if one of the parameters is a pointer, then
4988 the offsets of \e{subsequent} parameters will change depending on
4989 the memory model as well: far pointers take up four bytes on the
4990 stack when passed as a parameter, whereas near pointers take up two.
4992 At the other end of the process, to call a C function from your
4993 assembly code, you would do something like this:
4997 \c ; and then, further down...
4999 \c push word [myint] ; one of my integer variables
5000 \c push word mystring ; pointer into my data segment
5002 \c add sp,byte 4 ; `byte' saves space
5004 \c ; then those data items...
5009 \c mystring db 'This number -> %d <- should be 1234',10,0
5011 This piece of code is the small-model assembly equivalent of the C
5014 \c int myint = 1234;
5015 \c printf("This number -> %d <- should be 1234\n", myint);
5017 In large model, the function-call code might look more like this. In
5018 this example, it is assumed that \c{DS} already holds the segment
5019 base of the segment \c{_DATA}. If not, you would have to initialise
5022 \c push word [myint]
5023 \c push word seg mystring ; Now push the segment, and...
5024 \c push word mystring ; ... offset of "mystring"
5028 The integer value still takes up one word on the stack, since large
5029 model does not affect the size of the \c{int} data type. The first
5030 argument (pushed last) to \c{printf}, however, is a data pointer,
5031 and therefore has to contain a segment and offset part. The segment
5032 should be stored second in memory, and therefore must be pushed
5033 first. (Of course, \c{PUSH DS} would have been a shorter instruction
5034 than \c{PUSH WORD SEG mystring}, if \c{DS} was set up as the above
5035 example assumed.) Then the actual call becomes a far call, since
5036 functions expect far calls in large model; and \c{SP} has to be
5037 increased by 6 rather than 4 afterwards to make up for the extra
5041 \S{16cdata} Accessing Data Items
5043 To get at the contents of C variables, or to declare variables which
5044 C can access, you need only declare the names as \c{GLOBAL} or
5045 \c{EXTERN}. (Again, the names require leading underscores, as stated
5046 in \k{16cunder}.) Thus, a C variable declared as \c{int i} can be
5047 accessed from assembler as
5053 And to declare your own integer variable which C programs can access
5054 as \c{extern int j}, you do this (making sure you are assembling in
5055 the \c{_DATA} segment, if necessary):
5061 To access a C array, you need to know the size of the components of
5062 the array. For example, \c{int} variables are two bytes long, so if
5063 a C program declares an array as \c{int a[10]}, you can access
5064 \c{a[3]} by coding \c{mov ax,[_a+6]}. (The byte offset 6 is obtained
5065 by multiplying the desired array index, 3, by the size of the array
5066 element, 2.) The sizes of the C base types in 16-bit compilers are:
5067 1 for \c{char}, 2 for \c{short} and \c{int}, 4 for \c{long} and
5068 \c{float}, and 8 for \c{double}.
5070 To access a C \i{data structure}, you need to know the offset from
5071 the base of the structure to the field you are interested in. You
5072 can either do this by converting the C structure definition into a
5073 NASM structure definition (using \i\c{STRUC}), or by calculating the
5074 one offset and using just that.
5076 To do either of these, you should read your C compiler's manual to
5077 find out how it organises data structures. NASM gives no special
5078 alignment to structure members in its own \c{STRUC} macro, so you
5079 have to specify alignment yourself if the C compiler generates it.
5080 Typically, you might find that a structure like
5087 might be four bytes long rather than three, since the \c{int} field
5088 would be aligned to a two-byte boundary. However, this sort of
5089 feature tends to be a configurable option in the C compiler, either
5090 using command-line options or \c{#pragma} lines, so you have to find
5091 out how your own compiler does it.
5094 \S{16cmacro} \i\c{c16.mac}: Helper Macros for the 16-bit C Interface
5096 Included in the NASM archives, in the \I{misc subdirectory}\c{misc}
5097 directory, is a file \c{c16.mac} of macros. It defines three macros:
5098 \i\c{proc}, \i\c{arg} and \i\c{endproc}. These are intended to be
5099 used for C-style procedure definitions, and they automate a lot of
5100 the work involved in keeping track of the calling convention.
5102 (An alternative, TASM compatible form of \c{arg} is also now built
5103 into NASM's preprocessor. See \k{tasmcompat} for details.)
5105 An example of an assembly function using the macro set is given
5112 \c mov ax,[bp + %$i]
5113 \c mov bx,[bp + %$j]
5118 This defines \c{_nearproc} to be a procedure taking two arguments,
5119 the first (\c{i}) an integer and the second (\c{j}) a pointer to an
5120 integer. It returns \c{i + *j}.
5122 Note that the \c{arg} macro has an \c{EQU} as the first line of its
5123 expansion, and since the label before the macro call gets prepended
5124 to the first line of the expanded macro, the \c{EQU} works, defining
5125 \c{%$i} to be an offset from \c{BP}. A context-local variable is
5126 used, local to the context pushed by the \c{proc} macro and popped
5127 by the \c{endproc} macro, so that the same argument name can be used
5128 in later procedures. Of course, you don't \e{have} to do that.
5130 The macro set produces code for near functions (tiny, small and
5131 compact-model code) by default. You can have it generate far
5132 functions (medium, large and huge-model code) by means of coding
5133 \I\c{FARCODE}\c{%define FARCODE}. This changes the kind of return
5134 instruction generated by \c{endproc}, and also changes the starting
5135 point for the argument offsets. The macro set contains no intrinsic
5136 dependency on whether data pointers are far or not.
5138 \c{arg} can take an optional parameter, giving the size of the
5139 argument. If no size is given, 2 is assumed, since it is likely that
5140 many function parameters will be of type \c{int}.
5142 The large-model equivalent of the above function would look like this:
5150 \c mov ax,[bp + %$i]
5151 \c mov bx,[bp + %$j]
5152 \c mov es,[bp + %$j + 2]
5157 This makes use of the argument to the \c{arg} macro to define a
5158 parameter of size 4, because \c{j} is now a far pointer. When we
5159 load from \c{j}, we must load a segment and an offset.
5162 \H{16bp} Interfacing to \i{Borland Pascal} Programs
5164 Interfacing to Borland Pascal programs is similar in concept to
5165 interfacing to 16-bit C programs. The differences are:
5167 \b The leading underscore required for interfacing to C programs is
5168 not required for Pascal.
5170 \b The memory model is always large: functions are far, data
5171 pointers are far, and no data item can be more than 64K long.
5172 (Actually, some functions are near, but only those functions that
5173 are local to a Pascal unit and never called from outside it. All
5174 assembly functions that Pascal calls, and all Pascal functions that
5175 assembly routines are able to call, are far.) However, all static
5176 data declared in a Pascal program goes into the default data
5177 segment, which is the one whose segment address will be in \c{DS}
5178 when control is passed to your assembly code. The only things that
5179 do not live in the default data segment are local variables (they
5180 live in the stack segment) and dynamically allocated variables. All
5181 data \e{pointers}, however, are far.
5183 \b The function calling convention is different - described below.
5185 \b Some data types, such as strings, are stored differently.
5187 \b There are restrictions on the segment names you are allowed to
5188 use - Borland Pascal will ignore code or data declared in a segment
5189 it doesn't like the name of. The restrictions are described below.
5192 \S{16bpfunc} The Pascal Calling Convention
5194 \I{functions, Pascal calling convention}\I{Pascal calling
5195 convention}The 16-bit Pascal calling convention is as follows. In
5196 the following description, the words \e{caller} and \e{callee} are
5197 used to denote the function doing the calling and the function which
5200 \b The caller pushes the function's parameters on the stack, one
5201 after another, in normal order (left to right, so that the first
5202 argument specified to the function is pushed first).
5204 \b The caller then executes a far \c{CALL} instruction to pass
5205 control to the callee.
5207 \b The callee receives control, and typically (although this is not
5208 actually necessary, in functions which do not need to access their
5209 parameters) starts by saving the value of \c{SP} in \c{BP} so as to
5210 be able to use \c{BP} as a base pointer to find its parameters on
5211 the stack. However, the caller was probably doing this too, so part
5212 of the calling convention states that \c{BP} must be preserved by
5213 any function. Hence the callee, if it is going to set up \c{BP} as a
5214 \i{frame pointer}, must push the previous value first.
5216 \b The callee may then access its parameters relative to \c{BP}.
5217 The word at \c{[BP]} holds the previous value of \c{BP} as it was
5218 pushed. The next word, at \c{[BP+2]}, holds the offset part of the
5219 return address, and the next one at \c{[BP+4]} the segment part. The
5220 parameters begin at \c{[BP+6]}. The rightmost parameter of the
5221 function, since it was pushed last, is accessible at this offset
5222 from \c{BP}; the others follow, at successively greater offsets.
5224 \b The callee may also wish to decrease \c{SP} further, so as to
5225 allocate space on the stack for local variables, which will then be
5226 accessible at negative offsets from \c{BP}.
5228 \b The callee, if it wishes to return a value to the caller, should
5229 leave the value in \c{AL}, \c{AX} or \c{DX:AX} depending on the size
5230 of the value. Floating-point results are returned in \c{ST0}.
5231 Results of type \c{Real} (Borland's own custom floating-point data
5232 type, not handled directly by the FPU) are returned in \c{DX:BX:AX}.
5233 To return a result of type \c{String}, the caller pushes a pointer
5234 to a temporary string before pushing the parameters, and the callee
5235 places the returned string value at that location. The pointer is
5236 not a parameter, and should not be removed from the stack by the
5237 \c{RETF} instruction.
5239 \b Once the callee has finished processing, it restores \c{SP} from
5240 \c{BP} if it had allocated local stack space, then pops the previous
5241 value of \c{BP}, and returns via \c{RETF}. It uses the form of
5242 \c{RETF} with an immediate parameter, giving the number of bytes
5243 taken up by the parameters on the stack. This causes the parameters
5244 to be removed from the stack as a side effect of the return
5247 \b When the caller regains control from the callee, the function
5248 parameters have already been removed from the stack, so it needs to
5251 Thus, you would define a function in Pascal style, taking two
5252 \c{Integer}-type parameters, in the following way:
5258 \c sub sp,0x40 ; 64 bytes of local stack space
5259 \c mov bx,[bp+8] ; first parameter to function
5260 \c mov bx,[bp+6] ; second parameter to function
5264 \c mov sp,bp ; undo "sub sp,0x40" above
5266 \c retf 4 ; total size of params is 4
5268 At the other end of the process, to call a Pascal function from your
5269 assembly code, you would do something like this:
5273 \c ; and then, further down...
5275 \c push word seg mystring ; Now push the segment, and...
5276 \c push word mystring ; ... offset of "mystring"
5277 \c push word [myint] ; one of my variables
5278 \c call far SomeFunc
5280 This is equivalent to the Pascal code
5282 \c procedure SomeFunc(String: PChar; Int: Integer);
5283 \c SomeFunc(@mystring, myint);
5286 \S{16bpseg} Borland Pascal \I{segment names, Borland Pascal}Segment
5289 Since Borland Pascal's internal unit file format is completely
5290 different from \c{OBJ}, it only makes a very sketchy job of actually
5291 reading and understanding the various information contained in a
5292 real \c{OBJ} file when it links that in. Therefore an object file
5293 intended to be linked to a Pascal program must obey a number of
5296 \b Procedures and functions must be in a segment whose name is
5297 either \c{CODE}, \c{CSEG}, or something ending in \c{_TEXT}.
5299 \b Initialised data must be in a segment whose name is either
5300 \c{CONST} or something ending in \c{_DATA}.
5302 \b Uninitialised data must be in a segment whose name is either
5303 \c{DATA}, \c{DSEG}, or something ending in \c{_BSS}.
5305 \b Any other segments in the object file are completely ignored.
5306 \c{GROUP} directives and segment attributes are also ignored.
5309 \S{16bpmacro} Using \i\c{c16.mac} With Pascal Programs
5311 The \c{c16.mac} macro package, described in \k{16cmacro}, can also
5312 be used to simplify writing functions to be called from Pascal
5313 programs, if you code \I\c{PASCAL}\c{%define PASCAL}. This
5314 definition ensures that functions are far (it implies
5315 \i\c{FARCODE}), and also causes procedure return instructions to be
5316 generated with an operand.
5318 Defining \c{PASCAL} does not change the code which calculates the
5319 argument offsets; you must declare your function's arguments in
5320 reverse order. For example:
5328 \c mov ax,[bp + %$i]
5329 \c mov bx,[bp + %$j]
5330 \c mov es,[bp + %$j + 2]
5335 This defines the same routine, conceptually, as the example in
5336 \k{16cmacro}: it defines a function taking two arguments, an integer
5337 and a pointer to an integer, which returns the sum of the integer
5338 and the contents of the pointer. The only difference between this
5339 code and the large-model C version is that \c{PASCAL} is defined
5340 instead of \c{FARCODE}, and that the arguments are declared in
5344 \C{32bit} Writing 32-bit Code (Unix, Win32, DJGPP)
5346 This chapter attempts to cover some of the common issues involved
5347 when writing 32-bit code, to run under \i{Win32} or Unix, or to be
5348 linked with C code generated by a Unix-style C compiler such as
5349 \i{DJGPP}. It covers how to write assembly code to interface with
5350 32-bit C routines, and how to write position-independent code for
5353 Almost all 32-bit code, and in particular all code running under
5354 \c{Win32}, \c{DJGPP} or any of the PC Unix variants, runs in \I{flat
5355 memory model}\e{flat} memory model. This means that the segment registers
5356 and paging have already been set up to give you the same 32-bit 4Gb
5357 address space no matter what segment you work relative to, and that
5358 you should ignore all segment registers completely. When writing
5359 flat-model application code, you never need to use a segment
5360 override or modify any segment register, and the code-section
5361 addresses you pass to \c{CALL} and \c{JMP} live in the same address
5362 space as the data-section addresses you access your variables by and
5363 the stack-section addresses you access local variables and procedure
5364 parameters by. Every address is 32 bits long and contains only an
5368 \H{32c} Interfacing to 32-bit C Programs
5370 A lot of the discussion in \k{16c}, about interfacing to 16-bit C
5371 programs, still applies when working in 32 bits. The absence of
5372 memory models or segmentation worries simplifies things a lot.
5375 \S{32cunder} External Symbol Names
5377 Most 32-bit C compilers share the convention used by 16-bit
5378 compilers, that the names of all global symbols (functions or data)
5379 they define are formed by prefixing an underscore to the name as it
5380 appears in the C program. However, not all of them do: the \c{ELF}
5381 specification states that C symbols do \e{not} have a leading
5382 underscore on their assembly-language names.
5384 The older Linux \c{a.out} C compiler, all \c{Win32} compilers,
5385 \c{DJGPP}, and \c{NetBSD} and \c{FreeBSD}, all use the leading
5386 underscore; for these compilers, the macros \c{cextern} and
5387 \c{cglobal}, as given in \k{16cunder}, will still work. For \c{ELF},
5388 though, the leading underscore should not be used.
5391 \S{32cfunc} Function Definitions and Function Calls
5393 \I{functions, C calling convention}The \i{C calling convention}The C
5394 calling convention in 32-bit programs is as follows. In the
5395 following description, the words \e{caller} and \e{callee} are used
5396 to denote the function doing the calling and the function which gets
5399 \b The caller pushes the function's parameters on the stack, one
5400 after another, in reverse order (right to left, so that the first
5401 argument specified to the function is pushed last).
5403 \b The caller then executes a near \c{CALL} instruction to pass
5404 control to the callee.
5406 \b The callee receives control, and typically (although this is not
5407 actually necessary, in functions which do not need to access their
5408 parameters) starts by saving the value of \c{ESP} in \c{EBP} so as
5409 to be able to use \c{EBP} as a base pointer to find its parameters
5410 on the stack. However, the caller was probably doing this too, so
5411 part of the calling convention states that \c{EBP} must be preserved
5412 by any C function. Hence the callee, if it is going to set up
5413 \c{EBP} as a \i{frame pointer}, must push the previous value first.
5415 \b The callee may then access its parameters relative to \c{EBP}.
5416 The doubleword at \c{[EBP]} holds the previous value of \c{EBP} as
5417 it was pushed; the next doubleword, at \c{[EBP+4]}, holds the return
5418 address, pushed implicitly by \c{CALL}. The parameters start after
5419 that, at \c{[EBP+8]}. The leftmost parameter of the function, since
5420 it was pushed last, is accessible at this offset from \c{EBP}; the
5421 others follow, at successively greater offsets. Thus, in a function
5422 such as \c{printf} which takes a variable number of parameters, the
5423 pushing of the parameters in reverse order means that the function
5424 knows where to find its first parameter, which tells it the number
5425 and type of the remaining ones.
5427 \b The callee may also wish to decrease \c{ESP} further, so as to
5428 allocate space on the stack for local variables, which will then be
5429 accessible at negative offsets from \c{EBP}.
5431 \b The callee, if it wishes to return a value to the caller, should
5432 leave the value in \c{AL}, \c{AX} or \c{EAX} depending on the size
5433 of the value. Floating-point results are typically returned in
5436 \b Once the callee has finished processing, it restores \c{ESP} from
5437 \c{EBP} if it had allocated local stack space, then pops the previous
5438 value of \c{EBP}, and returns via \c{RET} (equivalently, \c{RETN}).
5440 \b When the caller regains control from the callee, the function
5441 parameters are still on the stack, so it typically adds an immediate
5442 constant to \c{ESP} to remove them (instead of executing a number of
5443 slow \c{POP} instructions). Thus, if a function is accidentally
5444 called with the wrong number of parameters due to a prototype
5445 mismatch, the stack will still be returned to a sensible state since
5446 the caller, which \e{knows} how many parameters it pushed, does the
5449 There is an alternative calling convention used by Win32 programs
5450 for Windows API calls, and also for functions called \e{by} the
5451 Windows API such as window procedures: they follow what Microsoft
5452 calls the \c{__stdcall} convention. This is slightly closer to the
5453 Pascal convention, in that the callee clears the stack by passing a
5454 parameter to the \c{RET} instruction. However, the parameters are
5455 still pushed in right-to-left order.
5457 Thus, you would define a function in C style in the following way:
5464 \c sub esp,0x40 ; 64 bytes of local stack space
5465 \c mov ebx,[ebp+8] ; first parameter to function
5469 \c leave ; mov esp,ebp / pop ebp
5472 At the other end of the process, to call a C function from your
5473 assembly code, you would do something like this:
5477 \c ; and then, further down...
5479 \c push dword [myint] ; one of my integer variables
5480 \c push dword mystring ; pointer into my data segment
5482 \c add esp,byte 8 ; `byte' saves space
5484 \c ; then those data items...
5489 \c mystring db 'This number -> %d <- should be 1234',10,0
5491 This piece of code is the assembly equivalent of the C code
5493 \c int myint = 1234;
5494 \c printf("This number -> %d <- should be 1234\n", myint);
5497 \S{32cdata} Accessing Data Items
5499 To get at the contents of C variables, or to declare variables which
5500 C can access, you need only declare the names as \c{GLOBAL} or
5501 \c{EXTERN}. (Again, the names require leading underscores, as stated
5502 in \k{32cunder}.) Thus, a C variable declared as \c{int i} can be
5503 accessed from assembler as
5508 And to declare your own integer variable which C programs can access
5509 as \c{extern int j}, you do this (making sure you are assembling in
5510 the \c{_DATA} segment, if necessary):
5515 To access a C array, you need to know the size of the components of
5516 the array. For example, \c{int} variables are four bytes long, so if
5517 a C program declares an array as \c{int a[10]}, you can access
5518 \c{a[3]} by coding \c{mov ax,[_a+12]}. (The byte offset 12 is obtained
5519 by multiplying the desired array index, 3, by the size of the array
5520 element, 4.) The sizes of the C base types in 32-bit compilers are:
5521 1 for \c{char}, 2 for \c{short}, 4 for \c{int}, \c{long} and
5522 \c{float}, and 8 for \c{double}. Pointers, being 32-bit addresses,
5523 are also 4 bytes long.
5525 To access a C \i{data structure}, you need to know the offset from
5526 the base of the structure to the field you are interested in. You
5527 can either do this by converting the C structure definition into a
5528 NASM structure definition (using \c{STRUC}), or by calculating the
5529 one offset and using just that.
5531 To do either of these, you should read your C compiler's manual to
5532 find out how it organises data structures. NASM gives no special
5533 alignment to structure members in its own \i\c{STRUC} macro, so you
5534 have to specify alignment yourself if the C compiler generates it.
5535 Typically, you might find that a structure like
5542 might be eight bytes long rather than five, since the \c{int} field
5543 would be aligned to a four-byte boundary. However, this sort of
5544 feature is sometimes a configurable option in the C compiler, either
5545 using command-line options or \c{#pragma} lines, so you have to find
5546 out how your own compiler does it.
5549 \S{32cmacro} \i\c{c32.mac}: Helper Macros for the 32-bit C Interface
5551 Included in the NASM archives, in the \I{misc directory}\c{misc}
5552 directory, is a file \c{c32.mac} of macros. It defines three macros:
5553 \i\c{proc}, \i\c{arg} and \i\c{endproc}. These are intended to be
5554 used for C-style procedure definitions, and they automate a lot of
5555 the work involved in keeping track of the calling convention.
5557 An example of an assembly function using the macro set is given
5564 \c mov eax,[ebp + %$i]
5565 \c mov ebx,[ebp + %$j]
5570 This defines \c{_proc32} to be a procedure taking two arguments, the
5571 first (\c{i}) an integer and the second (\c{j}) a pointer to an
5572 integer. It returns \c{i + *j}.
5574 Note that the \c{arg} macro has an \c{EQU} as the first line of its
5575 expansion, and since the label before the macro call gets prepended
5576 to the first line of the expanded macro, the \c{EQU} works, defining
5577 \c{%$i} to be an offset from \c{BP}. A context-local variable is
5578 used, local to the context pushed by the \c{proc} macro and popped
5579 by the \c{endproc} macro, so that the same argument name can be used
5580 in later procedures. Of course, you don't \e{have} to do that.
5582 \c{arg} can take an optional parameter, giving the size of the
5583 argument. If no size is given, 4 is assumed, since it is likely that
5584 many function parameters will be of type \c{int} or pointers.
5587 \H{picdll} Writing NetBSD/FreeBSD/OpenBSD and Linux/ELF \i{Shared
5590 \c{ELF} replaced the older \c{a.out} object file format under Linux
5591 because it contains support for \i{position-independent code}
5592 (\i{PIC}), which makes writing shared libraries much easier. NASM
5593 supports the \c{ELF} position-independent code features, so you can
5594 write Linux \c{ELF} shared libraries in NASM.
5596 \i{NetBSD}, and its close cousins \i{FreeBSD} and \i{OpenBSD}, take
5597 a different approach by hacking PIC support into the \c{a.out}
5598 format. NASM supports this as the \i\c{aoutb} output format, so you
5599 can write \i{BSD} shared libraries in NASM too.
5601 The operating system loads a PIC shared library by memory-mapping
5602 the library file at an arbitrarily chosen point in the address space
5603 of the running process. The contents of the library's code section
5604 must therefore not depend on where it is loaded in memory.
5606 Therefore, you cannot get at your variables by writing code like
5609 \c mov eax,[myvar] ; WRONG
5611 Instead, the linker provides an area of memory called the
5612 \i\e{global offset table}, or \i{GOT}; the GOT is situated at a
5613 constant distance from your library's code, so if you can find out
5614 where your library is loaded (which is typically done using a
5615 \c{CALL} and \c{POP} combination), you can obtain the address of the
5616 GOT, and you can then load the addresses of your variables out of
5617 linker-generated entries in the GOT.
5619 The \e{data} section of a PIC shared library does not have these
5620 restrictions: since the data section is writable, it has to be
5621 copied into memory anyway rather than just paged in from the library
5622 file, so as long as it's being copied it can be relocated too. So
5623 you can put ordinary types of relocation in the data section without
5624 too much worry (but see \k{picglobal} for a caveat).
5627 \S{picgot} Obtaining the Address of the GOT
5629 Each code module in your shared library should define the GOT as an
5632 \c extern _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ ; in ELF
5633 \c extern __GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ ; in BSD a.out
5635 At the beginning of any function in your shared library which plans
5636 to access your data or BSS sections, you must first calculate the
5637 address of the GOT. This is typically done by writing the function
5646 \c add ebx,_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_+$$-.get_GOT wrt ..gotpc
5648 \c ; the function body comes here
5655 (For BSD, again, the symbol \c{_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE} requires a
5656 second leading underscore.)
5658 The first two lines of this function are simply the standard C
5659 prologue to set up a stack frame, and the last three lines are
5660 standard C function epilogue. The third line, and the fourth to last
5661 line, save and restore the \c{EBX} register, because PIC shared
5662 libraries use this register to store the address of the GOT.
5664 The interesting bit is the \c{CALL} instruction and the following
5665 two lines. The \c{CALL} and \c{POP} combination obtains the address
5666 of the label \c{.get_GOT}, without having to know in advance where
5667 the program was loaded (since the \c{CALL} instruction is encoded
5668 relative to the current position). The \c{ADD} instruction makes use
5669 of one of the special PIC relocation types: \i{GOTPC relocation}.
5670 With the \i\c{WRT ..gotpc} qualifier specified, the symbol
5671 referenced (here \c{_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_}, the special symbol
5672 assigned to the GOT) is given as an offset from the beginning of the
5673 section. (Actually, \c{ELF} encodes it as the offset from the operand
5674 field of the \c{ADD} instruction, but NASM simplifies this
5675 deliberately, so you do things the same way for both \c{ELF} and
5676 \c{BSD}.) So the instruction then \e{adds} the beginning of the section,
5677 to get the real address of the GOT, and subtracts the value of
5678 \c{.get_GOT} which it knows is in \c{EBX}. Therefore, by the time
5679 that instruction has finished, \c{EBX} contains the address of the GOT.
5681 If you didn't follow that, don't worry: it's never necessary to
5682 obtain the address of the GOT by any other means, so you can put
5683 those three instructions into a macro and safely ignore them:
5690 \c add ebx,_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_+$$-%%getgot wrt ..gotpc
5694 \S{piclocal} Finding Your Local Data Items
5696 Having got the GOT, you can then use it to obtain the addresses of
5697 your data items. Most variables will reside in the sections you have
5698 declared; they can be accessed using the \I{GOTOFF
5699 relocation}\c{..gotoff} special \I\c{WRT ..gotoff}\c{WRT} type. The
5700 way this works is like this:
5702 \c lea eax,[ebx+myvar wrt ..gotoff]
5704 The expression \c{myvar wrt ..gotoff} is calculated, when the shared
5705 library is linked, to be the offset to the local variable \c{myvar}
5706 from the beginning of the GOT. Therefore, adding it to \c{EBX} as
5707 above will place the real address of \c{myvar} in \c{EAX}.
5709 If you declare variables as \c{GLOBAL} without specifying a size for
5710 them, they are shared between code modules in the library, but do
5711 not get exported from the library to the program that loaded it.
5712 They will still be in your ordinary data and BSS sections, so you
5713 can access them in the same way as local variables, using the above
5714 \c{..gotoff} mechanism.
5716 Note that due to a peculiarity of the way BSD \c{a.out} format
5717 handles this relocation type, there must be at least one non-local
5718 symbol in the same section as the address you're trying to access.
5721 \S{picextern} Finding External and Common Data Items
5723 If your library needs to get at an external variable (external to
5724 the \e{library}, not just to one of the modules within it), you must
5725 use the \I{GOT relocations}\I\c{WRT ..got}\c{..got} type to get at
5726 it. The \c{..got} type, instead of giving you the offset from the
5727 GOT base to the variable, gives you the offset from the GOT base to
5728 a GOT \e{entry} containing the address of the variable. The linker
5729 will set up this GOT entry when it builds the library, and the
5730 dynamic linker will place the correct address in it at load time. So
5731 to obtain the address of an external variable \c{extvar} in \c{EAX},
5734 \c mov eax,[ebx+extvar wrt ..got]
5736 This loads the address of \c{extvar} out of an entry in the GOT. The
5737 linker, when it builds the shared library, collects together every
5738 relocation of type \c{..got}, and builds the GOT so as to ensure it
5739 has every necessary entry present.
5741 Common variables must also be accessed in this way.
5744 \S{picglobal} Exporting Symbols to the Library User
5746 If you want to export symbols to the user of the library, you have
5747 to declare whether they are functions or data, and if they are data,
5748 you have to give the size of the data item. This is because the
5749 dynamic linker has to build \I{PLT}\i{procedure linkage table}
5750 entries for any exported functions, and also moves exported data
5751 items away from the library's data section in which they were
5754 So to export a function to users of the library, you must use
5756 \c global func:function ; declare it as a function
5762 And to export a data item such as an array, you would have to code
5764 \c global array:data array.end-array ; give the size too
5769 Be careful: If you export a variable to the library user, by
5770 declaring it as \c{GLOBAL} and supplying a size, the variable will
5771 end up living in the data section of the main program, rather than
5772 in your library's data section, where you declared it. So you will
5773 have to access your own global variable with the \c{..got} mechanism
5774 rather than \c{..gotoff}, as if it were external (which,
5775 effectively, it has become).
5777 Equally, if you need to store the address of an exported global in
5778 one of your data sections, you can't do it by means of the standard
5781 \c dataptr: dd global_data_item ; WRONG
5783 NASM will interpret this code as an ordinary relocation, in which
5784 \c{global_data_item} is merely an offset from the beginning of the
5785 \c{.data} section (or whatever); so this reference will end up
5786 pointing at your data section instead of at the exported global
5787 which resides elsewhere.
5789 Instead of the above code, then, you must write
5791 \c dataptr: dd global_data_item wrt ..sym
5793 which makes use of the special \c{WRT} type \I\c{WRT ..sym}\c{..sym}
5794 to instruct NASM to search the symbol table for a particular symbol
5795 at that address, rather than just relocating by section base.
5797 Either method will work for functions: referring to one of your
5798 functions by means of
5800 \c funcptr: dd my_function
5802 will give the user the address of the code you wrote, whereas
5804 \c funcptr: dd my_function wrt .sym
5806 will give the address of the procedure linkage table for the
5807 function, which is where the calling program will \e{believe} the
5808 function lives. Either address is a valid way to call the function.
5811 \S{picproc} Calling Procedures Outside the Library
5813 Calling procedures outside your shared library has to be done by
5814 means of a \i\e{procedure linkage table}, or \i{PLT}. The PLT is
5815 placed at a known offset from where the library is loaded, so the
5816 library code can make calls to the PLT in a position-independent
5817 way. Within the PLT there is code to jump to offsets contained in
5818 the GOT, so function calls to other shared libraries or to routines
5819 in the main program can be transparently passed off to their real
5822 To call an external routine, you must use another special PIC
5823 relocation type, \I{PLT relocations}\i\c{WRT ..plt}. This is much
5824 easier than the GOT-based ones: you simply replace calls such as
5825 \c{CALL printf} with the PLT-relative version \c{CALL printf WRT
5829 \S{link} Generating the Library File
5831 Having written some code modules and assembled them to \c{.o} files,
5832 you then generate your shared library with a command such as
5834 \c ld -shared -o library.so module1.o module2.o # for ELF
5835 \c ld -Bshareable -o library.so module1.o module2.o # for BSD
5837 For ELF, if your shared library is going to reside in system
5838 directories such as \c{/usr/lib} or \c{/lib}, it is usually worth
5839 using the \i\c{-soname} flag to the linker, to store the final
5840 library file name, with a version number, into the library:
5842 \c ld -shared -soname library.so.1 -o library.so.1.2 *.o
5844 You would then copy \c{library.so.1.2} into the library directory,
5845 and create \c{library.so.1} as a symbolic link to it.
5848 \C{mixsize} Mixing 16 and 32 Bit Code
5850 This chapter tries to cover some of the issues, largely related to
5851 unusual forms of addressing and jump instructions, encountered when
5852 writing operating system code such as protected-mode initialisation
5853 routines, which require code that operates in mixed segment sizes,
5854 such as code in a 16-bit segment trying to modify data in a 32-bit
5855 one, or jumps between different-size segments.
5858 \H{mixjump} Mixed-Size Jumps\I{jumps, mixed-size}
5860 \I{operating system, writing}\I{writing operating systems}The most
5861 common form of \i{mixed-size instruction} is the one used when
5862 writing a 32-bit OS: having done your setup in 16-bit mode, such as
5863 loading the kernel, you then have to boot it by switching into
5864 protected mode and jumping to the 32-bit kernel start address. In a
5865 fully 32-bit OS, this tends to be the \e{only} mixed-size
5866 instruction you need, since everything before it can be done in pure
5867 16-bit code, and everything after it can be pure 32-bit.
5869 This jump must specify a 48-bit far address, since the target
5870 segment is a 32-bit one. However, it must be assembled in a 16-bit
5871 segment, so just coding, for example,
5873 \c jmp 0x1234:0x56789ABC ; wrong!
5875 will not work, since the offset part of the address will be
5876 truncated to \c{0x9ABC} and the jump will be an ordinary 16-bit far
5879 The Linux kernel setup code gets round the inability of \c{as86} to
5880 generate the required instruction by coding it manually, using
5881 \c{DB} instructions. NASM can go one better than that, by actually
5882 generating the right instruction itself. Here's how to do it right:
5884 \c jmp dword 0x1234:0x56789ABC ; right
5886 \I\c{JMP DWORD}The \c{DWORD} prefix (strictly speaking, it should
5887 come \e{after} the colon, since it is declaring the \e{offset} field
5888 to be a doubleword; but NASM will accept either form, since both are
5889 unambiguous) forces the offset part to be treated as far, in the
5890 assumption that you are deliberately writing a jump from a 16-bit
5891 segment to a 32-bit one.
5893 You can do the reverse operation, jumping from a 32-bit segment to a
5894 16-bit one, by means of the \c{WORD} prefix:
5896 \c jmp word 0x8765:0x4321 ; 32 to 16 bit
5898 If the \c{WORD} prefix is specified in 16-bit mode, or the \c{DWORD}
5899 prefix in 32-bit mode, they will be ignored, since each is
5900 explicitly forcing NASM into a mode it was in anyway.
5903 \H{mixaddr} Addressing Between Different-Size Segments\I{addressing,
5904 mixed-size}\I{mixed-size addressing}
5906 If your OS is mixed 16 and 32-bit, or if you are writing a DOS
5907 extender, you are likely to have to deal with some 16-bit segments
5908 and some 32-bit ones. At some point, you will probably end up
5909 writing code in a 16-bit segment which has to access data in a
5910 32-bit segment, or vice versa.
5912 If the data you are trying to access in a 32-bit segment lies within
5913 the first 64K of the segment, you may be able to get away with using
5914 an ordinary 16-bit addressing operation for the purpose; but sooner
5915 or later, you will want to do 32-bit addressing from 16-bit mode.
5917 The easiest way to do this is to make sure you use a register for
5918 the address, since any effective address containing a 32-bit
5919 register is forced to be a 32-bit address. So you can do
5921 \c mov eax,offset_into_32_bit_segment_specified_by_fs
5922 \c mov dword [fs:eax],0x11223344
5924 This is fine, but slightly cumbersome (since it wastes an
5925 instruction and a register) if you already know the precise offset
5926 you are aiming at. The x86 architecture does allow 32-bit effective
5927 addresses to specify nothing but a 4-byte offset, so why shouldn't
5928 NASM be able to generate the best instruction for the purpose?
5930 It can. As in \k{mixjump}, you need only prefix the address with the
5931 \c{DWORD} keyword, and it will be forced to be a 32-bit address:
5933 \c mov dword [fs:dword my_offset],0x11223344
5935 Also as in \k{mixjump}, NASM is not fussy about whether the
5936 \c{DWORD} prefix comes before or after the segment override, so
5937 arguably a nicer-looking way to code the above instruction is
5939 \c mov dword [dword fs:my_offset],0x11223344
5941 Don't confuse the \c{DWORD} prefix \e{outside} the square brackets,
5942 which controls the size of the data stored at the address, with the
5943 one \c{inside} the square brackets which controls the length of the
5944 address itself. The two can quite easily be different:
5946 \c mov word [dword 0x12345678],0x9ABC
5948 This moves 16 bits of data to an address specified by a 32-bit
5951 You can also specify \c{WORD} or \c{DWORD} prefixes along with the
5952 \c{FAR} prefix to indirect far jumps or calls. For example:
5954 \c call dword far [fs:word 0x4321]
5956 This instruction contains an address specified by a 16-bit offset;
5957 it loads a 48-bit far pointer from that (16-bit segment and 32-bit
5958 offset), and calls that address.
5961 \H{mixother} Other Mixed-Size Instructions
5963 The other way you might want to access data might be using the
5964 string instructions (\c{LODSx}, \c{STOSx} and so on) or the
5965 \c{XLATB} instruction. These instructions, since they take no
5966 parameters, might seem to have no easy way to make them perform
5967 32-bit addressing when assembled in a 16-bit segment.
5969 This is the purpose of NASM's \i\c{a16} and \i\c{a32} prefixes. If
5970 you are coding \c{LODSB} in a 16-bit segment but it is supposed to
5971 be accessing a string in a 32-bit segment, you should load the
5972 desired address into \c{ESI} and then code
5976 The prefix forces the addressing size to 32 bits, meaning that
5977 \c{LODSB} loads from \c{[DS:ESI]} instead of \c{[DS:SI]}. To access
5978 a string in a 16-bit segment when coding in a 32-bit one, the
5979 corresponding \c{a16} prefix can be used.
5981 The \c{a16} and \c{a32} prefixes can be applied to any instruction
5982 in NASM's instruction table, but most of them can generate all the
5983 useful forms without them. The prefixes are necessary only for
5984 instructions with implicit addressing: \c{CMPSx} (\k{insCMPSB}),
5985 \c{SCASx} (\k{insSCASB}), \c{LODSx} (\k{insLODSB}), \c{STOSx}
5986 (\k{insSTOSB}), \c{MOVSx} (\k{insMOVSB}), \c{INSx} (\k{insINSB}),
5987 \c{OUTSx} (\k{insOUTSB}), and \c{XLATB} (\k{insXLATB}). Also, the
5988 various push and pop instructions (\c{PUSHA} and \c{POPF} as well as
5989 the more usual \c{PUSH} and \c{POP}) can accept \c{a16} or \c{a32}
5990 prefixes to force a particular one of \c{SP} or \c{ESP} to be used
5991 as a stack pointer, in case the stack segment in use is a different
5992 size from the code segment.
5994 \c{PUSH} and \c{POP}, when applied to segment registers in 32-bit
5995 mode, also have the slightly odd behaviour that they push and pop 4
5996 bytes at a time, of which the top two are ignored and the bottom two
5997 give the value of the segment register being manipulated. To force
5998 the 16-bit behaviour of segment-register push and pop instructions,
5999 you can use the operand-size prefix \i\c{o16}:
6004 This code saves a doubleword of stack space by fitting two segment
6005 registers into the space which would normally be consumed by pushing
6008 (You can also use the \i\c{o32} prefix to force the 32-bit behaviour
6009 when in 16-bit mode, but this seems less useful.)
6012 \C{trouble} Troubleshooting
6014 This chapter describes some of the common problems that users have
6015 been known to encounter with NASM, and answers them. It also gives
6016 instructions for reporting bugs in NASM if you find a difficulty
6017 that isn't listed here.
6020 \H{problems} Common Problems
6022 \S{inefficient} NASM Generates \i{Inefficient Code}
6024 I get a lot of `bug' reports about NASM generating inefficient, or
6025 even `wrong', code on instructions such as \c{ADD ESP,8}. This is a
6026 deliberate design feature, connected to predictability of output:
6027 NASM, on seeing \c{ADD ESP,8}, will generate the form of the
6028 instruction which leaves room for a 32-bit offset. You need to code
6029 \I\c{BYTE}\c{ADD ESP,BYTE 8} if you want the space-efficient
6030 form of the instruction. This isn't a bug: at worst it's a
6031 misfeature, and that's a matter of opinion only.
6034 \S{jmprange} My Jumps are Out of Range\I{out of range, jumps}
6036 Similarly, people complain that when they issue \i{conditional
6037 jumps} (which are \c{SHORT} by default) that try to jump too far,
6038 NASM reports `short jump out of range' instead of making the jumps
6041 This, again, is partly a predictability issue, but in fact has a
6042 more practical reason as well. NASM has no means of being told what
6043 type of processor the code it is generating will be run on; so it
6044 cannot decide for itself that it should generate \i\c{Jcc NEAR} type
6045 instructions, because it doesn't know that it's working for a 386 or
6046 above. Alternatively, it could replace the out-of-range short
6047 \c{JNE} instruction with a very short \c{JE} instruction that jumps
6048 over a \c{JMP NEAR}; this is a sensible solution for processors
6049 below a 386, but hardly efficient on processors which have good
6050 branch prediction \e{and} could have used \c{JNE NEAR} instead. So,
6051 once again, it's up to the user, not the assembler, to decide what
6052 instructions should be generated.
6055 \S{proborg} \i\c{ORG} Doesn't Work
6057 People writing \i{boot sector} programs in the \c{bin} format often
6058 complain that \c{ORG} doesn't work the way they'd like: in order to
6059 place the \c{0xAA55} signature word at the end of a 512-byte boot
6060 sector, people who are used to MASM tend to code
6064 \c ; some boot sector code
6069 This is not the intended use of the \c{ORG} directive in NASM, and
6070 will not work. The correct way to solve this problem in NASM is to
6071 use the \i\c{TIMES} directive, like this:
6075 \c ; some boot sector code
6077 \c TIMES 510-($-$$) DB 0
6080 The \c{TIMES} directive will insert exactly enough zero bytes into
6081 the output to move the assembly point up to 510. This method also
6082 has the advantage that if you accidentally fill your boot sector too
6083 full, NASM will catch the problem at assembly time and report it, so
6084 you won't end up with a boot sector that you have to disassemble to
6085 find out what's wrong with it.
6088 \S{probtimes} \i\c{TIMES} Doesn't Work
6090 The other common problem with the above code is people who write the
6095 by reasoning that \c{$} should be a pure number, just like 510, so
6096 the difference between them is also a pure number and can happily be
6099 NASM is a \e{modular} assembler: the various component parts are
6100 designed to be easily separable for re-use, so they don't exchange
6101 information unnecessarily. In consequence, the \c{bin} output
6102 format, even though it has been told by the \c{ORG} directive that
6103 the \c{.text} section should start at 0, does not pass that
6104 information back to the expression evaluator. So from the
6105 evaluator's point of view, \c{$} isn't a pure number: it's an offset
6106 from a section base. Therefore the difference between \c{$} and 510
6107 is also not a pure number, but involves a section base. Values
6108 involving section bases cannot be passed as arguments to \c{TIMES}.
6110 The solution, as in the previous section, is to code the \c{TIMES}
6113 \c TIMES 510-($-$$) DB 0
6115 in which \c{$} and \c{$$} are offsets from the same section base,
6116 and so their difference is a pure number. This will solve the
6117 problem and generate sensible code.
6120 \H{bugs} \i{Bugs}\I{reporting bugs}
6122 We have never yet released a version of NASM with any \e{known}
6123 bugs. That doesn't usually stop there being plenty we didn't know
6124 about, though. Any that you find should be reported firstly via the
6126 \W{https://sourceforge.net/projects/nasm/}\c{https://sourceforge.net/projects/nasm/}
6127 (click on "Bugs"), or if that fails then through one of the
6128 contacts in \k{contact}.
6130 Please read \k{qstart} first, and don't report the bug if it's
6131 listed in there as a deliberate feature. (If you think the feature
6132 is badly thought out, feel free to send us reasons why you think it
6133 should be changed, but don't just send us mail saying `This is a
6134 bug' if the documentation says we did it on purpose.) Then read
6135 \k{problems}, and don't bother reporting the bug if it's listed
6138 If you do report a bug, \e{please} give us all of the following
6141 \b What operating system you're running NASM under. DOS, Linux,
6142 NetBSD, Win16, Win32, VMS (I'd be impressed), whatever.
6144 \b If you're running NASM under DOS or Win32, tell us whether you've
6145 compiled your own executable from the DOS source archive, or whether
6146 you were using the standard distribution binaries out of the
6147 archive. If you were using a locally built executable, try to
6148 reproduce the problem using one of the standard binaries, as this
6149 will make it easier for us to reproduce your problem prior to fixing
6152 \b Which version of NASM you're using, and exactly how you invoked
6153 it. Give us the precise command line, and the contents of the
6154 \c{NASMENV} environment variable if any.
6156 \b Which versions of any supplementary programs you're using, and
6157 how you invoked them. If the problem only becomes visible at link
6158 time, tell us what linker you're using, what version of it you've
6159 got, and the exact linker command line. If the problem involves
6160 linking against object files generated by a compiler, tell us what
6161 compiler, what version, and what command line or options you used.
6162 (If you're compiling in an IDE, please try to reproduce the problem
6163 with the command-line version of the compiler.)
6165 \b If at all possible, send us a NASM source file which exhibits the
6166 problem. If this causes copyright problems (e.g. you can only
6167 reproduce the bug in restricted-distribution code) then bear in mind
6168 the following two points: firstly, we guarantee that any source code
6169 sent to us for the purposes of debugging NASM will be used \e{only}
6170 for the purposes of debugging NASM, and that we will delete all our
6171 copies of it as soon as we have found and fixed the bug or bugs in
6172 question; and secondly, we would prefer \e{not} to be mailed large
6173 chunks of code anyway. The smaller the file, the better. A
6174 three-line sample file that does nothing useful \e{except}
6175 demonstrate the problem is much easier to work with than a
6176 fully fledged ten-thousand-line program. (Of course, some errors
6177 \e{do} only crop up in large files, so this may not be possible.)
6179 \b A description of what the problem actually \e{is}. `It doesn't
6180 work' is \e{not} a helpful description! Please describe exactly what
6181 is happening that shouldn't be, or what isn't happening that should.
6182 Examples might be: `NASM generates an error message saying Line 3
6183 for an error that's actually on Line 5'; `NASM generates an error
6184 message that I believe it shouldn't be generating at all'; `NASM
6185 fails to generate an error message that I believe it \e{should} be
6186 generating'; `the object file produced from this source code crashes
6187 my linker'; `the ninth byte of the output file is 66 and I think it
6188 should be 77 instead'.
6190 \b If you believe the output file from NASM to be faulty, send it to
6191 us. That allows us to determine whether our own copy of NASM
6192 generates the same file, or whether the problem is related to
6193 portability issues between our development platforms and yours. We
6194 can handle binary files mailed to us as MIME attachments, uuencoded,
6195 and even BinHex. Alternatively, we may be able to provide an FTP
6196 site you can upload the suspect files to; but mailing them is easier
6199 \b Any other information or data files that might be helpful. If,
6200 for example, the problem involves NASM failing to generate an object
6201 file while TASM can generate an equivalent file without trouble,
6202 then send us \e{both} object files, so we can see what TASM is doing
6203 differently from us.
6206 \A{ndisasm} \i{Ndisasm}
6208 The Netwide Disassembler, NDISASM
6210 \H{ndisintro} Introduction
6213 The Netwide Disassembler is a small companion program to the Netwide
6214 Assembler, NASM. It seemed a shame to have an x86 assembler,
6215 complete with a full instruction table, and not make as much use of
6216 it as possible, so here's a disassembler which shares the
6217 instruction table (and some other bits of code) with NASM.
6219 The Netwide Disassembler does nothing except to produce
6220 disassemblies of \e{binary} source files. NDISASM does not have any
6221 understanding of object file formats, like \c{objdump}, and it will
6222 not understand \c{DOS .EXE} files like \c{debug} will. It just
6226 \H{ndisstart} Getting Started: Installation
6228 See \k{install} for installation instructions. NDISASM, like NASM,
6229 has a \c{man page} which you may want to put somewhere useful, if you
6230 are on a Unix system.
6233 \H{ndisrun} Running NDISASM
6235 To disassemble a file, you will typically use a command of the form
6237 \c ndisasm [-b16 | -b32] filename
6239 NDISASM can disassemble 16-bit code or 32-bit code equally easily,
6240 provided of course that you remember to specify which it is to work
6241 with. If no \i\c{-b} switch is present, NDISASM works in 16-bit mode by
6242 default. The \i\c{-u} switch (for USE32) also invokes 32-bit mode.
6244 Two more command line options are \i\c{-r} which reports the version
6245 number of NDISASM you are running, and \i\c{-h} which gives a short
6246 summary of command line options.
6249 \S{ndiscom} COM Files: Specifying an Origin
6251 To disassemble a \c{DOS .COM} file correctly, a disassembler must assume
6252 that the first instruction in the file is loaded at address \c{0x100},
6253 rather than at zero. NDISASM, which assumes by default that any file
6254 you give it is loaded at zero, will therefore need to be informed of
6257 The \i\c{-o} option allows you to declare a different origin for the
6258 file you are disassembling. Its argument may be expressed in any of
6259 the NASM numeric formats: decimal by default, if it begins with `\c{$}'
6260 or `\c{0x}' or ends in `\c{H}' it's \c{hex}, if it ends in `\c{Q}' it's
6261 \c{octal}, and if it ends in `\c{B}' it's \c{binary}.
6263 Hence, to disassemble a \c{.COM} file:
6265 \c ndisasm -o100h filename.com
6270 \S{ndissync} Code Following Data: Synchronisation
6272 Suppose you are disassembling a file which contains some data which
6273 isn't machine code, and \e{then} contains some machine code. NDISASM
6274 will faithfully plough through the data section, producing machine
6275 instructions wherever it can (although most of them will look
6276 bizarre, and some may have unusual prefixes, e.g. `\c{FS OR AX,0x240A}'),
6277 and generating `DB' instructions ever so often if it's totally stumped.
6278 Then it will reach the code section.
6280 Supposing NDISASM has just finished generating a strange machine
6281 instruction from part of the data section, and its file position is
6282 now one byte \e{before} the beginning of the code section. It's
6283 entirely possible that another spurious instruction will get
6284 generated, starting with the final byte of the data section, and
6285 then the correct first instruction in the code section will not be
6286 seen because the starting point skipped over it. This isn't really
6289 To avoid this, you can specify a `\i\c{synchronisation}' point, or indeed
6290 as many synchronisation points as you like (although NDISASM can
6291 only handle 8192 sync points internally). The definition of a sync
6292 point is this: NDISASM guarantees to hit sync points exactly during
6293 disassembly. If it is thinking about generating an instruction which
6294 would cause it to jump over a sync point, it will discard that
6295 instruction and output a `\c{db}' instead. So it \e{will} start
6296 disassembly exactly from the sync point, and so you \e{will} see all
6297 the instructions in your code section.
6299 Sync points are specified using the \i\c{-s} option: they are measured
6300 in terms of the program origin, not the file position. So if you
6301 want to synchronise after 32 bytes of a \c{.COM} file, you would have to
6304 \c ndisasm -o100h -s120h file.com
6308 \c ndisasm -o100h -s20h file.com
6310 As stated above, you can specify multiple sync markers if you need
6311 to, just by repeating the \c{-s} option.
6314 \S{ndisisync} Mixed Code and Data: Automatic (Intelligent) Synchronisation
6317 Suppose you are disassembling the boot sector of a \c{DOS} floppy (maybe
6318 it has a virus, and you need to understand the virus so that you
6319 know what kinds of damage it might have done you). Typically, this
6320 will contain a \c{JMP} instruction, then some data, then the rest of the
6321 code. So there is a very good chance of NDISASM being \e{misaligned}
6322 when the data ends and the code begins. Hence a sync point is
6325 On the other hand, why should you have to specify the sync point
6326 manually? What you'd do in order to find where the sync point would
6327 be, surely, would be to read the \c{JMP} instruction, and then to use
6328 its target address as a sync point. So can NDISASM do that for you?
6330 The answer, of course, is yes: using either of the synonymous
6331 switches \i\c{-a} (for automatic sync) or \i\c{-i} (for intelligent
6332 sync) will enable \c{auto-sync} mode. Auto-sync mode automatically
6333 generates a sync point for any forward-referring PC-relative jump or
6334 call instruction that NDISASM encounters. (Since NDISASM is one-pass,
6335 if it encounters a PC-relative jump whose target has already been
6336 processed, there isn't much it can do about it...)
6338 Only PC-relative jumps are processed, since an absolute jump is
6339 either through a register (in which case NDISASM doesn't know what
6340 the register contains) or involves a segment address (in which case
6341 the target code isn't in the same segment that NDISASM is working
6342 in, and so the sync point can't be placed anywhere useful).
6344 For some kinds of file, this mechanism will automatically put sync
6345 points in all the right places, and save you from having to place
6346 any sync points manually. However, it should be stressed that
6347 auto-sync mode is \e{not} guaranteed to catch all the sync points, and
6348 you may still have to place some manually.
6350 Auto-sync mode doesn't prevent you from declaring manual sync
6351 points: it just adds automatically generated ones to the ones you
6352 provide. It's perfectly feasible to specify \c{-i} \e{and} some \c{-s}
6355 Another caveat with auto-sync mode is that if, by some unpleasant
6356 fluke, something in your data section should disassemble to a
6357 PC-relative call or jump instruction, NDISASM may obediently place a
6358 sync point in a totally random place, for example in the middle of
6359 one of the instructions in your code section. So you may end up with
6360 a wrong disassembly even if you use auto-sync. Again, there isn't
6361 much I can do about this. If you have problems, you'll have to use
6362 manual sync points, or use the \c{-k} option (documented below) to
6363 suppress disassembly of the data area.
6366 \S{ndisother} Other Options
6368 The \i\c{-e} option skips a header on the file, by ignoring the first N
6369 bytes. This means that the header is \e{not} counted towards the
6370 disassembly offset: if you give \c{-e10 -o10}, disassembly will start
6371 at byte 10 in the file, and this will be given offset 10, not 20.
6373 The \i\c{-k} option is provided with two comma-separated numeric
6374 arguments, the first of which is an assembly offset and the second
6375 is a number of bytes to skip. This \e{will} count the skipped bytes
6376 towards the assembly offset: its use is to suppress disassembly of a
6377 data section which wouldn't contain anything you wanted to see
6381 \H{ndisbugs} Bugs and Improvements
6383 There are no known bugs. However, any you find, with patches if
6384 possible, should be sent to \W{mailto:jules@dsf.org.uk}\c{jules@dsf.org.uk}
6385 or \W{mailto:anakin@pobox.com}\c{anakin@pobox.com}, or to the
6387 \W{https://sourceforge.net/projects/nasm/}\c{https://sourceforge.net/projects/nasm/}
6388 and we'll try to fix them. Feel free to send contributions and
6389 new features as well.
6391 Future plans include awareness of which processors certain
6392 instructions will run on, and marking of instructions that are too
6393 advanced for some processor (or are \c{FPU} instructions, or are
6394 undocumented opcodes, or are privileged protected-mode instructions,
6399 I hope NDISASM is of some use to somebody. Including me. :-)
6401 I don't recommend taking NDISASM apart to see how an efficient
6402 disassembler works, because as far as I know, it isn't an efficient
6403 one anyway. You have been warned.
6406 \A{iref} x86 Instruction Reference
6408 This appendix provides a complete list of the machine instructions
6409 which NASM will assemble, and a short description of the function of
6412 It is not intended to be exhaustive documentation on the fine
6413 details of the instructions' function, such as which exceptions they
6414 can trigger: for such documentation, you should go to Intel's Web
6415 site, \W{http://developer.intel.com/design/Pentium4/manuals/}\c{http://developer.intel.com/design/Pentium4/manuals/}.
6417 Instead, this appendix is intended primarily to provide
6418 documentation on the way the instructions may be used within NASM.
6419 For example, looking up \c{LOOP} will tell you that NASM allows
6420 \c{CX} or \c{ECX} to be specified as an optional second argument to
6421 the \c{LOOP} instruction, to enforce which of the two possible
6422 counter registers should be used if the default is not the one
6425 The instructions are not quite listed in alphabetical order, since
6426 groups of instructions with similar functions are lumped together in
6427 the same entry. Most of them don't move very far from their
6428 alphabetic position because of this.
6431 \H{iref-opr} Key to Operand Specifications
6433 The instruction descriptions in this appendix specify their operands
6434 using the following notation:
6436 \b Registers: \c{reg8} denotes an 8-bit \i{general purpose
6437 register}, \c{reg16} denotes a 16-bit general purpose register, and
6438 \c{reg32} a 32-bit one. \c{fpureg} denotes one of the eight FPU
6439 stack registers, \c{mmxreg} denotes one of the eight 64-bit MMX
6440 registers, and \c{segreg} denotes a segment register. In addition,
6441 some registers (such as \c{AL}, \c{DX} or
6442 \c{ECX}) may be specified explicitly.
6444 \b Immediate operands: \c{imm} denotes a generic \i{immediate operand}.
6445 \c{imm8}, \c{imm16} and \c{imm32} are used when the operand is
6446 intended to be a specific size. For some of these instructions, NASM
6447 needs an explicit specifier: for example, \c{ADD ESP,16} could be
6448 interpreted as either \c{ADD r/m32,imm32} or \c{ADD r/m32,imm8}.
6449 NASM chooses the former by default, and so you must specify \c{ADD
6450 ESP,BYTE 16} for the latter.
6452 \b Memory references: \c{mem} denotes a generic \i{memory reference};
6453 \c{mem8}, \c{mem16}, \c{mem32}, \c{mem64} and \c{mem80} are used
6454 when the operand needs to be a specific size. Again, a specifier is
6455 needed in some cases: \c{DEC [address]} is ambiguous and will be
6456 rejected by NASM. You must specify \c{DEC BYTE [address]}, \c{DEC
6457 WORD [address]} or \c{DEC DWORD [address]} instead.
6459 \b \i{Restricted memory references}: one form of the \c{MOV}
6460 instruction allows a memory address to be specified \e{without}
6461 allowing the normal range of register combinations and effective
6462 address processing. This is denoted by \c{memoffs8}, \c{memoffs16}
6465 \b Register or memory choices: many instructions can accept either a
6466 register \e{or} a memory reference as an operand. \c{r/m8} is a
6467 shorthand for \c{reg8/mem8}; similarly \c{r/m16} and \c{r/m32}.
6468 \c{r/m64} is MMX-related, and is a shorthand for \c{mmxreg/mem64}.
6471 \H{iref-opc} Key to Opcode Descriptions
6473 This appendix also provides the opcodes which NASM will generate for
6474 each form of each instruction. The opcodes are listed in the
6477 \b A hex number, such as \c{3F}, indicates a fixed byte containing
6480 \b A hex number followed by \c{+r}, such as \c{C8+r}, indicates that
6481 one of the operands to the instruction is a register, and the
6482 `register value' of that register should be added to the hex number
6483 to produce the generated byte. For example, EDX has register value
6484 2, so the code \c{C8+r}, when the register operand is EDX, generates
6485 the hex byte \c{CA}. Register values for specific registers are
6486 given in \k{iref-rv}.
6488 \b A hex number followed by \c{+cc}, such as \c{40+cc}, indicates
6489 that the instruction name has a condition code suffix, and the
6490 numeric representation of the condition code should be added to the
6491 hex number to produce the generated byte. For example, the code
6492 \c{40+cc}, when the instruction contains the \c{NE} condition,
6493 generates the hex byte \c{45}. Condition codes and their numeric
6494 representations are given in \k{iref-cc}.
6496 \b A slash followed by a digit, such as \c{/2}, indicates that one
6497 of the operands to the instruction is a memory address or register
6498 (denoted \c{mem} or \c{r/m}, with an optional size). This is to be
6499 encoded as an effective address, with a \i{ModR/M byte}, an optional
6500 \i{SIB byte}, and an optional displacement, and the spare (register)
6501 field of the ModR/M byte should be the digit given (which will be
6502 from 0 to 7, so it fits in three bits). The encoding of effective
6503 addresses is given in \k{iref-ea}.
6505 \b The code \c{/r} combines the above two: it indicates that one of
6506 the operands is a memory address or \c{r/m}, and another is a
6507 register, and that an effective address should be generated with the
6508 spare (register) field in the ModR/M byte being equal to the
6509 `register value' of the register operand. The encoding of effective
6510 addresses is given in \k{iref-ea}; register values are given in
6513 \b The codes \c{ib}, \c{iw} and \c{id} indicate that one of the
6514 operands to the instruction is an immediate value, and that this is
6515 to be encoded as a byte, little-endian word or little-endian
6516 doubleword respectively.
6518 \b The codes \c{rb}, \c{rw} and \c{rd} indicate that one of the
6519 operands to the instruction is an immediate value, and that the
6520 \e{difference} between this value and the address of the end of the
6521 instruction is to be encoded as a byte, word or doubleword
6522 respectively. Where the form \c{rw/rd} appears, it indicates that
6523 either \c{rw} or \c{rd} should be used according to whether assembly
6524 is being performed in \c{BITS 16} or \c{BITS 32} state respectively.
6526 \b The codes \c{ow} and \c{od} indicate that one of the operands to
6527 the instruction is a reference to the contents of a memory address
6528 specified as an immediate value: this encoding is used in some forms
6529 of the \c{MOV} instruction in place of the standard
6530 effective-address mechanism. The displacement is encoded as a word
6531 or doubleword. Again, \c{ow/od} denotes that \c{ow} or \c{od} should
6532 be chosen according to the \c{BITS} setting.
6534 \b The codes \c{o16} and \c{o32} indicate that the given form of the
6535 instruction should be assembled with operand size 16 or 32 bits. In
6536 other words, \c{o16} indicates a \c{66} prefix in \c{BITS 32} state,
6537 but generates no code in \c{BITS 16} state; and \c{o32} indicates a
6538 \c{66} prefix in \c{BITS 16} state but generates nothing in \c{BITS
6541 \b The codes \c{a16} and \c{a32}, similarly to \c{o16} and \c{o32},
6542 indicate the address size of the given form of the instruction.
6543 Where this does not match the \c{BITS} setting, a \c{67} prefix is
6547 \S{iref-rv} Register Values
6549 Where an instruction requires a register value, it is already
6550 implicit in the encoding of the rest of the instruction what type of
6551 register is intended: an 8-bit general-purpose register, a segment
6552 register, a debug register, an MMX register, or whatever. Therefore
6553 there is no problem with registers of different types sharing an
6556 The encodings for the various classes of register are:
6558 \b 8-bit general registers: \c{AL} is 0, \c{CL} is 1, \c{DL} is 2,
6559 \c{BL} is 3, \c{AH} is 4, \c{CH} is 5, \c{DH} is 6, and \c{BH} is
6562 \b 16-bit general registers: \c{AX} is 0, \c{CX} is 1, \c{DX} is 2,
6563 \c{BX} is 3, \c{SP} is 4, \c{BP} is 5, \c{SI} is 6, and \c{DI} is 7.
6565 \b 32-bit general registers: \c{EAX} is 0, \c{ECX} is 1, \c{EDX} is
6566 2, \c{EBX} is 3, \c{ESP} is 4, \c{EBP} is 5, \c{ESI} is 6, and
6569 \b \i{Segment registers}: \c{ES} is 0, \c{CS} is 1, \c{SS} is 2, \c{DS}
6570 is 3, \c{FS} is 4, and \c{GS} is 5.
6572 \b \I{floating-point, registers}Floating-point registers: \c{ST0}
6573 is 0, \c{ST1} is 1, \c{ST2} is 2, \c{ST3} is 3, \c{ST4} is 4,
6574 \c{ST5} is 5, \c{ST6} is 6, and \c{ST7} is 7.
6576 \b 64-bit \i{MMX registers}: \c{MM0} is 0, \c{MM1} is 1, \c{MM2} is 2,
6577 \c{MM3} is 3, \c{MM4} is 4, \c{MM5} is 5, \c{MM6} is 6, and \c{MM7}
6580 \b \i{Control registers}: \c{CR0} is 0, \c{CR2} is 2, \c{CR3} is 3,
6583 \b \i{Debug registers}: \c{DR0} is 0, \c{DR1} is 1, \c{DR2} is 2,
6584 \c{DR3} is 3, \c{DR6} is 6, and \c{DR7} is 7.
6586 \b \i{Test registers}: \c{TR3} is 3, \c{TR4} is 4, \c{TR5} is 5,
6587 \c{TR6} is 6, and \c{TR7} is 7.
6589 (Note that wherever a register name contains a number, that number
6590 is also the register value for that register.)
6593 \S{iref-cc} \i{Condition Codes}
6595 The available condition codes are given here, along with their
6596 numeric representations as part of opcodes. Many of these condition
6597 codes have synonyms, so several will be listed at a time.
6599 In the following descriptions, the word `either', when applied to two
6600 possible trigger conditions, is used to mean `either or both'. If
6601 `either but not both' is meant, the phrase `exactly one of' is used.
6603 \b \c{O} is 0 (trigger if the overflow flag is set); \c{NO} is 1.
6605 \b \c{B}, \c{C} and \c{NAE} are 2 (trigger if the carry flag is
6606 set); \c{AE}, \c{NB} and \c{NC} are 3.
6608 \b \c{E} and \c{Z} are 4 (trigger if the zero flag is set); \c{NE}
6611 \b \c{BE} and \c{NA} are 6 (trigger if either of the carry or zero
6612 flags is set); \c{A} and \c{NBE} are 7.
6614 \b \c{S} is 8 (trigger if the sign flag is set); \c{NS} is 9.
6616 \b \c{P} and \c{PE} are 10 (trigger if the parity flag is set);
6617 \c{NP} and \c{PO} are 11.
6619 \b \c{L} and \c{NGE} are 12 (trigger if exactly one of the sign and
6620 overflow flags is set); \c{GE} and \c{NL} are 13.
6622 \b \c{LE} and \c{NG} are 14 (trigger if either the zero flag is set,
6623 or exactly one of the sign and overflow flags is set); \c{G} and
6626 Note that in all cases, the sense of a condition code may be
6627 reversed by changing the low bit of the numeric representation.
6629 For details of when an instruction sets each of the status flags,
6630 see the individual instruction, plus the Status Flags reference
6634 \S{iref-SSE-cc} \i{SSE Condition Predicates}
6636 The condition predicates for SSE comparison instructions are the
6637 codes used as part of the opcode, to determine what form of
6638 comparison is being carried out. In each case, the imm8 value is
6639 the final byte of the opcode encoding, and the predicate is the
6640 code used as part of the mnemonic for the instruction (equivalent
6641 to the "cc" in an integer instruction that used a condition code).
6642 The instructions that use this will give details of what the various
6643 mnemonics are, this table is used to help you work out details of what
6646 \c Predi- imm8 Description Relation where: Emula- Result QNaN
6647 \c cate Encod- A Is 1st Operand tion if NaN Signal
6648 \c ing B Is 2nd Operand Operand Invalid
6650 \c EQ 000B equal A = B False No
6652 \c LT 001B less-than A < B False Yes
6654 \c LE 010B less-than- A <= B False Yes
6657 \c --- ---- greater A > B Swap False Yes
6661 \c --- ---- greater- A >= B Swap False Yes
6662 \c than-or-equal Operands,
6665 \c UNORD 011B unordered A, B = Unordered True No
6667 \c NEQ 100B not-equal A != B True No
6669 \c NLT 101B not-less- NOT(A < B) True Yes
6672 \c NLE 110B not-less- NOT(A <= B) True Yes
6676 \c --- ---- not-greater NOT(A > B) Swap True Yes
6680 \c --- ---- not-greater NOT(A >= B) Swap True Yes
6684 \c ORD 111B ordered A , B = Ordered False No
6686 The unordered relationship is true when at least one of the two
6687 values being compared is a NaN or in an unsupported format.
6689 Note that the comparisons which are listed as not having a predicate
6690 or encoding can only be achieved through software emulation, as
6691 described in the "emulation" column. Note in particular that an
6692 instruction such as \c{greater-than} is not the same as \c{NLE}, as,
6693 unlike with the \c{CMP} instruction, it has to take into account the
6694 possibility of one operand containing a NaN or an unsupported numeric
6698 \S{iref-Flags} \i{Status Flags}
6700 The status flags provide some information about the result of the
6701 arithmetic instructions. This information can be used by conditional
6702 instructions (such a \c{Jcc} and \c{CMOVcc}) as well as by some of
6703 the other instructions (such as \c{ADC} and \c{INTO}).
6705 There are 6 status flags:
6709 Set if an arithmetic operation generates a
6710 carry or a borrow out of the most-significant bit of the result;
6711 cleared otherwise. This flag indicates an overflow condition for
6712 unsigned-integer arithmetic. It is also used in multiple-precision
6715 \c PF - Parity flag.
6717 Set if the least-significant byte of the result contains an even
6718 number of 1 bits; cleared otherwise.
6720 \c AF - Adjust flag.
6722 Set if an arithmetic operation generates a carry or a borrow
6723 out of bit 3 of the result; cleared otherwise. This flag is used
6724 in binary-coded decimal (BCD) arithmetic.
6728 Set if the result is zero; cleared otherwise.
6732 Set equal to the most-significant bit of the result, which is the
6733 sign bit of a signed integer. (0 indicates a positive value and 1
6734 indicates a negative value.)
6736 \c OF - Overflow flag.
6738 Set if the integer result is too large a positive number or too
6739 small a negative number (excluding the sign-bit) to fit in the
6740 destination operand; cleared otherwise. This flag indicates an
6741 overflow condition for signed-integer (two's complement) arithmetic.
6744 \S{iref-ea} Effective Address Encoding: \i{ModR/M} and \i{SIB}
6746 An \i{effective address} is encoded in up to three parts: a ModR/M
6747 byte, an optional SIB byte, and an optional byte, word or doubleword
6750 The ModR/M byte consists of three fields: the \c{mod} field, ranging
6751 from 0 to 3, in the upper two bits of the byte, the \c{r/m} field,
6752 ranging from 0 to 7, in the lower three bits, and the spare
6753 (register) field in the middle (bit 3 to bit 5). The spare field is
6754 not relevant to the effective address being encoded, and either
6755 contains an extension to the instruction opcode or the register
6756 value of another operand.
6758 The ModR/M system can be used to encode a direct register reference
6759 rather than a memory access. This is always done by setting the
6760 \c{mod} field to 3 and the \c{r/m} field to the register value of
6761 the register in question (it must be a general-purpose register, and
6762 the size of the register must already be implicit in the encoding of
6763 the rest of the instruction). In this case, the SIB byte and
6764 displacement field are both absent.
6766 In 16-bit addressing mode (either \c{BITS 16} with no \c{67} prefix,
6767 or \c{BITS 32} with a \c{67} prefix), the SIB byte is never used.
6768 The general rules for \c{mod} and \c{r/m} (there is an exception,
6771 \b The \c{mod} field gives the length of the displacement field: 0
6772 means no displacement, 1 means one byte, and 2 means two bytes.
6774 \b The \c{r/m} field encodes the combination of registers to be
6775 added to the displacement to give the accessed address: 0 means
6776 \c{BX+SI}, 1 means \c{BX+DI}, 2 means \c{BP+SI}, 3 means \c{BP+DI},
6777 4 means \c{SI} only, 5 means \c{DI} only, 6 means \c{BP} only, and 7
6780 However, there is a special case:
6782 \b If \c{mod} is 0 and \c{r/m} is 6, the effective address encoded
6783 is not \c{[BP]} as the above rules would suggest, but instead
6784 \c{[disp16]}: the displacement field is present and is two bytes
6785 long, and no registers are added to the displacement.
6787 Therefore the effective address \c{[BP]} cannot be encoded as
6788 efficiently as \c{[BX]}; so if you code \c{[BP]} in a program, NASM
6789 adds a notional 8-bit zero displacement, and sets \c{mod} to 1,
6790 \c{r/m} to 6, and the one-byte displacement field to 0.
6792 In 32-bit addressing mode (either \c{BITS 16} with a \c{67} prefix,
6793 or \c{BITS 32} with no \c{67} prefix) the general rules (again,
6794 there are exceptions) for \c{mod} and \c{r/m} are:
6796 \b The \c{mod} field gives the length of the displacement field: 0
6797 means no displacement, 1 means one byte, and 2 means four bytes.
6799 \b If only one register is to be added to the displacement, and it
6800 is not \c{ESP}, the \c{r/m} field gives its register value, and the
6801 SIB byte is absent. If the \c{r/m} field is 4 (which would encode
6802 \c{ESP}), the SIB byte is present and gives the combination and
6803 scaling of registers to be added to the displacement.
6805 If the SIB byte is present, it describes the combination of
6806 registers (an optional base register, and an optional index register
6807 scaled by multiplication by 1, 2, 4 or 8) to be added to the
6808 displacement. The SIB byte is divided into the \c{scale} field, in
6809 the top two bits, the \c{index} field in the next three, and the
6810 \c{base} field in the bottom three. The general rules are:
6812 \b The \c{base} field encodes the register value of the base
6815 \b The \c{index} field encodes the register value of the index
6816 register, unless it is 4, in which case no index register is used
6817 (so \c{ESP} cannot be used as an index register).
6819 \b The \c{scale} field encodes the multiplier by which the index
6820 register is scaled before adding it to the base and displacement: 0
6821 encodes a multiplier of 1, 1 encodes 2, 2 encodes 4 and 3 encodes 8.
6823 The exceptions to the 32-bit encoding rules are:
6825 \b If \c{mod} is 0 and \c{r/m} is 5, the effective address encoded
6826 is not \c{[EBP]} as the above rules would suggest, but instead
6827 \c{[disp32]}: the displacement field is present and is four bytes
6828 long, and no registers are added to the displacement.
6830 \b If \c{mod} is 0, \c{r/m} is 4 (meaning the SIB byte is present)
6831 and \c{base} is 4, the effective address encoded is not
6832 \c{[EBP+index]} as the above rules would suggest, but instead
6833 \c{[disp32+index]}: the displacement field is present and is four
6834 bytes long, and there is no base register (but the index register is
6835 still processed in the normal way).
6838 \H{iref-flg} Key to Instruction Flags
6840 Given along with each instruction in this appendix is a set of
6841 flags, denoting the type of the instruction. The types are as follows:
6843 \b \c{8086}, \c{186}, \c{286}, \c{386}, \c{486}, \c{PENT} and \c{P6}
6844 denote the lowest processor type that supports the instruction. Most
6845 instructions run on all processors above the given type; those that
6846 do not are documented. The Pentium II contains no additional
6847 instructions beyond the P6 (Pentium Pro); from the point of view of
6848 its instruction set, it can be thought of as a P6 with MMX
6851 \b \c{3DNOW} indicates that the instruction is a 3DNow! one, and will
6852 run on the AMD K6-2 and later processors. ATHLON extensions to the
6853 3DNow! instruction set are documented as such.
6855 \b \c{CYRIX} indicates that the instruction is specific to Cyrix
6856 processors, for example the extra MMX instructions in the Cyrix
6857 extended MMX instruction set.
6859 \b \c{FPU} indicates that the instruction is a floating-point one,
6860 and will only run on machines with a coprocessor (automatically
6861 including 486DX, Pentium and above).
6863 \b \c{KATMAI} indicates that the instruction was introduced as part
6864 of the Katmai New Instruction set. These instructions are available
6865 on the Pentium III and later processors. Those which are not
6866 specifically SSE instructions are also available on the AMD Athlon.
6868 \b \c{MMX} indicates that the instruction is an MMX one, and will
6869 run on MMX-capable Pentium processors and the Pentium II.
6871 \b \c{PRIV} indicates that the instruction is a protected-mode
6872 management instruction. Many of these may only be used in protected
6873 mode, or only at privilege level zero.
6875 \b \c{SSE} and \c{SSE2} indicate that the instruction is a Streaming
6876 SIMD Extension instruction. These instructions operate on multiple
6877 values in a single operation. SSE was introduced with the Pentium III
6878 and SSE2 was introduced with the Pentium 4.
6880 \b \c{UNDOC} indicates that the instruction is an undocumented one,
6881 and not part of the official Intel Architecture; it may or may not
6882 be supported on any given machine.
6884 \b \c{WILLAMETTE} indicates that the instruction was introduced as
6885 part of the new instruction set in the Pentium 4 and Intel Xeon
6886 processors. These instructions are also known as SSE2 instructions.
6889 \H{iref-inst} x86 Instruction Set
6892 \S{insAAA} \i\c{AAA}, \i\c{AAS}, \i\c{AAM}, \i\c{AAD}: ASCII
6899 \c AAD ; D5 0A [8086]
6900 \c AAD imm ; D5 ib [8086]
6902 \c AAM ; D4 0A [8086]
6903 \c AAM imm ; D4 ib [8086]
6905 These instructions are used in conjunction with the add, subtract,
6906 multiply and divide instructions to perform binary-coded decimal
6907 arithmetic in \e{unpacked} (one BCD digit per byte - easy to
6908 translate to and from \c{ASCII}, hence the instruction names) form.
6909 There are also packed BCD instructions \c{DAA} and \c{DAS}: see
6912 \b \c{AAA} (ASCII Adjust After Addition) should be used after a
6913 one-byte \c{ADD} instruction whose destination was the \c{AL}
6914 register: by means of examining the value in the low nibble of
6915 \c{AL} and also the auxiliary carry flag \c{AF}, it determines
6916 whether the addition has overflowed, and adjusts it (and sets
6917 the carry flag) if so. You can add long BCD strings together
6918 by doing \c{ADD}/\c{AAA} on the low digits, then doing
6919 \c{ADC}/\c{AAA} on each subsequent digit.
6921 \b \c{AAS} (ASCII Adjust AL After Subtraction) works similarly to
6922 \c{AAA}, but is for use after \c{SUB} instructions rather than
6925 \b \c{AAM} (ASCII Adjust AX After Multiply) is for use after you
6926 have multiplied two decimal digits together and left the result
6927 in \c{AL}: it divides \c{AL} by ten and stores the quotient in
6928 \c{AH}, leaving the remainder in \c{AL}. The divisor 10 can be
6929 changed by specifying an operand to the instruction: a particularly
6930 handy use of this is \c{AAM 16}, causing the two nibbles in \c{AL}
6931 to be separated into \c{AH} and \c{AL}.
6933 \b \c{AAD} (ASCII Adjust AX Before Division) performs the inverse
6934 operation to \c{AAM}: it multiplies \c{AH} by ten, adds it to
6935 \c{AL}, and sets \c{AH} to zero. Again, the multiplier 10 can
6939 \S{insADC} \i\c{ADC}: Add with Carry
6941 \c ADC r/m8,reg8 ; 10 /r [8086]
6942 \c ADC r/m16,reg16 ; o16 11 /r [8086]
6943 \c ADC r/m32,reg32 ; o32 11 /r [386]
6945 \c ADC reg8,r/m8 ; 12 /r [8086]
6946 \c ADC reg16,r/m16 ; o16 13 /r [8086]
6947 \c ADC reg32,r/m32 ; o32 13 /r [386]
6949 \c ADC r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /2 ib [8086]
6950 \c ADC r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /2 iw [8086]
6951 \c ADC r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /2 id [386]
6953 \c ADC r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /2 ib [8086]
6954 \c ADC r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /2 ib [386]
6956 \c ADC AL,imm8 ; 14 ib [8086]
6957 \c ADC AX,imm16 ; o16 15 iw [8086]
6958 \c ADC EAX,imm32 ; o32 15 id [386]
6960 \c{ADC} performs integer addition: it adds its two operands
6961 together, plus the value of the carry flag, and leaves the result in
6962 its destination (first) operand. The destination operand can be a
6963 register or a memory location. The source operand can be a register,
6964 a memory location or an immediate value.
6966 The flags are set according to the result of the operation: in
6967 particular, the carry flag is affected and can be used by a
6968 subsequent \c{ADC} instruction.
6970 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
6971 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
6972 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
6973 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
6974 form of the instruction.
6976 To add two numbers without also adding the contents of the carry
6977 flag, use \c{ADD} (\k{insADD}).
6980 \S{insADD} \i\c{ADD}: Add Integers
6982 \c ADD r/m8,reg8 ; 00 /r [8086]
6983 \c ADD r/m16,reg16 ; o16 01 /r [8086]
6984 \c ADD r/m32,reg32 ; o32 01 /r [386]
6986 \c ADD reg8,r/m8 ; 02 /r [8086]
6987 \c ADD reg16,r/m16 ; o16 03 /r [8086]
6988 \c ADD reg32,r/m32 ; o32 03 /r [386]
6990 \c ADD r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /0 ib [8086]
6991 \c ADD r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /0 iw [8086]
6992 \c ADD r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /0 id [386]
6994 \c ADD r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /0 ib [8086]
6995 \c ADD r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /0 ib [386]
6997 \c ADD AL,imm8 ; 04 ib [8086]
6998 \c ADD AX,imm16 ; o16 05 iw [8086]
6999 \c ADD EAX,imm32 ; o32 05 id [386]
7001 \c{ADD} performs integer addition: it adds its two operands
7002 together, and leaves the result in its destination (first) operand.
7003 The destination operand can be a register or a memory location.
7004 The source operand can be a register, a memory location or an
7007 The flags are set according to the result of the operation: in
7008 particular, the carry flag is affected and can be used by a
7009 subsequent \c{ADC} instruction.
7011 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
7012 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
7013 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
7014 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
7015 form of the instruction.
7018 \S{insADDPD} \i\c{ADDPD}: ADD Packed Double-Precision FP Values
7020 \c ADDPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 58 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7022 \c{ADDPD} performs addition on each of two packed double-precision
7025 \c dst[0-63] := dst[0-63] + src[0-63],
7026 \c dst[64-127] := dst[64-127] + src[64-127].
7028 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
7029 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7032 \S{insADDPS} \i\c{ADDPS}: ADD Packed Single-Precision FP Values
7034 \c ADDPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F 58 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
7036 \c{ADDPS} performs addition on each of four packed single-precision
7039 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] + src[0-31],
7040 \c dst[32-63] := dst[32-63] + src[32-63],
7041 \c dst[64-95] := dst[64-95] + src[64-95],
7042 \c dst[96-127] := dst[96-127] + src[96-127].
7044 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
7045 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7048 \S{insADDSD} \i\c{ADDSD}: ADD Scalar Double-Precision FP Values
7050 \c ADDSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F 58 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
7052 \c{ADDSD} adds the low double-precision FP values from the source
7053 and destination operands and stores the double-precision FP result
7054 in the destination operand.
7056 \c dst[0-63] := dst[0-63] + src[0-63],
7057 \c dst[64-127) remains unchanged.
7059 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
7060 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location.
7063 \S{insADDSS} \i\c{ADDSS}: ADD Scalar Single-Precision FP Values
7065 \c ADDSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F 58 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7067 \c{ADDSS} adds the low single-precision FP values from the source
7068 and destination operands and stores the single-precision FP result
7069 in the destination operand.
7071 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] + src[0-31],
7072 \c dst[32-127] remains unchanged.
7074 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
7075 either an \c{XMM} register or a 32-bit memory location.
7078 \S{insAND} \i\c{AND}: Bitwise AND
7080 \c AND r/m8,reg8 ; 20 /r [8086]
7081 \c AND r/m16,reg16 ; o16 21 /r [8086]
7082 \c AND r/m32,reg32 ; o32 21 /r [386]
7084 \c AND reg8,r/m8 ; 22 /r [8086]
7085 \c AND reg16,r/m16 ; o16 23 /r [8086]
7086 \c AND reg32,r/m32 ; o32 23 /r [386]
7088 \c AND r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /4 ib [8086]
7089 \c AND r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /4 iw [8086]
7090 \c AND r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /4 id [386]
7092 \c AND r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /4 ib [8086]
7093 \c AND r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /4 ib [386]
7095 \c AND AL,imm8 ; 24 ib [8086]
7096 \c AND AX,imm16 ; o16 25 iw [8086]
7097 \c AND EAX,imm32 ; o32 25 id [386]
7099 \c{AND} performs a bitwise AND operation between its two operands
7100 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if the corresponding
7101 bits of the two inputs were both 1), and stores the result in the
7102 destination (first) operand. The destination operand can be a
7103 register or a memory location. The source operand can be a register,
7104 a memory location or an immediate value.
7106 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
7107 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
7108 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
7109 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
7110 form of the instruction.
7112 The \c{MMX} instruction \c{PAND} (see \k{insPAND}) performs the same
7113 operation on the 64-bit \c{MMX} registers.
7116 \S{insANDNPD} \i\c{ANDNPD}: Bitwise Logical AND NOT of
7117 Packed Double-Precision FP Values
7119 \c ANDNPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 55 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7121 \c{ANDNPD} inverts the bits of the two double-precision
7122 floating-point values in the destination register, and then
7123 performs a logical AND between the two double-precision
7124 floating-point values in the source operand and the temporary
7125 inverted result, storing the result in the destination register.
7127 \c dst[0-63] := src[0-63] AND NOT dst[0-63],
7128 \c dst[64-127] := src[64-127] AND NOT dst[64-127].
7130 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
7131 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7134 \S{insANDNPS} \i\c{ANDNPS}: Bitwise Logical AND NOT of
7135 Packed Single-Precision FP Values
7137 \c ANDNPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F 55 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
7139 \c{ANDNPS} inverts the bits of the four single-precision
7140 floating-point values in the destination register, and then
7141 performs a logical AND between the four single-precision
7142 floating-point values in the source operand and the temporary
7143 inverted result, storing the result in the destination register.
7145 \c dst[0-31] := src[0-31] AND NOT dst[0-31],
7146 \c dst[32-63] := src[32-63] AND NOT dst[32-63],
7147 \c dst[64-95] := src[64-95] AND NOT dst[64-95],
7148 \c dst[96-127] := src[96-127] AND NOT dst[96-127].
7150 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
7151 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7154 \S{insANDPD} \i\c{ANDPD}: Bitwise Logical AND For Single FP
7156 \c ANDPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 54 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7158 \c{ANDPD} performs a bitwise logical AND of the two double-precision
7159 floating point values in the source and destination operand, and
7160 stores the result in the destination register.
7162 \c dst[0-63] := src[0-63] AND dst[0-63],
7163 \c dst[64-127] := src[64-127] AND dst[64-127].
7165 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
7166 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7169 \S{insANDPS} \i\c{ANDPS}: Bitwise Logical AND For Single FP
7171 \c ANDPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F 54 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
7173 \c{ANDPS} performs a bitwise logical AND of the four single-precision
7174 floating point values in the source and destination operand, and
7175 stores the result in the destination register.
7177 \c dst[0-31] := src[0-31] AND dst[0-31],
7178 \c dst[32-63] := src[32-63] AND dst[32-63],
7179 \c dst[64-95] := src[64-95] AND dst[64-95],
7180 \c dst[96-127] := src[96-127] AND dst[96-127].
7182 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
7183 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7186 \S{insARPL} \i\c{ARPL}: Adjust RPL Field of Selector
7188 \c ARPL r/m16,reg16 ; 63 /r [286,PRIV]
7190 \c{ARPL} expects its two word operands to be segment selectors. It
7191 adjusts the \i\c{RPL} (requested privilege level - stored in the bottom
7192 two bits of the selector) field of the destination (first) operand
7193 to ensure that it is no less (i.e. no more privileged than) the \c{RPL}
7194 field of the source operand. The zero flag is set if and only if a
7195 change had to be made.
7198 \S{insBOUND} \i\c{BOUND}: Check Array Index against Bounds
7200 \c BOUND reg16,mem ; o16 62 /r [186]
7201 \c BOUND reg32,mem ; o32 62 /r [386]
7203 \c{BOUND} expects its second operand to point to an area of memory
7204 containing two signed values of the same size as its first operand
7205 (i.e. two words for the 16-bit form; two doublewords for the 32-bit
7206 form). It performs two signed comparisons: if the value in the
7207 register passed as its first operand is less than the first of the
7208 in-memory values, or is greater than or equal to the second, it
7209 throws a \c{BR} exception. Otherwise, it does nothing.
7212 \S{insBSF} \i\c{BSF}, \i\c{BSR}: Bit Scan
7214 \c BSF reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F BC /r [386]
7215 \c BSF reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F BC /r [386]
7217 \c BSR reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F BD /r [386]
7218 \c BSR reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F BD /r [386]
7220 \b \c{BSF} searches for the least significant set bit in its source
7221 (second) operand, and if it finds one, stores the index in
7222 its destination (first) operand. If no set bit is found, the
7223 contents of the destination operand are undefined. If the source
7224 operand is zero, the zero flag is set.
7226 \b \c{BSR} performs the same function, but searches from the top
7227 instead, so it finds the most significant set bit.
7229 Bit indices are from 0 (least significant) to 15 or 31 (most
7230 significant). The destination operand can only be a register.
7231 The source operand can be a register or a memory location.
7234 \S{insBSWAP} \i\c{BSWAP}: Byte Swap
7236 \c BSWAP reg32 ; o32 0F C8+r [486]
7238 \c{BSWAP} swaps the order of the four bytes of a 32-bit register:
7239 bits 0-7 exchange places with bits 24-31, and bits 8-15 swap with
7240 bits 16-23. There is no explicit 16-bit equivalent: to byte-swap
7241 \c{AX}, \c{BX}, \c{CX} or \c{DX}, \c{XCHG} can be used. When \c{BSWAP}
7242 is used with a 16-bit register, the result is undefined.
7245 \S{insBT} \i\c{BT}, \i\c{BTC}, \i\c{BTR}, \i\c{BTS}: Bit Test
7247 \c BT r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F A3 /r [386]
7248 \c BT r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F A3 /r [386]
7249 \c BT r/m16,imm8 ; o16 0F BA /4 ib [386]
7250 \c BT r/m32,imm8 ; o32 0F BA /4 ib [386]
7252 \c BTC r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F BB /r [386]
7253 \c BTC r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F BB /r [386]
7254 \c BTC r/m16,imm8 ; o16 0F BA /7 ib [386]
7255 \c BTC r/m32,imm8 ; o32 0F BA /7 ib [386]
7257 \c BTR r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F B3 /r [386]
7258 \c BTR r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F B3 /r [386]
7259 \c BTR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 0F BA /6 ib [386]
7260 \c BTR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 0F BA /6 ib [386]
7262 \c BTS r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F AB /r [386]
7263 \c BTS r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F AB /r [386]
7264 \c BTS r/m16,imm ; o16 0F BA /5 ib [386]
7265 \c BTS r/m32,imm ; o32 0F BA /5 ib [386]
7267 These instructions all test one bit of their first operand, whose
7268 index is given by the second operand, and store the value of that
7269 bit into the carry flag. Bit indices are from 0 (least significant)
7270 to 15 or 31 (most significant).
7272 In addition to storing the original value of the bit into the carry
7273 flag, \c{BTR} also resets (clears) the bit in the operand itself.
7274 \c{BTS} sets the bit, and \c{BTC} complements the bit. \c{BT} does
7275 not modify its operands.
7277 The destination can be a register or a memory location. The source can
7278 be a register or an immediate value.
7280 If the destination operand is a register, the bit offset should be
7281 in the range 0-15 (for 16-bit operands) or 0-31 (for 32-bit operands).
7282 An immediate value outside these ranges will be taken modulo 16/32
7285 If the destination operand is a memory location, then an immediate
7286 bit offset follows the same rules as for a register. If the bit offset
7287 is in a register, then it can be anything within the signed range of
7288 the register used (ie, for a 32-bit operand, it can be (-2^31) to (2^31 - 1)
7291 \S{insCALL} \i\c{CALL}: Call Subroutine
7293 \c CALL imm ; E8 rw/rd [8086]
7294 \c CALL imm:imm16 ; o16 9A iw iw [8086]
7295 \c CALL imm:imm32 ; o32 9A id iw [386]
7296 \c CALL FAR mem16 ; o16 FF /3 [8086]
7297 \c CALL FAR mem32 ; o32 FF /3 [386]
7298 \c CALL r/m16 ; o16 FF /2 [8086]
7299 \c CALL r/m32 ; o32 FF /2 [386]
7301 \c{CALL} calls a subroutine, by means of pushing the current
7302 instruction pointer (\c{IP}) and optionally \c{CS} as well on the
7303 stack, and then jumping to a given address.
7305 \c{CS} is pushed as well as \c{IP} if and only if the call is a far
7306 call, i.e. a destination segment address is specified in the
7307 instruction. The forms involving two colon-separated arguments are
7308 far calls; so are the \c{CALL FAR mem} forms.
7310 The immediate \i{near call} takes one of two forms (\c{call imm16/imm32},
7311 determined by the current segment size limit. For 16-bit operands,
7312 you would use \c{CALL 0x1234}, and for 32-bit operands you would use
7313 \c{CALL 0x12345678}. The value passed as an operand is a relative offset.
7315 You can choose between the two immediate \i{far call} forms
7316 (\c{CALL imm:imm}) by the use of the \c{WORD} and \c{DWORD} keywords:
7317 \c{CALL WORD 0x1234:0x5678}) or \c{CALL DWORD 0x1234:0x56789abc}.
7319 The \c{CALL FAR mem} forms execute a far call by loading the
7320 destination address out of memory. The address loaded consists of 16
7321 or 32 bits of offset (depending on the operand size), and 16 bits of
7322 segment. The operand size may be overridden using \c{CALL WORD FAR
7323 mem} or \c{CALL DWORD FAR mem}.
7325 The \c{CALL r/m} forms execute a \i{near call} (within the same
7326 segment), loading the destination address out of memory or out of a
7327 register. The keyword \c{NEAR} may be specified, for clarity, in
7328 these forms, but is not necessary. Again, operand size can be
7329 overridden using \c{CALL WORD mem} or \c{CALL DWORD mem}.
7331 As a convenience, NASM does not require you to call a far procedure
7332 symbol by coding the cumbersome \c{CALL SEG routine:routine}, but
7333 instead allows the easier synonym \c{CALL FAR routine}.
7335 The \c{CALL r/m} forms given above are near calls; NASM will accept
7336 the \c{NEAR} keyword (e.g. \c{CALL NEAR [address]}), even though it
7337 is not strictly necessary.
7340 \S{insCBW} \i\c{CBW}, \i\c{CWD}, \i\c{CDQ}, \i\c{CWDE}: Sign Extensions
7342 \c CBW ; o16 98 [8086]
7343 \c CWDE ; o32 98 [386]
7345 \c CWD ; o16 99 [8086]
7346 \c CDQ ; o32 99 [386]
7348 All these instructions sign-extend a short value into a longer one,
7349 by replicating the top bit of the original value to fill the
7352 \c{CBW} extends \c{AL} into \c{AX} by repeating the top bit of
7353 \c{AL} in every bit of \c{AH}. \c{CWDE} extends \c{AX} into
7354 \c{EAX}. \c{CWD} extends \c{AX} into \c{DX:AX} by repeating
7355 the top bit of \c{AX} throughout \c{DX}, and \c{CDQ} extends
7356 \c{EAX} into \c{EDX:EAX}.
7359 \S{insCLC} \i\c{CLC}, \i\c{CLD}, \i\c{CLI}, \i\c{CLTS}: Clear Flags
7364 \c CLTS ; 0F 06 [286,PRIV]
7366 These instructions clear various flags. \c{CLC} clears the carry
7367 flag; \c{CLD} clears the direction flag; \c{CLI} clears the
7368 interrupt flag (thus disabling interrupts); and \c{CLTS} clears the
7369 task-switched (\c{TS}) flag in \c{CR0}.
7371 To set the carry, direction, or interrupt flags, use the \c{STC},
7372 \c{STD} and \c{STI} instructions (\k{insSTC}). To invert the carry
7373 flag, use \c{CMC} (\k{insCMC}).
7376 \S{insCLFLUSH} \i\c{CLFLUSH}: Flush Cache Line
7378 \c CLFLUSH mem ; 0F AE /7 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7380 \c{CLFLUSH} invalidates the cache line that contains the linear address
7381 specified by the source operand from all levels of the processor cache
7382 hierarchy (data and instruction). If, at any level of the cache
7383 hierarchy, the line is inconsistent with memory (dirty) it is written
7384 to memory before invalidation. The source operand points to a
7385 byte-sized memory location.
7387 Although \c{CLFLUSH} is flagged \c{SSE2} and above, it may not be
7388 present on all processors which have \c{SSE2} support, and it may be
7389 supported on other processors; the \c{CPUID} instruction (\k{insCPUID})
7390 will return a bit which indicates support for the \c{CLFLUSH} instruction.
7393 \S{insCMC} \i\c{CMC}: Complement Carry Flag
7397 \c{CMC} changes the value of the carry flag: if it was 0, it sets it
7398 to 1, and vice versa.
7401 \S{insCMOVcc} \i\c{CMOVcc}: Conditional Move
7403 \c CMOVcc reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F 40+cc /r [P6]
7404 \c CMOVcc reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F 40+cc /r [P6]
7406 \c{CMOV} moves its source (second) operand into its destination
7407 (first) operand if the given condition code is satisfied; otherwise
7410 For a list of condition codes, see \k{iref-cc}.
7412 Although the \c{CMOV} instructions are flagged \c{P6} and above, they
7413 may not be supported by all Pentium Pro processors; the \c{CPUID}
7414 instruction (\k{insCPUID}) will return a bit which indicates whether
7415 conditional moves are supported.
7418 \S{insCMP} \i\c{CMP}: Compare Integers
7420 \c CMP r/m8,reg8 ; 38 /r [8086]
7421 \c CMP r/m16,reg16 ; o16 39 /r [8086]
7422 \c CMP r/m32,reg32 ; o32 39 /r [386]
7424 \c CMP reg8,r/m8 ; 3A /r [8086]
7425 \c CMP reg16,r/m16 ; o16 3B /r [8086]
7426 \c CMP reg32,r/m32 ; o32 3B /r [386]
7428 \c CMP r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /0 ib [8086]
7429 \c CMP r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /0 iw [8086]
7430 \c CMP r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /0 id [386]
7432 \c CMP r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /0 ib [8086]
7433 \c CMP r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /0 ib [386]
7435 \c CMP AL,imm8 ; 3C ib [8086]
7436 \c CMP AX,imm16 ; o16 3D iw [8086]
7437 \c CMP EAX,imm32 ; o32 3D id [386]
7439 \c{CMP} performs a `mental' subtraction of its second operand from
7440 its first operand, and affects the flags as if the subtraction had
7441 taken place, but does not store the result of the subtraction
7444 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
7445 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
7446 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
7447 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
7448 form of the instruction.
7450 The destination operand can be a register or a memory location. The
7451 source can be a register, memory location or an immediate value of
7452 the same size as the destination.
7455 \S{insCMPccPD} \i\c{CMPccPD}: Packed Double-Precision FP Compare
7456 \I\c{CMPEQPD} \I\c{CMPLTPD} \I\c{CMPLEPD} \I\c{CMPUNORDPD}
7457 \I\c{CMPNEQPD} \I\c{CMPNLTPD} \I\c{CMPNLEPD} \I\c{CMPORDPD}
7459 \c CMPPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128,imm8 ; 66 0F C2 /r ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7461 \c CMPEQPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F C2 /r 00 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7462 \c CMPLTPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F C2 /r 01 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7463 \c CMPLEPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F C2 /r 02 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7464 \c CMPUNORDPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F C2 /r 03 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7465 \c CMPNEQPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F C2 /r 04 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7466 \c CMPNLTPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F C2 /r 05 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7467 \c CMPNLEPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F C2 /r 06 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7468 \c CMPORDPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F C2 /r 07 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7470 The \c{CMPccPD} instructions compare the two packed double-precision
7471 FP values in the source and destination operands, and returns the
7472 result of the comparison in the destination register. The result of
7473 each comparison is a quadword mask of all 1s (comparison true) or
7474 all 0s (comparison false).
7476 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either an
7477 \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7479 The third operand is an 8-bit immediate value, of which the low 3
7480 bits define the type of comparison. For ease of programming, the
7481 8 two-operand pseudo-instructions are provided, with the third
7482 operand already filled in. The \I{Condition Predicates}
7483 \c{Condition Predicates} are:
7487 \c LE 2 Less-than-or-equal
7488 \c UNORD 3 Unordered
7490 \c NLT 5 Not-less-than
7491 \c NLE 6 Not-less-than-or-equal
7494 For more details of the comparison predicates, and details of how
7495 to emulate the "greater-than" equivalents, see \k{iref-SSE-cc}
7498 \S{insCMPccPS} \i\c{CMPccPS}: Packed Single-Precision FP Compare
7499 \I\c{CMPEQPS} \I\c{CMPLTPS} \I\c{CMPLEPS} \I\c{CMPUNORDPS}
7500 \I\c{CMPNEQPS} \I\c{CMPNLTPS} \I\c{CMPNLEPS} \I\c{CMPORDPS}
7502 \c CMPPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128,imm8 ; 0F C2 /r ib [KATMAI,SSE]
7504 \c CMPEQPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F C2 /r 00 [KATMAI,SSE]
7505 \c CMPLTPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F C2 /r 01 [KATMAI,SSE]
7506 \c CMPLEPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F C2 /r 02 [KATMAI,SSE]
7507 \c CMPUNORDPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F C2 /r 03 [KATMAI,SSE]
7508 \c CMPNEQPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F C2 /r 04 [KATMAI,SSE]
7509 \c CMPNLTPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F C2 /r 05 [KATMAI,SSE]
7510 \c CMPNLEPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F C2 /r 06 [KATMAI,SSE]
7511 \c CMPORDPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F C2 /r 07 [KATMAI,SSE]
7513 The \c{CMPccPS} instructions compare the two packed single-precision
7514 FP values in the source and destination operands, and returns the
7515 result of the comparison in the destination register. The result of
7516 each comparison is a doubleword mask of all 1s (comparison true) or
7517 all 0s (comparison false).
7519 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either an
7520 \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7522 The third operand is an 8-bit immediate value, of which the low 3
7523 bits define the type of comparison. For ease of programming, the
7524 8 two-operand pseudo-instructions are provided, with the third
7525 operand already filled in. The \I{Condition Predicates}
7526 \c{Condition Predicates} are:
7530 \c LE 2 Less-than-or-equal
7531 \c UNORD 3 Unordered
7533 \c NLT 5 Not-less-than
7534 \c NLE 6 Not-less-than-or-equal
7537 For more details of the comparison predicates, and details of how
7538 to emulate the "greater-than" equivalents, see \k{iref-SSE-cc}
7541 \S{insCMPSB} \i\c{CMPSB}, \i\c{CMPSW}, \i\c{CMPSD}: Compare Strings
7543 \c CMPSB ; A6 [8086]
7544 \c CMPSW ; o16 A7 [8086]
7545 \c CMPSD ; o32 A7 [386]
7547 \c{CMPSB} compares the byte at \c{[DS:SI]} or \c{[DS:ESI]} with the
7548 byte at \c{[ES:DI]} or \c{[ES:EDI]}, and sets the flags accordingly.
7549 It then increments or decrements (depending on the direction flag:
7550 increments if the flag is clear, decrements if it is set) \c{SI} and
7551 \c{DI} (or \c{ESI} and \c{EDI}).
7553 The registers used are \c{SI} and \c{DI} if the address size is 16
7554 bits, and \c{ESI} and \c{EDI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use
7555 an address size not equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can
7556 use an explicit \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
7558 The segment register used to load from \c{[SI]} or \c{[ESI]} can be
7559 overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
7560 example, \c{ES CMPSB}). The use of \c{ES} for the load from \c{[DI]}
7561 or \c{[EDI]} cannot be overridden.
7563 \c{CMPSW} and \c{CMPSD} work in the same way, but they compare a
7564 word or a doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement
7565 the addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of 1.
7567 The \c{REPE} and \c{REPNE} prefixes (equivalently, \c{REPZ} and
7568 \c{REPNZ}) may be used to repeat the instruction up to \c{CX} (or
7569 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times until the
7570 first unequal or equal byte is found.
7573 \S{insCMPccSD} \i\c{CMPccSD}: Scalar Double-Precision FP Compare
7574 \I\c{CMPEQSD} \I\c{CMPLTSD} \I\c{CMPLESD} \I\c{CMPUNORDSD}
7575 \I\c{CMPNEQSD} \I\c{CMPNLTSD} \I\c{CMPNLESD} \I\c{CMPORDSD}
7577 \c CMPSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64,imm8 ; F2 0F C2 /r ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7579 \c CMPEQSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F C2 /r 00 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7580 \c CMPLTSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F C2 /r 01 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7581 \c CMPLESD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F C2 /r 02 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7582 \c CMPUNORDSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F C2 /r 03 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7583 \c CMPNEQSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F C2 /r 04 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7584 \c CMPNLTSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F C2 /r 05 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7585 \c CMPNLESD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F C2 /r 06 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7586 \c CMPORDSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F C2 /r 07 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7588 The \c{CMPccSD} instructions compare the low-order double-precision
7589 FP values in the source and destination operands, and returns the
7590 result of the comparison in the destination register. The result of
7591 each comparison is a quadword mask of all 1s (comparison true) or
7592 all 0s (comparison false).
7594 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either an
7595 \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7597 The third operand is an 8-bit immediate value, of which the low 3
7598 bits define the type of comparison. For ease of programming, the
7599 8 two-operand pseudo-instructions are provided, with the third
7600 operand already filled in. The \I{Condition Predicates}
7601 \c{Condition Predicates} are:
7605 \c LE 2 Less-than-or-equal
7606 \c UNORD 3 Unordered
7608 \c NLT 5 Not-less-than
7609 \c NLE 6 Not-less-than-or-equal
7612 For more details of the comparison predicates, and details of how
7613 to emulate the "greater-than" equivalents, see \k{iref-SSE-cc}
7616 \S{insCMPccSS} \i\c{CMPccSS}: Scalar Single-Precision FP Compare
7617 \I\c{CMPEQSS} \I\c{CMPLTSS} \I\c{CMPLESS} \I\c{CMPUNORDSS}
7618 \I\c{CMPNEQSS} \I\c{CMPNLTSS} \I\c{CMPNLESS} \I\c{CMPORDSS}
7620 \c CMPSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32,imm8 ; F3 0F C2 /r ib [KATMAI,SSE]
7622 \c CMPEQSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F C2 /r 00 [KATMAI,SSE]
7623 \c CMPLTSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F C2 /r 01 [KATMAI,SSE]
7624 \c CMPLESS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F C2 /r 02 [KATMAI,SSE]
7625 \c CMPUNORDSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F C2 /r 03 [KATMAI,SSE]
7626 \c CMPNEQSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F C2 /r 04 [KATMAI,SSE]
7627 \c CMPNLTSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F C2 /r 05 [KATMAI,SSE]
7628 \c CMPNLESS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F C2 /r 06 [KATMAI,SSE]
7629 \c CMPORDSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F C2 /r 07 [KATMAI,SSE]
7631 The \c{CMPccSS} instructions compare the low-order single-precision
7632 FP values in the source and destination operands, and returns the
7633 result of the comparison in the destination register. The result of
7634 each comparison is a doubleword mask of all 1s (comparison true) or
7635 all 0s (comparison false).
7637 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either an
7638 \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7640 The third operand is an 8-bit immediate value, of which the low 3
7641 bits define the type of comparison. For ease of programming, the
7642 8 two-operand pseudo-instructions are provided, with the third
7643 operand already filled in. The \I{Condition Predicates}
7644 \c{Condition Predicates} are:
7648 \c LE 2 Less-than-or-equal
7649 \c UNORD 3 Unordered
7651 \c NLT 5 Not-less-than
7652 \c NLE 6 Not-less-than-or-equal
7655 For more details of the comparison predicates, and details of how
7656 to emulate the "greater-than" equivalents, see \k{iref-SSE-cc}
7659 \S{insCMPXCHG} \i\c{CMPXCHG}, \i\c{CMPXCHG486}: Compare and Exchange
7661 \c CMPXCHG r/m8,reg8 ; 0F B0 /r [PENT]
7662 \c CMPXCHG r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F B1 /r [PENT]
7663 \c CMPXCHG r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F B1 /r [PENT]
7665 \c CMPXCHG486 r/m8,reg8 ; 0F A6 /r [486,UNDOC]
7666 \c CMPXCHG486 r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F A7 /r [486,UNDOC]
7667 \c CMPXCHG486 r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F A7 /r [486,UNDOC]
7669 These two instructions perform exactly the same operation; however,
7670 apparently some (not all) 486 processors support it under a
7671 non-standard opcode, so NASM provides the undocumented
7672 \c{CMPXCHG486} form to generate the non-standard opcode.
7674 \c{CMPXCHG} compares its destination (first) operand to the value in
7675 \c{AL}, \c{AX} or \c{EAX} (depending on the operand size of the
7676 instruction). If they are equal, it copies its source (second)
7677 operand into the destination and sets the zero flag. Otherwise, it
7678 clears the zero flag and copies the destination register to AL, AX or EAX.
7680 The destination can be either a register or a memory location. The
7681 source is a register.
7683 \c{CMPXCHG} is intended to be used for atomic operations in
7684 multitasking or multiprocessor environments. To safely update a
7685 value in shared memory, for example, you might load the value into
7686 \c{EAX}, load the updated value into \c{EBX}, and then execute the
7687 instruction \c{LOCK CMPXCHG [value],EBX}. If \c{value} has not
7688 changed since being loaded, it is updated with your desired new
7689 value, and the zero flag is set to let you know it has worked. (The
7690 \c{LOCK} prefix prevents another processor doing anything in the
7691 middle of this operation: it guarantees atomicity.) However, if
7692 another processor has modified the value in between your load and
7693 your attempted store, the store does not happen, and you are
7694 notified of the failure by a cleared zero flag, so you can go round
7698 \S{insCMPXCHG8B} \i\c{CMPXCHG8B}: Compare and Exchange Eight Bytes
7700 \c CMPXCHG8B mem ; 0F C7 /1 [PENT]
7702 This is a larger and more unwieldy version of \c{CMPXCHG}: it
7703 compares the 64-bit (eight-byte) value stored at \c{[mem]} with the
7704 value in \c{EDX:EAX}. If they are equal, it sets the zero flag and
7705 stores \c{ECX:EBX} into the memory area. If they are unequal, it
7706 clears the zero flag and stores the memory contents into \c{EDX:EAX}.
7708 \c{CMPXCHG8B} can be used with the \c{LOCK} prefix, to allow atomic
7709 execution. This is useful in multi-processor and multi-tasking
7713 \S{insCOMISD} \i\c{COMISD}: Scalar Ordered Double-Precision FP Compare and Set EFLAGS
7715 \c COMISD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; 66 0F 2F /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7717 \c{COMISD} compares the low-order double-precision FP value in the
7718 two source operands. ZF, PF and CF are set according to the result.
7719 OF, AF and AF are cleared. The unordered result is returned if either
7720 source is a NaN (QNaN or SNaN).
7722 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either
7723 an \c{XMM} register or a memory location.
7725 The flags are set according to the following rules:
7727 \c Result Flags Values
7729 \c UNORDERED: ZF,PF,CF <-- 111;
7730 \c GREATER_THAN: ZF,PF,CF <-- 000;
7731 \c LESS_THAN: ZF,PF,CF <-- 001;
7732 \c EQUAL: ZF,PF,CF <-- 100;
7735 \S{insCOMISS} \i\c{COMISS}: Scalar Ordered Single-Precision FP Compare and Set EFLAGS
7737 \c COMISS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; 66 0F 2F /r [KATMAI,SSE]
7739 \c{COMISS} compares the low-order single-precision FP value in the
7740 two source operands. ZF, PF and CF are set according to the result.
7741 OF, AF and AF are cleared. The unordered result is returned if either
7742 source is a NaN (QNaN or SNaN).
7744 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either
7745 an \c{XMM} register or a memory location.
7747 The flags are set according to the following rules:
7749 \c Result Flags Values
7751 \c UNORDERED: ZF,PF,CF <-- 111;
7752 \c GREATER_THAN: ZF,PF,CF <-- 000;
7753 \c LESS_THAN: ZF,PF,CF <-- 001;
7754 \c EQUAL: ZF,PF,CF <-- 100;
7757 \S{insCPUID} \i\c{CPUID}: Get CPU Identification Code
7759 \c CPUID ; 0F A2 [PENT]
7761 \c{CPUID} returns various information about the processor it is
7762 being executed on. It fills the four registers \c{EAX}, \c{EBX},
7763 \c{ECX} and \c{EDX} with information, which varies depending on the
7764 input contents of \c{EAX}.
7766 \c{CPUID} also acts as a barrier to serialise instruction execution:
7767 executing the \c{CPUID} instruction guarantees that all the effects
7768 (memory modification, flag modification, register modification) of
7769 previous instructions have been completed before the next
7770 instruction gets fetched.
7772 The information returned is as follows:
7774 \b If \c{EAX} is zero on input, \c{EAX} on output holds the maximum
7775 acceptable input value of \c{EAX}, and \c{EBX:EDX:ECX} contain the
7776 string \c{"GenuineIntel"} (or not, if you have a clone processor).
7777 That is to say, \c{EBX} contains \c{"Genu"} (in NASM's own sense of
7778 character constants, described in \k{chrconst}), \c{EDX} contains
7779 \c{"ineI"} and \c{ECX} contains \c{"ntel"}.
7781 \b If \c{EAX} is one on input, \c{EAX} on output contains version
7782 information about the processor, and \c{EDX} contains a set of
7783 feature flags, showing the presence and absence of various features.
7784 For example, bit 8 is set if the \c{CMPXCHG8B} instruction
7785 (\k{insCMPXCHG8B}) is supported, bit 15 is set if the conditional
7786 move instructions (\k{insCMOVcc} and \k{insFCMOVB}) are supported,
7787 and bit 23 is set if \c{MMX} instructions are supported.
7789 \b If \c{EAX} is two on input, \c{EAX}, \c{EBX}, \c{ECX} and \c{EDX}
7790 all contain information about caches and TLBs (Translation Lookahead
7793 For more information on the data returned from \c{CPUID}, see the
7794 documentation from Intel and other processor manufacturers.
7797 \S{insCVTDQ2PD} \i\c{CVTDQ2PD}:
7798 Packed Signed INT32 to Packed Double-Precision FP Conversion
7800 \c CVTDQ2PD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F3 0F E6 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7802 \c{CVTDQ2PD} converts two packed signed doublewords from the source
7803 operand to two packed double-precision FP values in the destination
7806 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
7807 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location. If the
7808 source is a register, the packed integers are in the low quadword.
7811 \S{insCVTDQ2PS} \i\c{CVTDQ2PS}:
7812 Packed Signed INT32 to Packed Single-Precision FP Conversion
7814 \c CVTDQ2PS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F 5B /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7816 \c{CVTDQ2PS} converts four packed signed doublewords from the source
7817 operand to four packed single-precision FP values in the destination
7820 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
7821 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7823 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7826 \S{insCVTPD2DQ} \i\c{CVTPD2DQ}:
7827 Packed Double-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion
7829 \c CVTPD2DQ xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; F2 0F E6 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7831 \c{CVTPD2DQ} converts two packed double-precision FP values from the
7832 source operand to two packed signed doublewords in the low quadword
7833 of the destination operand. The high quadword of the destination is
7836 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
7837 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7839 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7842 \S{insCVTPD2PI} \i\c{CVTPD2PI}:
7843 Packed Double-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion
7845 \c CVTPD2PI mm,xmm/mem128 ; 66 0F 2D /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7847 \c{CVTPD2PI} converts two packed double-precision FP values from the
7848 source operand to two packed signed doublewords in the destination
7851 The destination operand is an \c{MMX} register. The source can be
7852 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7854 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7857 \S{insCVTPD2PS} \i\c{CVTPD2PS}:
7858 Packed Double-Precision FP to Packed Single-Precision FP Conversion
7860 \c CVTPD2PS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 5A /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7862 \c{CVTPD2PS} converts two packed double-precision FP values from the
7863 source operand to two packed single-precision FP values in the low
7864 quadword of the destination operand. The high quadword of the
7865 destination is set to all 0s.
7867 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
7868 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7870 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7873 \S{insCVTPI2PD} \i\c{CVTPI2PD}:
7874 Packed Signed INT32 to Packed Double-Precision FP Conversion
7876 \c CVTPI2PD xmm,mm/mem64 ; 66 0F 2A /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7878 \c{CVTPI2PD} converts two packed signed doublewords from the source
7879 operand to two packed double-precision FP values in the destination
7882 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
7883 either an \c{MMX} register or a 64-bit memory location.
7885 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7888 \S{insCVTPI2PS} \i\c{CVTPI2PS}:
7889 Packed Signed INT32 to Packed Single-FP Conversion
7891 \c CVTPI2PS xmm,mm/mem64 ; 0F 2A /r [KATMAI,SSE]
7893 \c{CVTPI2PS} converts two packed signed doublewords from the source
7894 operand to two packed single-precision FP values in the low quadword
7895 of the destination operand. The high quadword of the destination
7898 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
7899 either an \c{MMX} register or a 64-bit memory location.
7901 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7904 \S{insCVTPS2DQ} \i\c{CVTPS2DQ}:
7905 Packed Single-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion
7907 \c CVTPS2DQ xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 5B /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7909 \c{CVTPS2DQ} converts four packed single-precision FP values from the
7910 source operand to four packed signed doublewords in the destination operand.
7912 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
7913 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
7915 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7918 \S{insCVTPS2PD} \i\c{CVTPS2PD}:
7919 Packed Single-Precision FP to Packed Double-Precision FP Conversion
7921 \c CVTPS2PD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; 0F 5A /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7923 \c{CVTPS2PD} converts two packed single-precision FP values from the
7924 source operand to two packed double-precision FP values in the destination
7927 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
7928 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location. If the source
7929 is a register, the input values are in the low quadword.
7931 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7934 \S{insCVTPS2PI} \i\c{CVTPS2PI}:
7935 Packed Single-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion
7937 \c CVTPS2PI mm,xmm/mem64 ; 0F 2D /r [KATMAI,SSE]
7939 \c{CVTPS2PI} converts two packed single-precision FP values from
7940 the source operand to two packed signed doublewords in the destination
7943 The destination operand is an \c{MMX} register. The source can be
7944 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location. If the
7945 source is a register, the input values are in the low quadword.
7947 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7950 \S{insCVTSD2SI} \i\c{CVTSD2SI}:
7951 Scalar Double-Precision FP to Signed INT32 Conversion
7953 \c CVTSD2SI reg32,xmm/mem64 ; F2 0F 2D /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7955 \c{CVTSD2SI} converts a double-precision FP value from the source
7956 operand to a signed doubleword in the destination operand.
7958 The destination operand is a general purpose register. The source can be
7959 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location. If the
7960 source is a register, the input value is in the low quadword.
7962 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7965 \S{insCVTSD2SS} \i\c{CVTSD2SS}:
7966 Scalar Double-Precision FP to Scalar Single-Precision FP Conversion
7968 \c CVTSD2SS xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F 5A /r [KATMAI,SSE]
7970 \c{CVTSD2SS} converts a double-precision FP value from the source
7971 operand to a single-precision FP value in the low doubleword of the
7972 destination operand. The upper 3 doublewords are left unchanged.
7974 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
7975 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location. If the
7976 source is a register, the input value is in the low quadword.
7978 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7981 \S{insCVTSI2SD} \i\c{CVTSI2SD}:
7982 Signed INT32 to Scalar Double-Precision FP Conversion
7984 \c CVTSI2SD xmm,r/m32 ; F2 0F 2A /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
7986 \c{CVTSI2SD} converts a signed doubleword from the source operand to
7987 a double-precision FP value in the low quadword of the destination
7988 operand. The high quadword is left unchanged.
7990 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either
7991 a general purpose register or a 32-bit memory location.
7993 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
7996 \S{insCVTSI2SS} \i\c{CVTSI2SS}:
7997 Signed INT32 to Scalar Single-Precision FP Conversion
7999 \c CVTSI2SS xmm,r/m32 ; F3 0F 2A /r [KATMAI,SSE]
8001 \c{CVTSI2SS} converts a signed doubleword from the source operand to a
8002 single-precision FP value in the low doubleword of the destination operand.
8003 The upper 3 doublewords are left unchanged.
8005 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either
8006 a general purpose register or a 32-bit memory location.
8008 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8011 \S{insCVTSS2SD} \i\c{CVTSS2SD}:
8012 Scalar Single-Precision FP to Scalar Double-Precision FP Conversion
8014 \c CVTSS2SD xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F 5A /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
8016 \c{CVTSS2SD} converts a single-precision FP value from the source operand
8017 to a double-precision FP value in the low quadword of the destination
8018 operand. The upper quadword is left unchanged.
8020 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be either
8021 an \c{XMM} register or a 32-bit memory location. If the source is a
8022 register, the input value is contained in the low doubleword.
8024 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8027 \S{insCVTSS2SI} \i\c{CVTSS2SI}:
8028 Scalar Single-Precision FP to Signed INT32 Conversion
8030 \c CVTSS2SI reg32,xmm/mem32 ; F3 0F 2D /r [KATMAI,SSE]
8032 \c{CVTSS2SI} converts a single-precision FP value from the source
8033 operand to a signed doubleword in the destination operand.
8035 The destination operand is a general purpose register. The source can be
8036 either an \c{XMM} register or a 32-bit memory location. If the
8037 source is a register, the input value is in the low doubleword.
8039 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8042 \S{insCVTTPD2DQ} \i\c{CVTTPD2DQ}:
8043 Packed Double-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation
8045 \c CVTTPD2DQ xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F E6 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
8047 \c{CVTTPD2DQ} converts two packed double-precision FP values in the source
8048 operand to two packed single-precision FP values in the destination operand.
8049 If the result is inexact, it is truncated (rounded toward zero). The high
8050 quadword is set to all 0s.
8052 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
8053 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
8055 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8058 \S{insCVTTPD2PI} \i\c{CVTTPD2PI}:
8059 Packed Double-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation
8061 \c CVTTPD2PI mm,xmm/mem128 ; 66 0F 2C /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
8063 \c{CVTTPD2PI} converts two packed double-precision FP values in the source
8064 operand to two packed single-precision FP values in the destination operand.
8065 If the result is inexact, it is truncated (rounded toward zero).
8067 The destination operand is an \c{MMX} register. The source can be
8068 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
8070 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8073 \S{insCVTTPS2DQ} \i\c{CVTTPS2DQ}:
8074 Packed Single-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation
8076 \c CVTTPS2DQ xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; F3 0F 5B /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
8078 \c{CVTTPS2DQ} converts four packed single-precision FP values in the source
8079 operand to four packed signed doublewords in the destination operand.
8080 If the result is inexact, it is truncated (rounded toward zero).
8082 The destination operand is an \c{XMM} register. The source can be
8083 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
8085 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8088 \S{insCVTTPS2PI} \i\c{CVTTPS2PI}:
8089 Packed Single-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation
8091 \c CVTTPS2PI mm,xmm/mem64 ; 0F 2C /r [KATMAI,SSE]
8093 \c{CVTTPS2PI} converts two packed single-precision FP values in the source
8094 operand to two packed signed doublewords in the destination operand.
8095 If the result is inexact, it is truncated (rounded toward zero). If
8096 the source is a register, the input values are in the low quadword.
8098 The destination operand is an \c{MMX} register. The source can be
8099 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location. If the source
8100 is a register, the input value is in the low quadword.
8102 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8105 \S{insCVTTSD2SI} \i\c{CVTTSD2SI}:
8106 Scalar Double-Precision FP to Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation
8108 \c CVTTSD2SI reg32,xmm/mem64 ; F2 0F 2C /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
8110 \c{CVTTSD2SI} converts a double-precision FP value in the source operand
8111 to a signed doubleword in the destination operand. If the result is
8112 inexact, it is truncated (rounded toward zero).
8114 The destination operand is a general purpose register. The source can be
8115 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location. If the source is a
8116 register, the input value is in the low quadword.
8118 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8121 \S{insCVTTSS2SI} \i\c{CVTTSS2SI}:
8122 Scalar Single-Precision FP to Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation
8124 \c CVTTSD2SI reg32,xmm/mem32 ; F3 0F 2C /r [KATMAI,SSE]
8126 \c{CVTTSS2SI} converts a single-precision FP value in the source operand
8127 to a signed doubleword in the destination operand. If the result is
8128 inexact, it is truncated (rounded toward zero).
8130 The destination operand is a general purpose register. The source can be
8131 either an \c{XMM} register or a 32-bit memory location. If the source is a
8132 register, the input value is in the low doubleword.
8134 For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor manuals.
8137 \S{insDAA} \i\c{DAA}, \i\c{DAS}: Decimal Adjustments
8142 These instructions are used in conjunction with the add and subtract
8143 instructions to perform binary-coded decimal arithmetic in
8144 \e{packed} (one BCD digit per nibble) form. For the unpacked
8145 equivalents, see \k{insAAA}.
8147 \c{DAA} should be used after a one-byte \c{ADD} instruction whose
8148 destination was the \c{AL} register: by means of examining the value
8149 in the \c{AL} and also the auxiliary carry flag \c{AF}, it
8150 determines whether either digit of the addition has overflowed, and
8151 adjusts it (and sets the carry and auxiliary-carry flags) if so. You
8152 can add long BCD strings together by doing \c{ADD}/\c{DAA} on the
8153 low two digits, then doing \c{ADC}/\c{DAA} on each subsequent pair
8156 \c{DAS} works similarly to \c{DAA}, but is for use after \c{SUB}
8157 instructions rather than \c{ADD}.
8160 \S{insDEC} \i\c{DEC}: Decrement Integer
8162 \c DEC reg16 ; o16 48+r [8086]
8163 \c DEC reg32 ; o32 48+r [386]
8164 \c DEC r/m8 ; FE /1 [8086]
8165 \c DEC r/m16 ; o16 FF /1 [8086]
8166 \c DEC r/m32 ; o32 FF /1 [386]
8168 \c{DEC} subtracts 1 from its operand. It does \e{not} affect the
8169 carry flag: to affect the carry flag, use \c{SUB something,1} (see
8170 \k{insSUB}). \c{DEC} affects all the other flags according to the result.
8172 This instruction can be used with a \c{LOCK} prefix to allow atomic
8175 See also \c{INC} (\k{insINC}).
8178 \S{insDIV} \i\c{DIV}: Unsigned Integer Divide
8180 \c DIV r/m8 ; F6 /6 [8086]
8181 \c DIV r/m16 ; o16 F7 /6 [8086]
8182 \c DIV r/m32 ; o32 F7 /6 [386]
8184 \c{DIV} performs unsigned integer division. The explicit operand
8185 provided is the divisor; the dividend and destination operands are
8186 implicit, in the following way:
8188 \b For \c{DIV r/m8}, \c{AX} is divided by the given operand; the
8189 quotient is stored in \c{AL} and the remainder in \c{AH}.
8191 \b For \c{DIV r/m16}, \c{DX:AX} is divided by the given operand; the
8192 quotient is stored in \c{AX} and the remainder in \c{DX}.
8194 \b For \c{DIV r/m32}, \c{EDX:EAX} is divided by the given operand;
8195 the quotient is stored in \c{EAX} and the remainder in \c{EDX}.
8197 Signed integer division is performed by the \c{IDIV} instruction:
8201 \S{insDIVPD} \i\c{DIVPD}: Packed Double-Precision FP Divide
8203 \c DIVPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 5E /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
8205 \c{DIVPD} divides the two packed double-precision FP values in
8206 the destination operand by the two packed double-precision FP
8207 values in the source operand, and stores the packed double-precision
8208 results in the destination register.
8210 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
8211 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
8213 \c dst[0-63] := dst[0-63] / src[0-63],
8214 \c dst[64-127] := dst[64-127] / src[64-127].
8217 \S{insDIVPS} \i\c{DIVPS}: Packed Single-Precision FP Divide
8219 \c DIVPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F 5E /r [KATMAI,SSE]
8221 \c{DIVPS} divides the four packed single-precision FP values in
8222 the destination operand by the four packed single-precision FP
8223 values in the source operand, and stores the packed single-precision
8224 results in the destination register.
8226 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
8227 either an \c{XMM} register or a 128-bit memory location.
8229 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] / src[0-31],
8230 \c dst[32-63] := dst[32-63] / src[32-63],
8231 \c dst[64-95] := dst[64-95] / src[64-95],
8232 \c dst[96-127] := dst[96-127] / src[96-127].
8235 \S{insDIVSD} \i\c{DIVSD}: Scalar Double-Precision FP Divide
8237 \c DIVSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64 ; F2 0F 5E /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
8239 \c{DIVSD} divides the low-order double-precision FP value in the
8240 destination operand by the low-order double-precision FP value in
8241 the source operand, and stores the double-precision result in the
8242 destination register.
8244 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
8245 either an \c{XMM} register or a 64-bit memory location.
8247 \c dst[0-63] := dst[0-63] / src[0-63],
8248 \c dst[64-127] remains unchanged.
8251 \S{insDIVSS} \i\c{DIVSS}: Scalar Single-Precision FP Divide
8253 \c DIVSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F 5E /r [KATMAI,SSE]
8255 \c{DIVSS} divides the low-order single-precision FP value in the
8256 destination operand by the low-order single-precision FP value in
8257 the source operand, and stores the single-precision result in the
8258 destination register.
8260 The destination is an \c{XMM} register. The source operand can be
8261 either an \c{XMM} register or a 32-bit memory location.
8263 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] / src[0-31],
8264 \c dst[32-127] remains unchanged.
8267 \S{insEMMS} \i\c{EMMS}: Empty MMX State
8269 \c EMMS ; 0F 77 [PENT,MMX]
8271 \c{EMMS} sets the FPU tag word (marking which floating-point registers
8272 are available) to all ones, meaning all registers are available for
8273 the FPU to use. It should be used after executing \c{MMX} instructions
8274 and before executing any subsequent floating-point operations.
8277 \S{insENTER} \i\c{ENTER}: Create Stack Frame
8279 \c ENTER imm,imm ; C8 iw ib [186]
8281 \c{ENTER} constructs a \i\c{stack frame} for a high-level language
8282 procedure call. The first operand (the \c{iw} in the opcode
8283 definition above refers to the first operand) gives the amount of
8284 stack space to allocate for local variables; the second (the \c{ib}
8285 above) gives the nesting level of the procedure (for languages like
8286 Pascal, with nested procedures).
8288 The function of \c{ENTER}, with a nesting level of zero, is
8291 \c PUSH EBP ; or PUSH BP in 16 bits
8292 \c MOV EBP,ESP ; or MOV BP,SP in 16 bits
8293 \c SUB ESP,operand1 ; or SUB SP,operand1 in 16 bits
8295 This creates a stack frame with the procedure parameters accessible
8296 upwards from \c{EBP}, and local variables accessible downwards from
8299 With a nesting level of one, the stack frame created is 4 (or 2)
8300 bytes bigger, and the value of the final frame pointer \c{EBP} is
8301 accessible in memory at \c{[EBP-4]}.
8303 This allows \c{ENTER}, when called with a nesting level of two, to
8304 look at the stack frame described by the \e{previous} value of
8305 \c{EBP}, find the frame pointer at offset -4 from that, and push it
8306 along with its new frame pointer, so that when a level-two procedure
8307 is called from within a level-one procedure, \c{[EBP-4]} holds the
8308 frame pointer of the most recent level-one procedure call and
8309 \c{[EBP-8]} holds that of the most recent level-two call. And so on,
8310 for nesting levels up to 31.
8312 Stack frames created by \c{ENTER} can be destroyed by the \c{LEAVE}
8313 instruction: see \k{insLEAVE}.
8316 \S{insF2XM1} \i\c{F2XM1}: Calculate 2**X-1
8318 \c F2XM1 ; D9 F0 [8086,FPU]
8320 \c{F2XM1} raises 2 to the power of \c{ST0}, subtracts one, and
8321 stores the result back into \c{ST0}. The initial contents of \c{ST0}
8322 must be a number in the range -1.0 to +1.0.
8325 \S{insFABS} \i\c{FABS}: Floating-Point Absolute Value
8327 \c FABS ; D9 E1 [8086,FPU]
8329 \c{FABS} computes the absolute value of \c{ST0},by clearing the sign
8330 bit, and stores the result back in \c{ST0}.
8333 \S{insFADD} \i\c{FADD}, \i\c{FADDP}: Floating-Point Addition
8335 \c FADD mem32 ; D8 /0 [8086,FPU]
8336 \c FADD mem64 ; DC /0 [8086,FPU]
8338 \c FADD fpureg ; D8 C0+r [8086,FPU]
8339 \c FADD ST0,fpureg ; D8 C0+r [8086,FPU]
8341 \c FADD TO fpureg ; DC C0+r [8086,FPU]
8342 \c FADD fpureg,ST0 ; DC C0+r [8086,FPU]
8344 \c FADDP fpureg ; DE C0+r [8086,FPU]
8345 \c FADDP fpureg,ST0 ; DE C0+r [8086,FPU]
8347 \b \c{FADD}, given one operand, adds the operand to \c{ST0} and stores
8348 the result back in \c{ST0}. If the operand has the \c{TO} modifier,
8349 the result is stored in the register given rather than in \c{ST0}.
8351 \b \c{FADDP} performs the same function as \c{FADD TO}, but pops the
8352 register stack after storing the result.
8354 The given two-operand forms are synonyms for the one-operand forms.
8356 To add an integer value to \c{ST0}, use the c{FIADD} instruction
8360 \S{insFBLD} \i\c{FBLD}, \i\c{FBSTP}: BCD Floating-Point Load and Store
8362 \c FBLD mem80 ; DF /4 [8086,FPU]
8363 \c FBSTP mem80 ; DF /6 [8086,FPU]
8365 \c{FBLD} loads an 80-bit (ten-byte) packed binary-coded decimal
8366 number from the given memory address, converts it to a real, and
8367 pushes it on the register stack. \c{FBSTP} stores the value of
8368 \c{ST0}, in packed BCD, at the given address and then pops the
8372 \S{insFCHS} \i\c{FCHS}: Floating-Point Change Sign
8374 \c FCHS ; D9 E0 [8086,FPU]
8376 \c{FCHS} negates the number in \c{ST0}, by inverting the sign bit:
8377 negative numbers become positive, and vice versa.
8380 \S{insFCLEX} \i\c{FCLEX}, \c{FNCLEX}: Clear Floating-Point Exceptions
8382 \c FCLEX ; 9B DB E2 [8086,FPU]
8383 \c FNCLEX ; DB E2 [8086,FPU]
8385 \c{FCLEX} clears any floating-point exceptions which may be pending.
8386 \c{FNCLEX} does the same thing but doesn't wait for previous
8387 floating-point operations (including the \e{handling} of pending
8388 exceptions) to finish first.
8391 \S{insFCMOVB} \i\c{FCMOVcc}: Floating-Point Conditional Move
8393 \c FCMOVB fpureg ; DA C0+r [P6,FPU]
8394 \c FCMOVB ST0,fpureg ; DA C0+r [P6,FPU]
8396 \c FCMOVE fpureg ; DA C8+r [P6,FPU]
8397 \c FCMOVE ST0,fpureg ; DA C8+r [P6,FPU]
8399 \c FCMOVBE fpureg ; DA D0+r [P6,FPU]
8400 \c FCMOVBE ST0,fpureg ; DA D0+r [P6,FPU]
8402 \c FCMOVU fpureg ; DA D8+r [P6,FPU]
8403 \c FCMOVU ST0,fpureg ; DA D8+r [P6,FPU]
8405 \c FCMOVNB fpureg ; DB C0+r [P6,FPU]
8406 \c FCMOVNB ST0,fpureg ; DB C0+r [P6,FPU]
8408 \c FCMOVNE fpureg ; DB C8+r [P6,FPU]
8409 \c FCMOVNE ST0,fpureg ; DB C8+r [P6,FPU]
8411 \c FCMOVNBE fpureg ; DB D0+r [P6,FPU]
8412 \c FCMOVNBE ST0,fpureg ; DB D0+r [P6,FPU]
8414 \c FCMOVNU fpureg ; DB D8+r [P6,FPU]
8415 \c FCMOVNU ST0,fpureg ; DB D8+r [P6,FPU]
8417 The \c{FCMOV} instructions perform conditional move operations: each
8418 of them moves the contents of the given register into \c{ST0} if its
8419 condition is satisfied, and does nothing if not.
8421 The conditions are not the same as the standard condition codes used
8422 with conditional jump instructions. The conditions \c{B}, \c{BE},
8423 \c{NB}, \c{NBE}, \c{E} and \c{NE} are exactly as normal, but none of
8424 the other standard ones are supported. Instead, the condition \c{U}
8425 and its counterpart \c{NU} are provided; the \c{U} condition is
8426 satisfied if the last two floating-point numbers compared were
8427 \e{unordered}, i.e. they were not equal but neither one could be
8428 said to be greater than the other, for example if they were NaNs.
8429 (The flag state which signals this is the setting of the parity
8430 flag: so the \c{U} condition is notionally equivalent to \c{PE}, and
8431 \c{NU} is equivalent to \c{PO}.)
8433 The \c{FCMOV} conditions test the main processor's status flags, not
8434 the FPU status flags, so using \c{FCMOV} directly after \c{FCOM}
8435 will not work. Instead, you should either use \c{FCOMI} which writes
8436 directly to the main CPU flags word, or use \c{FSTSW} to extract the
8439 Although the \c{FCMOV} instructions are flagged \c{P6} above, they
8440 may not be supported by all Pentium Pro processors; the \c{CPUID}
8441 instruction (\k{insCPUID}) will return a bit which indicates whether
8442 conditional moves are supported.
8445 \S{insFCOM} \i\c{FCOM}, \i\c{FCOMP}, \i\c{FCOMPP}, \i\c{FCOMI},
8446 \i\c{FCOMIP}: Floating-Point Compare
8448 \c FCOM mem32 ; D8 /2 [8086,FPU]
8449 \c FCOM mem64 ; DC /2 [8086,FPU]
8450 \c FCOM fpureg ; D8 D0+r [8086,FPU]
8451 \c FCOM ST0,fpureg ; D8 D0+r [8086,FPU]
8453 \c FCOMP mem32 ; D8 /3 [8086,FPU]
8454 \c FCOMP mem64 ; DC /3 [8086,FPU]
8455 \c FCOMP fpureg ; D8 D8+r [8086,FPU]
8456 \c FCOMP ST0,fpureg ; D8 D8+r [8086,FPU]
8458 \c FCOMPP ; DE D9 [8086,FPU]
8460 \c FCOMI fpureg ; DB F0+r [P6,FPU]
8461 \c FCOMI ST0,fpureg ; DB F0+r [P6,FPU]
8463 \c FCOMIP fpureg ; DF F0+r [P6,FPU]
8464 \c FCOMIP ST0,fpureg ; DF F0+r [P6,FPU]
8466 \c{FCOM} compares \c{ST0} with the given operand, and sets the FPU
8467 flags accordingly. \c{ST0} is treated as the left-hand side of the
8468 comparison, so that the carry flag is set (for a `less-than' result)
8469 if \c{ST0} is less than the given operand.
8471 \c{FCOMP} does the same as \c{FCOM}, but pops the register stack
8472 afterwards. \c{FCOMPP} compares \c{ST0} with \c{ST1} and then pops
8473 the register stack twice.
8475 \c{FCOMI} and \c{FCOMIP} work like the corresponding forms of
8476 \c{FCOM} and \c{FCOMP}, but write their results directly to the CPU
8477 flags register rather than the FPU status word, so they can be
8478 immediately followed by conditional jump or conditional move
8481 The \c{FCOM} instructions differ from the \c{FUCOM} instructions
8482 (\k{insFUCOM}) only in the way they handle quiet NaNs: \c{FUCOM}
8483 will handle them silently and set the condition code flags to an
8484 `unordered' result, whereas \c{FCOM} will generate an exception.
8487 \S{insFCOS} \i\c{FCOS}: Cosine
8489 \c FCOS ; D9 FF [386,FPU]
8491 \c{FCOS} computes the cosine of \c{ST0} (in radians), and stores the
8492 result in \c{ST0}. The absolute value of \c{ST0} must be less than 2**63.
8494 See also \c{FSINCOS} (\k{insFSIN}).
8497 \S{insFDECSTP} \i\c{FDECSTP}: Decrement Floating-Point Stack Pointer
8499 \c FDECSTP ; D9 F6 [8086,FPU]
8501 \c{FDECSTP} decrements the `top' field in the floating-point status
8502 word. This has the effect of rotating the FPU register stack by one,
8503 as if the contents of \c{ST7} had been pushed on the stack. See also
8504 \c{FINCSTP} (\k{insFINCSTP}).
8507 \S{insFDISI} \i\c{FxDISI}, \i\c{FxENI}: Disable and Enable Floating-Point Interrupts
8509 \c FDISI ; 9B DB E1 [8086,FPU]
8510 \c FNDISI ; DB E1 [8086,FPU]
8512 \c FENI ; 9B DB E0 [8086,FPU]
8513 \c FNENI ; DB E0 [8086,FPU]
8515 \c{FDISI} and \c{FENI} disable and enable floating-point interrupts.
8516 These instructions are only meaningful on original 8087 processors:
8517 the 287 and above treat them as no-operation instructions.
8519 \c{FNDISI} and \c{FNENI} do the same thing as \c{FDISI} and \c{FENI}
8520 respectively, but without waiting for the floating-point processor
8521 to finish what it was doing first.
8524 \S{insFDIV} \i\c{FDIV}, \i\c{FDIVP}, \i\c{FDIVR}, \i\c{FDIVRP}: Floating-Point Division
8526 \c FDIV mem32 ; D8 /6 [8086,FPU]
8527 \c FDIV mem64 ; DC /6 [8086,FPU]
8529 \c FDIV fpureg ; D8 F0+r [8086,FPU]
8530 \c FDIV ST0,fpureg ; D8 F0+r [8086,FPU]
8532 \c FDIV TO fpureg ; DC F8+r [8086,FPU]
8533 \c FDIV fpureg,ST0 ; DC F8+r [8086,FPU]
8535 \c FDIVR mem32 ; D8 /0 [8086,FPU]
8536 \c FDIVR mem64 ; DC /0 [8086,FPU]
8538 \c FDIVR fpureg ; D8 F8+r [8086,FPU]
8539 \c FDIVR ST0,fpureg ; D8 F8+r [8086,FPU]
8541 \c FDIVR TO fpureg ; DC F0+r [8086,FPU]
8542 \c FDIVR fpureg,ST0 ; DC F0+r [8086,FPU]
8544 \c FDIVP fpureg ; DE F8+r [8086,FPU]
8545 \c FDIVP fpureg,ST0 ; DE F8+r [8086,FPU]
8547 \c FDIVRP fpureg ; DE F0+r [8086,FPU]
8548 \c FDIVRP fpureg,ST0 ; DE F0+r [8086,FPU]
8550 \b \c{FDIV} divides \c{ST0} by the given operand and stores the result
8551 back in \c{ST0}, unless the \c{TO} qualifier is given, in which case
8552 it divides the given operand by \c{ST0} and stores the result in the
8555 \b \c{FDIVR} does the same thing, but does the division the other way
8556 up: so if \c{TO} is not given, it divides the given operand by
8557 \c{ST0} and stores the result in \c{ST0}, whereas if \c{TO} is given
8558 it divides \c{ST0} by its operand and stores the result in the
8561 \b \c{FDIVP} operates like \c{FDIV TO}, but pops the register stack
8562 once it has finished.
8564 \b \c{FDIVRP} operates like \c{FDIVR TO}, but pops the register stack
8565 once it has finished.
8567 For FP/Integer divisions, see \c{FIDIV} (\k{insFIDIV}).
8570 \S{insFEMMS} \i\c{FEMMS}: Faster Enter/Exit of the MMX or floating-point state
8572 \c FEMMS ; 0F 0E [PENT,3DNOW]
8574 \c{FEMMS} can be used in place of the \c{EMMS} instruction on
8575 processors which support the 3DNow! instruction set. Following
8576 execution of \c{FEMMS}, the state of the \c{MMX/FP} registers
8577 is undefined, and this allows a faster context switch between
8578 \c{FP} and \c{MMX} instructions. The \c{FEMMS} instruction can
8579 also be used \e{before} executing \c{MMX} instructions
8582 \S{insFFREE} \i\c{FFREE}: Flag Floating-Point Register as Unused
8584 \c FFREE fpureg ; DD C0+r [8086,FPU]
8585 \c FFREEP fpureg ; DF C0+r [286,FPU,UNDOC]
8587 \c{FFREE} marks the given register as being empty.
8589 \c{FFREEP} marks the given register as being empty, and then
8590 pops the register stack.
8593 \S{insFIADD} \i\c{FIADD}: Floating-Point/Integer Addition
8595 \c FIADD mem16 ; DE /0 [8086,FPU]
8596 \c FIADD mem32 ; DA /0 [8086,FPU]
8598 \c{FIADD} adds the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored in the given
8599 memory location to \c{ST0}, storing the result in \c{ST0}.
8602 \S{insFICOM} \i\c{FICOM}, \i\c{FICOMP}: Floating-Point/Integer Compare
8604 \c FICOM mem16 ; DE /2 [8086,FPU]
8605 \c FICOM mem32 ; DA /2 [8086,FPU]
8607 \c FICOMP mem16 ; DE /3 [8086,FPU]
8608 \c FICOMP mem32 ; DA /3 [8086,FPU]
8610 \c{FICOM} compares \c{ST0} with the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored
8611 in the given memory location, and sets the FPU flags accordingly.
8612 \c{FICOMP} does the same, but pops the register stack afterwards.
8615 \S{insFIDIV} \i\c{FIDIV}, \i\c{FIDIVR}: Floating-Point/Integer Division
8617 \c FIDIV mem16 ; DE /6 [8086,FPU]
8618 \c FIDIV mem32 ; DA /6 [8086,FPU]
8620 \c FIDIVR mem16 ; DE /7 [8086,FPU]
8621 \c FIDIVR mem32 ; DA /7 [8086,FPU]
8623 \c{FIDIV} divides \c{ST0} by the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored in
8624 the given memory location, and stores the result in \c{ST0}.
8625 \c{FIDIVR} does the division the other way up: it divides the
8626 integer by \c{ST0}, but still stores the result in \c{ST0}.
8629 \S{insFILD} \i\c{FILD}, \i\c{FIST}, \i\c{FISTP}: Floating-Point/Integer Conversion
8631 \c FILD mem16 ; DF /0 [8086,FPU]
8632 \c FILD mem32 ; DB /0 [8086,FPU]
8633 \c FILD mem64 ; DF /5 [8086,FPU]
8635 \c FIST mem16 ; DF /2 [8086,FPU]
8636 \c FIST mem32 ; DB /2 [8086,FPU]
8638 \c FISTP mem16 ; DF /3 [8086,FPU]
8639 \c FISTP mem32 ; DB /3 [8086,FPU]
8640 \c FISTP mem64 ; DF /7 [8086,FPU]
8642 \c{FILD} loads an integer out of a memory location, converts it to a
8643 real, and pushes it on the FPU register stack. \c{FIST} converts
8644 \c{ST0} to an integer and stores that in memory; \c{FISTP} does the
8645 same as \c{FIST}, but pops the register stack afterwards.
8648 \S{insFIMUL} \i\c{FIMUL}: Floating-Point/Integer Multiplication
8650 \c FIMUL mem16 ; DE /1 [8086,FPU]
8651 \c FIMUL mem32 ; DA /1 [8086,FPU]
8653 \c{FIMUL} multiplies \c{ST0} by the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored
8654 in the given memory location, and stores the result in \c{ST0}.
8657 \S{insFINCSTP} \i\c{FINCSTP}: Increment Floating-Point Stack Pointer
8659 \c FINCSTP ; D9 F7 [8086,FPU]
8661 \c{FINCSTP} increments the `top' field in the floating-point status
8662 word. This has the effect of rotating the FPU register stack by one,
8663 as if the register stack had been popped; however, unlike the
8664 popping of the stack performed by many FPU instructions, it does not
8665 flag the new \c{ST7} (previously \c{ST0}) as empty. See also
8666 \c{FDECSTP} (\k{insFDECSTP}).
8669 \S{insFINIT} \i\c{FINIT}, \i\c{FNINIT}: Initialise Floating-Point Unit
8671 \c FINIT ; 9B DB E3 [8086,FPU]
8672 \c FNINIT ; DB E3 [8086,FPU]
8674 \c{FINIT} initialises the FPU to its default state. It flags all
8675 registers as empty, without actually change their values, clears
8676 the top of stack pointer. \c{FNINIT} does the same, without first
8677 waiting for pending exceptions to clear.
8680 \S{insFISUB} \i\c{FISUB}: Floating-Point/Integer Subtraction
8682 \c FISUB mem16 ; DE /4 [8086,FPU]
8683 \c FISUB mem32 ; DA /4 [8086,FPU]
8685 \c FISUBR mem16 ; DE /5 [8086,FPU]
8686 \c FISUBR mem32 ; DA /5 [8086,FPU]
8688 \c{FISUB} subtracts the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored in the given
8689 memory location from \c{ST0}, and stores the result in \c{ST0}.
8690 \c{FISUBR} does the subtraction the other way round, i.e. it
8691 subtracts \c{ST0} from the given integer, but still stores the
8695 \S{insFLD} \i\c{FLD}: Floating-Point Load
8697 \c FLD mem32 ; D9 /0 [8086,FPU]
8698 \c FLD mem64 ; DD /0 [8086,FPU]
8699 \c FLD mem80 ; DB /5 [8086,FPU]
8700 \c FLD fpureg ; D9 C0+r [8086,FPU]
8702 \c{FLD} loads a floating-point value out of the given register or
8703 memory location, and pushes it on the FPU register stack.
8706 \S{insFLD1} \i\c{FLDxx}: Floating-Point Load Constants
8708 \c FLD1 ; D9 E8 [8086,FPU]
8709 \c FLDL2E ; D9 EA [8086,FPU]
8710 \c FLDL2T ; D9 E9 [8086,FPU]
8711 \c FLDLG2 ; D9 EC [8086,FPU]
8712 \c FLDLN2 ; D9 ED [8086,FPU]
8713 \c FLDPI ; D9 EB [8086,FPU]
8714 \c FLDZ ; D9 EE [8086,FPU]
8716 These instructions push specific standard constants on the FPU
8719 \c Instruction Constant pushed
8722 \c FLDL2E base-2 logarithm of e
8723 \c FLDL2T base-2 log of 10
8724 \c FLDLG2 base-10 log of 2
8725 \c FLDLN2 base-e log of 2
8730 \S{insFLDCW} \i\c{FLDCW}: Load Floating-Point Control Word
8732 \c FLDCW mem16 ; D9 /5 [8086,FPU]
8734 \c{FLDCW} loads a 16-bit value out of memory and stores it into the
8735 FPU control word (governing things like the rounding mode, the
8736 precision, and the exception masks). See also \c{FSTCW}
8737 (\k{insFSTCW}). If exceptions are enabled and you don't want to
8738 generate one, use \c{FCLEX} or \c{FNCLEX} (\k{insFCLEX}) before
8739 loading the new control word.
8742 \S{insFLDENV} \i\c{FLDENV}: Load Floating-Point Environment
8744 \c FLDENV mem ; D9 /4 [8086,FPU]
8746 \c{FLDENV} loads the FPU operating environment (control word, status
8747 word, tag word, instruction pointer, data pointer and last opcode)
8748 from memory. The memory area is 14 or 28 bytes long, depending on
8749 the CPU mode at the time. See also \c{FSTENV} (\k{insFSTENV}).
8752 \S{insFMUL} \i\c{FMUL}, \i\c{FMULP}: Floating-Point Multiply
8754 \c FMUL mem32 ; D8 /1 [8086,FPU]
8755 \c FMUL mem64 ; DC /1 [8086,FPU]
8757 \c FMUL fpureg ; D8 C8+r [8086,FPU]
8758 \c FMUL ST0,fpureg ; D8 C8+r [8086,FPU]
8760 \c FMUL TO fpureg ; DC C8+r [8086,FPU]
8761 \c FMUL fpureg,ST0 ; DC C8+r [8086,FPU]
8763 \c FMULP fpureg ; DE C8+r [8086,FPU]
8764 \c FMULP fpureg,ST0 ; DE C8+r [8086,FPU]
8766 \c{FMUL} multiplies \c{ST0} by the given operand, and stores the
8767 result in \c{ST0}, unless the \c{TO} qualifier is used in which case
8768 it stores the result in the operand. \c{FMULP} performs the same
8769 operation as \c{FMUL TO}, and then pops the register stack.
8772 \S{insFNOP} \i\c{FNOP}: Floating-Point No Operation
8774 \c FNOP ; D9 D0 [8086,FPU]
8776 \c{FNOP} does nothing.
8779 \S{insFPATAN} \i\c{FPATAN}, \i\c{FPTAN}: Arctangent and Tangent
8781 \c FPATAN ; D9 F3 [8086,FPU]
8782 \c FPTAN ; D9 F2 [8086,FPU]
8784 \c{FPATAN} computes the arctangent, in radians, of the result of
8785 dividing \c{ST1} by \c{ST0}, stores the result in \c{ST1}, and pops
8786 the register stack. It works like the C \c{atan2} function, in that
8787 changing the sign of both \c{ST0} and \c{ST1} changes the output
8788 value by pi (so it performs true rectangular-to-polar coordinate
8789 conversion, with \c{ST1} being the Y coordinate and \c{ST0} being
8790 the X coordinate, not merely an arctangent).
8792 \c{FPTAN} computes the tangent of the value in \c{ST0} (in radians),
8793 and stores the result back into \c{ST0}.
8795 The absolute value of \c{ST0} must be less than 2**63.
8798 \S{insFPREM} \i\c{FPREM}, \i\c{FPREM1}: Floating-Point Partial Remainder
8800 \c FPREM ; D9 F8 [8086,FPU]
8801 \c FPREM1 ; D9 F5 [386,FPU]
8803 These instructions both produce the remainder obtained by dividing
8804 \c{ST0} by \c{ST1}. This is calculated, notionally, by dividing
8805 \c{ST0} by \c{ST1}, rounding the result to an integer, multiplying
8806 by \c{ST1} again, and computing the value which would need to be
8807 added back on to the result to get back to the original value in
8810 The two instructions differ in the way the notional round-to-integer
8811 operation is performed. \c{FPREM} does it by rounding towards zero,
8812 so that the remainder it returns always has the same sign as the
8813 original value in \c{ST0}; \c{FPREM1} does it by rounding to the
8814 nearest integer, so that the remainder always has at most half the
8815 magnitude of \c{ST1}.
8817 Both instructions calculate \e{partial} remainders, meaning that
8818 they may not manage to provide the final result, but might leave
8819 intermediate results in \c{ST0} instead. If this happens, they will
8820 set the C2 flag in the FPU status word; therefore, to calculate a
8821 remainder, you should repeatedly execute \c{FPREM} or \c{FPREM1}
8822 until C2 becomes clear.
8825 \S{insFRNDINT} \i\c{FRNDINT}: Floating-Point Round to Integer
8827 \c FRNDINT ; D9 FC [8086,FPU]
8829 \c{FRNDINT} rounds the contents of \c{ST0} to an integer, according
8830 to the current rounding mode set in the FPU control word, and stores
8831 the result back in \c{ST0}.
8834 \S{insFRSTOR} \i\c{FSAVE}, \i\c{FRSTOR}: Save/Restore Floating-Point State
8836 \c FSAVE mem ; 9B DD /6 [8086,FPU]
8837 \c FNSAVE mem ; DD /6 [8086,FPU]
8839 \c FRSTOR mem ; DD /4 [8086,FPU]
8841 \c{FSAVE} saves the entire floating-point unit state, including all
8842 the information saved by \c{FSTENV} (\k{insFSTENV}) plus the
8843 contents of all the registers, to a 94 or 108 byte area of memory
8844 (depending on the CPU mode). \c{FRSTOR} restores the floating-point
8845 state from the same area of memory.
8847 \c{FNSAVE} does the same as \c{FSAVE}, without first waiting for
8848 pending floating-point exceptions to clear.
8851 \S{insFSCALE} \i\c{FSCALE}: Scale Floating-Point Value by Power of Two
8853 \c FSCALE ; D9 FD [8086,FPU]
8855 \c{FSCALE} scales a number by a power of two: it rounds \c{ST1}
8856 towards zero to obtain an integer, then multiplies \c{ST0} by two to
8857 the power of that integer, and stores the result in \c{ST0}.
8860 \S{insFSETPM} \i\c{FSETPM}: Set Protected Mode
8862 \c FSETPM ; DB E4 [286,FPU]
8864 This instruction initialises protected mode on the 287 floating-point
8865 coprocessor. It is only meaningful on that processor: the 387 and
8866 above treat the instruction as a no-operation.
8869 \S{insFSIN} \i\c{FSIN}, \i\c{FSINCOS}: Sine and Cosine
8871 \c FSIN ; D9 FE [386,FPU]
8872 \c FSINCOS ; D9 FB [386,FPU]
8874 \c{FSIN} calculates the sine of \c{ST0} (in radians) and stores the
8875 result in \c{ST0}. \c{FSINCOS} does the same, but then pushes the
8876 cosine of the same value on the register stack, so that the sine
8877 ends up in \c{ST1} and the cosine in \c{ST0}. \c{FSINCOS} is faster
8878 than executing \c{FSIN} and \c{FCOS} (see \k{insFCOS}) in succession.
8880 The absolute value of \c{ST0} must be less than 2**63.
8883 \S{insFSQRT} \i\c{FSQRT}: Floating-Point Square Root
8885 \c FSQRT ; D9 FA [8086,FPU]
8887 \c{FSQRT} calculates the square root of \c{ST0} and stores the
8891 \S{insFST} \i\c{FST}, \i\c{FSTP}: Floating-Point Store
8893 \c FST mem32 ; D9 /2 [8086,FPU]
8894 \c FST mem64 ; DD /2 [8086,FPU]
8895 \c FST fpureg ; DD D0+r [8086,FPU]
8897 \c FSTP mem32 ; D9 /3 [8086,FPU]
8898 \c FSTP mem64 ; DD /3 [8086,FPU]
8899 \c FSTP mem80 ; DB /7 [8086,FPU]
8900 \c FSTP fpureg ; DD D8+r [8086,FPU]
8902 \c{FST} stores the value in \c{ST0} into the given memory location
8903 or other FPU register. \c{FSTP} does the same, but then pops the
8907 \S{insFSTCW} \i\c{FSTCW}: Store Floating-Point Control Word
8909 \c FSTCW mem16 ; 9B D9 /7 [8086,FPU]
8910 \c FNSTCW mem16 ; D9 /7 [8086,FPU]
8912 \c{FSTCW} stores the \c{FPU} control word (governing things like the
8913 rounding mode, the precision, and the exception masks) into a 2-byte
8914 memory area. See also \c{FLDCW} (\k{insFLDCW}).
8916 \c{FNSTCW} does the same thing as \c{FSTCW}, without first waiting
8917 for pending floating-point exceptions to clear.
8920 \S{insFSTENV} \i\c{FSTENV}: Store Floating-Point Environment
8922 \c FSTENV mem ; 9B D9 /6 [8086,FPU]
8923 \c FNSTENV mem ; D9 /6 [8086,FPU]
8925 \c{FSTENV} stores the \c{FPU} operating environment (control word,
8926 status word, tag word, instruction pointer, data pointer and last
8927 opcode) into memory. The memory area is 14 or 28 bytes long,
8928 depending on the CPU mode at the time. See also \c{FLDENV}
8931 \c{FNSTENV} does the same thing as \c{FSTENV}, without first waiting
8932 for pending floating-point exceptions to clear.
8935 \S{insFSTSW} \i\c{FSTSW}: Store Floating-Point Status Word
8937 \c FSTSW mem16 ; 9B DD /7 [8086,FPU]
8938 \c FSTSW AX ; 9B DF E0 [286,FPU]
8940 \c FNSTSW mem16 ; DD /7 [8086,FPU]
8941 \c FNSTSW AX ; DF E0 [286,FPU]
8943 \c{FSTSW} stores the \c{FPU} status word into \c{AX} or into a 2-byte
8946 \c{FNSTSW} does the same thing as \c{FSTSW}, without first waiting
8947 for pending floating-point exceptions to clear.
8950 \S{insFSUB} \i\c{FSUB}, \i\c{FSUBP}, \i\c{FSUBR}, \i\c{FSUBRP}: Floating-Point Subtract
8952 \c FSUB mem32 ; D8 /4 [8086,FPU]
8953 \c FSUB mem64 ; DC /4 [8086,FPU]
8955 \c FSUB fpureg ; D8 E0+r [8086,FPU]
8956 \c FSUB ST0,fpureg ; D8 E0+r [8086,FPU]
8958 \c FSUB TO fpureg ; DC E8+r [8086,FPU]
8959 \c FSUB fpureg,ST0 ; DC E8+r [8086,FPU]
8961 \c FSUBR mem32 ; D8 /5 [8086,FPU]
8962 \c FSUBR mem64 ; DC /5 [8086,FPU]
8964 \c FSUBR fpureg ; D8 E8+r [8086,FPU]
8965 \c FSUBR ST0,fpureg ; D8 E8+r [8086,FPU]
8967 \c FSUBR TO fpureg ; DC E0+r [8086,FPU]
8968 \c FSUBR fpureg,ST0 ; DC E0+r [8086,FPU]
8970 \c FSUBP fpureg ; DE E8+r [8086,FPU]
8971 \c FSUBP fpureg,ST0 ; DE E8+r [8086,FPU]
8973 \c FSUBRP fpureg ; DE E0+r [8086,FPU]
8974 \c FSUBRP fpureg,ST0 ; DE E0+r [8086,FPU]
8976 \b \c{FSUB} subtracts the given operand from \c{ST0} and stores the
8977 result back in \c{ST0}, unless the \c{TO} qualifier is given, in
8978 which case it subtracts \c{ST0} from the given operand and stores
8979 the result in the operand.
8981 \b \c{FSUBR} does the same thing, but does the subtraction the other
8982 way up: so if \c{TO} is not given, it subtracts \c{ST0} from the given
8983 operand and stores the result in \c{ST0}, whereas if \c{TO} is given
8984 it subtracts its operand from \c{ST0} and stores the result in the
8987 \b \c{FSUBP} operates like \c{FSUB TO}, but pops the register stack
8988 once it has finished.
8990 \b \c{FSUBRP} operates like \c{FSUBR TO}, but pops the register stack
8991 once it has finished.
8994 \S{insFTST} \i\c{FTST}: Test \c{ST0} Against Zero
8996 \c FTST ; D9 E4 [8086,FPU]
8998 \c{FTST} compares \c{ST0} with zero and sets the FPU flags
8999 accordingly. \c{ST0} is treated as the left-hand side of the
9000 comparison, so that a `less-than' result is generated if \c{ST0} is
9004 \S{insFUCOM} \i\c{FUCOMxx}: Floating-Point Unordered Compare
9006 \c FUCOM fpureg ; DD E0+r [386,FPU]
9007 \c FUCOM ST0,fpureg ; DD E0+r [386,FPU]
9009 \c FUCOMP fpureg ; DD E8+r [386,FPU]
9010 \c FUCOMP ST0,fpureg ; DD E8+r [386,FPU]
9012 \c FUCOMPP ; DA E9 [386,FPU]
9014 \c FUCOMI fpureg ; DB E8+r [P6,FPU]
9015 \c FUCOMI ST0,fpureg ; DB E8+r [P6,FPU]
9017 \c FUCOMIP fpureg ; DF E8+r [P6,FPU]
9018 \c FUCOMIP ST0,fpureg ; DF E8+r [P6,FPU]
9020 \b \c{FUCOM} compares \c{ST0} with the given operand, and sets the
9021 FPU flags accordingly. \c{ST0} is treated as the left-hand side of
9022 the comparison, so that the carry flag is set (for a `less-than'
9023 result) if \c{ST0} is less than the given operand.
9025 \b \c{FUCOMP} does the same as \c{FUCOM}, but pops the register stack
9026 afterwards. \c{FUCOMPP} compares \c{ST0} with \c{ST1} and then pops
9027 the register stack twice.
9029 \b \c{FUCOMI} and \c{FUCOMIP} work like the corresponding forms of
9030 \c{FUCOM} and \c{FUCOMP}, but write their results directly to the CPU
9031 flags register rather than the FPU status word, so they can be
9032 immediately followed by conditional jump or conditional move
9035 The \c{FUCOM} instructions differ from the \c{FCOM} instructions
9036 (\k{insFCOM}) only in the way they handle quiet NaNs: \c{FUCOM} will
9037 handle them silently and set the condition code flags to an
9038 `unordered' result, whereas \c{FCOM} will generate an exception.
9041 \S{insFXAM} \i\c{FXAM}: Examine Class of Value in \c{ST0}
9043 \c FXAM ; D9 E5 [8086,FPU]
9045 \c{FXAM} sets the FPU flags \c{C3}, \c{C2} and \c{C0} depending on
9046 the type of value stored in \c{ST0}:
9048 \c Register contents Flags
9050 \c Unsupported format 000
9052 \c Finite number 010
9055 \c Empty register 101
9058 Additionally, the \c{C1} flag is set to the sign of the number.
9061 \S{insFXCH} \i\c{FXCH}: Floating-Point Exchange
9063 \c FXCH ; D9 C9 [8086,FPU]
9064 \c FXCH fpureg ; D9 C8+r [8086,FPU]
9065 \c FXCH fpureg,ST0 ; D9 C8+r [8086,FPU]
9066 \c FXCH ST0,fpureg ; D9 C8+r [8086,FPU]
9068 \c{FXCH} exchanges \c{ST0} with a given FPU register. The no-operand
9069 form exchanges \c{ST0} with \c{ST1}.
9072 \S{insFXRSTOR} \i\c{FXRSTOR}: Restore \c{FP}, \c{MMX} and \c{SSE} State
9074 \c FXRSTOR memory ; 0F AE /1 [P6,SSE,FPU]
9076 The \c{FXRSTOR} instruction reloads the \c{FPU}, \c{MMX} and \c{SSE}
9077 state (environment and registers), from the 512 byte memory area defined
9078 by the source operand. This data should have been written by a previous
9082 \S{insFXSAVE} \i\c{FXSAVE}: Store \c{FP}, \c{MMX} and \c{SSE} State
9084 \c FXSAVE memory ; 0F AE /0 [P6,SSE,FPU]
9086 \c{FXSAVE}The FXSAVE instruction writes the current \c{FPU}, \c{MMX}
9087 and \c{SSE} technology states (environment and registers), to the
9088 512 byte memory area defined by the destination operand. It does this
9089 without checking for pending unmasked floating-point exceptions
9090 (similar to the operation of \c{FNSAVE}).
9092 Unlike the \c{FSAVE/FNSAVE} instructions, the processor retains the
9093 contents of the \c{FPU}, \c{MMX} and \c{SSE} state in the processor
9094 after the state has been saved. This instruction has been optimised
9095 to maximize floating-point save performance.
9098 \S{insFXTRACT} \i\c{FXTRACT}: Extract Exponent and Significand
9100 \c FXTRACT ; D9 F4 [8086,FPU]
9102 \c{FXTRACT} separates the number in \c{ST0} into its exponent and
9103 significand (mantissa), stores the exponent back into \c{ST0}, and
9104 then pushes the significand on the register stack (so that the
9105 significand ends up in \c{ST0}, and the exponent in \c{ST1}).
9108 \S{insFYL2X} \i\c{FYL2X}, \i\c{FYL2XP1}: Compute Y times Log2(X) or Log2(X+1)
9110 \c FYL2X ; D9 F1 [8086,FPU]
9111 \c FYL2XP1 ; D9 F9 [8086,FPU]
9113 \c{FYL2X} multiplies \c{ST1} by the base-2 logarithm of \c{ST0},
9114 stores the result in \c{ST1}, and pops the register stack (so that
9115 the result ends up in \c{ST0}). \c{ST0} must be non-zero and
9118 \c{FYL2XP1} works the same way, but replacing the base-2 log of
9119 \c{ST0} with that of \c{ST0} plus one. This time, \c{ST0} must have
9120 magnitude no greater than 1 minus half the square root of two.
9123 \S{insHLT} \i\c{HLT}: Halt Processor
9125 \c HLT ; F4 [8086,PRIV]
9127 \c{HLT} puts the processor into a halted state, where it will
9128 perform no more operations until restarted by an interrupt or a
9131 On the 286 and later processors, this is a privileged instruction.
9134 \S{insIBTS} \i\c{IBTS}: Insert Bit String
9136 \c IBTS r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F A7 /r [386,UNDOC]
9137 \c IBTS r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F A7 /r [386,UNDOC]
9139 The implied operation of this instruction is:
9141 \c IBTS r/m16,AX,CL,reg16
9142 \c IBTS r/m32,EAX,CL,reg32
9144 Writes a bit string from the source operand to the destination.
9145 \c{CL} indicates the number of bits to be copied, from the low bits
9146 of the source. \c{(E)AX} indicates the low order bit offset in the
9147 destination that is written to. For example, if \c{CL} is set to 4
9148 and \c{AX} (for 16-bit code) is set to 5, bits 0-3 of \c{src} will
9149 be copied to bits 5-8 of \c{dst}. This instruction is very poorly
9150 documented, and I have been unable to find any official source of
9151 documentation on it.
9153 \c{IBTS} is supported only on the early Intel 386s, and conflicts
9154 with the opcodes for \c{CMPXCHG486} (on early Intel 486s). NASM
9155 supports it only for completeness. Its counterpart is \c{XBTS}
9159 \S{insIDIV} \i\c{IDIV}: Signed Integer Divide
9161 \c IDIV r/m8 ; F6 /7 [8086]
9162 \c IDIV r/m16 ; o16 F7 /7 [8086]
9163 \c IDIV r/m32 ; o32 F7 /7 [386]
9165 \c{IDIV} performs signed integer division. The explicit operand
9166 provided is the divisor; the dividend and destination operands
9167 are implicit, in the following way:
9169 \b For \c{IDIV r/m8}, \c{AX} is divided by the given operand;
9170 the quotient is stored in \c{AL} and the remainder in \c{AH}.
9172 \b For \c{IDIV r/m16}, \c{DX:AX} is divided by the given operand;
9173 the quotient is stored in \c{AX} and the remainder in \c{DX}.
9175 \b For \c{IDIV r/m32}, \c{EDX:EAX} is divided by the given operand;
9176 the quotient is stored in \c{EAX} and the remainder in \c{EDX}.
9178 Unsigned integer division is performed by the \c{DIV} instruction:
9182 \S{insIMUL} \i\c{IMUL}: Signed Integer Multiply
9184 \c IMUL r/m8 ; F6 /5 [8086]
9185 \c IMUL r/m16 ; o16 F7 /5 [8086]
9186 \c IMUL r/m32 ; o32 F7 /5 [386]
9188 \c IMUL reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F AF /r [386]
9189 \c IMUL reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F AF /r [386]
9191 \c IMUL reg16,imm8 ; o16 6B /r ib [186]
9192 \c IMUL reg16,imm16 ; o16 69 /r iw [186]
9193 \c IMUL reg32,imm8 ; o32 6B /r ib [386]
9194 \c IMUL reg32,imm32 ; o32 69 /r id [386]
9196 \c IMUL reg16,r/m16,imm8 ; o16 6B /r ib [186]
9197 \c IMUL reg16,r/m16,imm16 ; o16 69 /r iw [186]
9198 \c IMUL reg32,r/m32,imm8 ; o32 6B /r ib [386]
9199 \c IMUL reg32,r/m32,imm32 ; o32 69 /r id [386]
9201 \c{IMUL} performs signed integer multiplication. For the
9202 single-operand form, the other operand and destination are
9203 implicit, in the following way:
9205 \b For \c{IMUL r/m8}, \c{AL} is multiplied by the given operand;
9206 the product is stored in \c{AX}.
9208 \b For \c{IMUL r/m16}, \c{AX} is multiplied by the given operand;
9209 the product is stored in \c{DX:AX}.
9211 \b For \c{IMUL r/m32}, \c{EAX} is multiplied by the given operand;
9212 the product is stored in \c{EDX:EAX}.
9214 The two-operand form multiplies its two operands and stores the
9215 result in the destination (first) operand. The three-operand
9216 form multiplies its last two operands and stores the result in
9219 The two-operand form with an immediate second operand is in
9220 fact a shorthand for the three-operand form, as can be seen by
9221 examining the opcode descriptions: in the two-operand form, the
9222 code \c{/r} takes both its register and \c{r/m} parts from the
9223 same operand (the first one).
9225 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate operand and another longer
9226 source operand, the immediate operand is considered to be signed,
9227 and is sign-extended to the length of the other source operand.
9228 In these cases, the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force
9229 NASM to generate this form of the instruction.
9231 Unsigned integer multiplication is performed by the \c{MUL}
9232 instruction: see \k{insMUL}.
9235 \S{insIN} \i\c{IN}: Input from I/O Port
9237 \c IN AL,imm8 ; E4 ib [8086]
9238 \c IN AX,imm8 ; o16 E5 ib [8086]
9239 \c IN EAX,imm8 ; o32 E5 ib [386]
9240 \c IN AL,DX ; EC [8086]
9241 \c IN AX,DX ; o16 ED [8086]
9242 \c IN EAX,DX ; o32 ED [386]
9244 \c{IN} reads a byte, word or doubleword from the specified I/O port,
9245 and stores it in the given destination register. The port number may
9246 be specified as an immediate value if it is between 0 and 255, and
9247 otherwise must be stored in \c{DX}. See also \c{OUT} (\k{insOUT}).
9250 \S{insINC} \i\c{INC}: Increment Integer
9252 \c INC reg16 ; o16 40+r [8086]
9253 \c INC reg32 ; o32 40+r [386]
9254 \c INC r/m8 ; FE /0 [8086]
9255 \c INC r/m16 ; o16 FF /0 [8086]
9256 \c INC r/m32 ; o32 FF /0 [386]
9258 \c{INC} adds 1 to its operand. It does \e{not} affect the carry
9259 flag: to affect the carry flag, use \c{ADD something,1} (see
9260 \k{insADD}). \c{INC} affects all the other flags according to the result.
9262 This instruction can be used with a \c{LOCK} prefix to allow atomic execution.
9264 See also \c{DEC} (\k{insDEC}).
9267 \S{insINSB} \i\c{INSB}, \i\c{INSW}, \i\c{INSD}: Input String from I/O Port
9270 \c INSW ; o16 6D [186]
9271 \c INSD ; o32 6D [386]
9273 \c{INSB} inputs a byte from the I/O port specified in \c{DX} and
9274 stores it at \c{[ES:DI]} or \c{[ES:EDI]}. It then increments or
9275 decrements (depending on the direction flag: increments if the flag
9276 is clear, decrements if it is set) \c{DI} or \c{EDI}.
9278 The register used is \c{DI} if the address size is 16 bits, and
9279 \c{EDI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
9280 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
9281 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
9283 Segment override prefixes have no effect for this instruction: the
9284 use of \c{ES} for the load from \c{[DI]} or \c{[EDI]} cannot be
9287 \c{INSW} and \c{INSD} work in the same way, but they input a word or
9288 a doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement the
9289 addressing register by 2 or 4 instead of 1.
9291 The \c{REP} prefix may be used to repeat the instruction \c{CX} (or
9292 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times.
9294 See also \c{OUTSB}, \c{OUTSW} and \c{OUTSD} (\k{insOUTSB}).
9297 \S{insINT} \i\c{INT}: Software Interrupt
9299 \c INT imm8 ; CD ib [8086]
9301 \c{INT} causes a software interrupt through a specified vector
9302 number from 0 to 255.
9304 The code generated by the \c{INT} instruction is always two bytes
9305 long: although there are short forms for some \c{INT} instructions,
9306 NASM does not generate them when it sees the \c{INT} mnemonic. In
9307 order to generate single-byte breakpoint instructions, use the
9308 \c{INT3} or \c{INT1} instructions (see \k{insINT1}) instead.
9311 \S{insINT1} \i\c{INT3}, \i\c{INT1}, \i\c{ICEBP}, \i\c{INT01}: Breakpoints
9318 \c INT03 ; CC [8086]
9320 \c{INT1} and \c{INT3} are short one-byte forms of the instructions
9321 \c{INT 1} and \c{INT 3} (see \k{insINT}). They perform a similar
9322 function to their longer counterparts, but take up less code space.
9323 They are used as breakpoints by debuggers.
9325 \b \c{INT1}, and its alternative synonyms \c{INT01} and \c{ICEBP}, is
9326 an instruction used by in-circuit emulators (ICEs). It is present,
9327 though not documented, on some processors down to the 286, but is
9328 only documented for the Pentium Pro. \c{INT3} is the instruction
9329 normally used as a breakpoint by debuggers.
9331 \b \c{INT3}, and its synonym \c{INT03}, is not precisely equivalent to
9332 \c{INT 3}: the short form, since it is designed to be used as a
9333 breakpoint, bypasses the normal \c{IOPL} checks in virtual-8086 mode,
9334 and also does not go through interrupt redirection.
9337 \S{insINTO} \i\c{INTO}: Interrupt if Overflow
9341 \c{INTO} performs an \c{INT 4} software interrupt (see \k{insINT})
9342 if and only if the overflow flag is set.
9345 \S{insINVD} \i\c{INVD}: Invalidate Internal Caches
9347 \c INVD ; 0F 08 [486]
9349 \c{INVD} invalidates and empties the processor's internal caches,
9350 and causes the processor to instruct external caches to do the same.
9351 It does not write the contents of the caches back to memory first:
9352 any modified data held in the caches will be lost. To write the data
9353 back first, use \c{WBINVD} (\k{insWBINVD}).
9356 \S{insINVLPG} \i\c{INVLPG}: Invalidate TLB Entry
9358 \c INVLPG mem ; 0F 01 /7 [486]
9360 \c{INVLPG} invalidates the translation lookahead buffer (TLB) entry
9361 associated with the supplied memory address.
9364 \S{insIRET} \i\c{IRET}, \i\c{IRETW}, \i\c{IRETD}: Return from Interrupt
9367 \c IRETW ; o16 CF [8086]
9368 \c IRETD ; o32 CF [386]
9370 \c{IRET} returns from an interrupt (hardware or software) by means
9371 of popping \c{IP} (or \c{EIP}), \c{CS} and the flags off the stack
9372 and then continuing execution from the new \c{CS:IP}.
9374 \c{IRETW} pops \c{IP}, \c{CS} and the flags as 2 bytes each, taking
9375 6 bytes off the stack in total. \c{IRETD} pops \c{EIP} as 4 bytes,
9376 pops a further 4 bytes of which the top two are discarded and the
9377 bottom two go into \c{CS}, and pops the flags as 4 bytes as well,
9378 taking 12 bytes off the stack.
9380 \c{IRET} is a shorthand for either \c{IRETW} or \c{IRETD}, depending
9381 on the default \c{BITS} setting at the time.
9384 \S{insJcc} \i\c{Jcc}: Conditional Branch
9386 \c Jcc imm ; 70+cc rb [8086]
9387 \c Jcc NEAR imm ; 0F 80+cc rw/rd [386]
9389 The \i{conditional jump} instructions execute a near (same segment)
9390 jump if and only if their conditions are satisfied. For example,
9391 \c{JNZ} jumps only if the zero flag is not set.
9393 The ordinary form of the instructions has only a 128-byte range; the
9394 \c{NEAR} form is a 386 extension to the instruction set, and can
9395 span the full size of a segment. NASM will not override your choice
9396 of jump instruction: if you want \c{Jcc NEAR}, you have to use the
9399 The \c{SHORT} keyword is allowed on the first form of the
9400 instruction, for clarity, but is not necessary.
9402 For details of the condition codes, see \k{iref-cc}.
9405 \S{insJCXZ} \i\c{JCXZ}, \i\c{JECXZ}: Jump if CX/ECX Zero
9407 \c JCXZ imm ; a16 E3 rb [8086]
9408 \c JECXZ imm ; a32 E3 rb [386]
9410 \c{JCXZ} performs a short jump (with maximum range 128 bytes) if and
9411 only if the contents of the \c{CX} register is 0. \c{JECXZ} does the
9412 same thing, but with \c{ECX}.
9415 \S{insJMP} \i\c{JMP}: Jump
9417 \c JMP imm ; E9 rw/rd [8086]
9418 \c JMP SHORT imm ; EB rb [8086]
9419 \c JMP imm:imm16 ; o16 EA iw iw [8086]
9420 \c JMP imm:imm32 ; o32 EA id iw [386]
9421 \c JMP FAR mem ; o16 FF /5 [8086]
9422 \c JMP FAR mem32 ; o32 FF /5 [386]
9423 \c JMP r/m16 ; o16 FF /4 [8086]
9424 \c JMP r/m32 ; o32 FF /4 [386]
9426 \c{JMP} jumps to a given address. The address may be specified as an
9427 absolute segment and offset, or as a relative jump within the
9430 \c{JMP SHORT imm} has a maximum range of 128 bytes, since the
9431 displacement is specified as only 8 bits, but takes up less code
9432 space. NASM does not choose when to generate \c{JMP SHORT} for you:
9433 you must explicitly code \c{SHORT} every time you want a short jump.
9435 You can choose between the two immediate \i{far jump} forms (\c{JMP
9436 imm:imm}) by the use of the \c{WORD} and \c{DWORD} keywords: \c{JMP
9437 WORD 0x1234:0x5678}) or \c{JMP DWORD 0x1234:0x56789abc}.
9439 The \c{JMP FAR mem} forms execute a far jump by loading the
9440 destination address out of memory. The address loaded consists of 16
9441 or 32 bits of offset (depending on the operand size), and 16 bits of
9442 segment. The operand size may be overridden using \c{JMP WORD FAR
9443 mem} or \c{JMP DWORD FAR mem}.
9445 The \c{JMP r/m} forms execute a \i{near jump} (within the same
9446 segment), loading the destination address out of memory or out of a
9447 register. The keyword \c{NEAR} may be specified, for clarity, in
9448 these forms, but is not necessary. Again, operand size can be
9449 overridden using \c{JMP WORD mem} or \c{JMP DWORD mem}.
9451 As a convenience, NASM does not require you to jump to a far symbol
9452 by coding the cumbersome \c{JMP SEG routine:routine}, but instead
9453 allows the easier synonym \c{JMP FAR routine}.
9455 The \c{CALL r/m} forms given above are near calls; NASM will accept
9456 the \c{NEAR} keyword (e.g. \c{CALL NEAR [address]}), even though it
9457 is not strictly necessary.
9460 \S{insLAHF} \i\c{LAHF}: Load AH from Flags
9464 \c{LAHF} sets the \c{AH} register according to the contents of the
9465 low byte of the flags word.
9467 The operation of \c{LAHF} is:
9469 \c AH <-- SF:ZF:0:AF:0:PF:1:CF
9471 See also \c{SAHF} (\k{insSAHF}).
9474 \S{insLAR} \i\c{LAR}: Load Access Rights
9476 \c LAR reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F 02 /r [286,PRIV]
9477 \c LAR reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F 02 /r [286,PRIV]
9479 \c{LAR} takes the segment selector specified by its source (second)
9480 operand, finds the corresponding segment descriptor in the GDT or
9481 LDT, and loads the access-rights byte of the descriptor into its
9482 destination (first) operand.
9485 \S{insLDMXCSR} \i\c{LDMXCSR}: Load Streaming SIMD Extension
9488 \c LDMXCSR mem32 ; 0F AE /2 [KATMAI,SSE]
9490 \c{LDMXCSR} loads 32-bits of data from the specified memory location
9491 into the \c{MXCSR} control/status register. \c{MXCSR} is used to
9492 enable masked/unmasked exception handling, to set rounding modes,
9493 to set flush-to-zero mode, and to view exception status flags.
9495 For details of the \c{MXCSR} register, see the Intel processor docs.
9497 See also \c{STMXCSR} (\k{insSTMXCSR}
9500 \S{insLDS} \i\c{LDS}, \i\c{LES}, \i\c{LFS}, \i\c{LGS}, \i\c{LSS}: Load Far Pointer
9502 \c LDS reg16,mem ; o16 C5 /r [8086]
9503 \c LDS reg32,mem ; o32 C5 /r [386]
9505 \c LES reg16,mem ; o16 C4 /r [8086]
9506 \c LES reg32,mem ; o32 C4 /r [386]
9508 \c LFS reg16,mem ; o16 0F B4 /r [386]
9509 \c LFS reg32,mem ; o32 0F B4 /r [386]
9511 \c LGS reg16,mem ; o16 0F B5 /r [386]
9512 \c LGS reg32,mem ; o32 0F B5 /r [386]
9514 \c LSS reg16,mem ; o16 0F B2 /r [386]
9515 \c LSS reg32,mem ; o32 0F B2 /r [386]
9517 These instructions load an entire far pointer (16 or 32 bits of
9518 offset, plus 16 bits of segment) out of memory in one go. \c{LDS},
9519 for example, loads 16 or 32 bits from the given memory address into
9520 the given register (depending on the size of the register), then
9521 loads the \e{next} 16 bits from memory into \c{DS}. \c{LES},
9522 \c{LFS}, \c{LGS} and \c{LSS} work in the same way but use the other
9526 \S{insLEA} \i\c{LEA}: Load Effective Address
9528 \c LEA reg16,mem ; o16 8D /r [8086]
9529 \c LEA reg32,mem ; o32 8D /r [386]
9531 \c{LEA}, despite its syntax, does not access memory. It calculates
9532 the effective address specified by its second operand as if it were
9533 going to load or store data from it, but instead it stores the
9534 calculated address into the register specified by its first operand.
9535 This can be used to perform quite complex calculations (e.g. \c{LEA
9536 EAX,[EBX+ECX*4+100]}) in one instruction.
9538 \c{LEA}, despite being a purely arithmetic instruction which
9539 accesses no memory, still requires square brackets around its second
9540 operand, as if it were a memory reference.
9542 The size of the calculation is the current \e{address} size, and the
9543 size that the result is stored as is the current \e{operand} size.
9544 If the address and operand size are not the same, then if the
9545 addressing mode was 32-bits, the low 16-bits are stored, and if the
9546 address was 16-bits, it is zero-extended to 32-bits before storing.
9549 \S{insLEAVE} \i\c{LEAVE}: Destroy Stack Frame
9553 \c{LEAVE} destroys a stack frame of the form created by the
9554 \c{ENTER} instruction (see \k{insENTER}). It is functionally
9555 equivalent to \c{MOV ESP,EBP} followed by \c{POP EBP} (or \c{MOV
9556 SP,BP} followed by \c{POP BP} in 16-bit mode).
9559 \S{insLFENCE} \i\c{LFENCE}: Load Fence
9561 \c LFENCE ; 0F AE /5 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9563 \c{LFENCE} performs a serialising operation on all loads from memory
9564 that were issued before the \c{LFENCE} instruction. This guarantees that
9565 all memory reads before the \c{LFENCE} instruction are visible before any
9566 reads after the \c{LFENCE} instruction.
9568 \c{LFENCE} is ordered respective to other \c{LFENCE} instruction, \c{MFENCE},
9569 any memory read and any other serialising instruction (such as \c{CPUID}).
9571 Weakly ordered memory types can be used to achieve higher processor
9572 performance through such techniques as out-of-order issue and
9573 speculative reads. The degree to which a consumer of data recognizes
9574 or knows that the data is weakly ordered varies among applications
9575 and may be unknown to the producer of this data. The \c{LFENCE}
9576 instruction provides a performance-efficient way of ensuring load
9577 ordering between routines that produce weakly-ordered results and
9578 routines that consume that data.
9580 \c{LFENCE} uses the following ModRM encoding:
9583 \c Reg/Opcode (5:3) = 101B
9586 All other ModRM encodings are defined to be reserved, and use
9587 of these encodings risks incompatibility with future processors.
9589 See also \c{SFENCE} (\k{insSFENCE}) and \c{MFENCE} (\k{insMFENCE}).
9592 \S{insLGDT} \i\c{LGDT}, \i\c{LIDT}, \i\c{LLDT}: Load Descriptor Tables
9594 \c LGDT mem ; 0F 01 /2 [286,PRIV]
9595 \c LIDT mem ; 0F 01 /3 [286,PRIV]
9596 \c LLDT r/m16 ; 0F 00 /2 [286,PRIV]
9598 \c{LGDT} and \c{LIDT} both take a 6-byte memory area as an operand:
9599 they load a 32-bit linear address and a 16-bit size limit from that
9600 area (in the opposite order) into the \c{GDTR} (global descriptor table
9601 register) or \c{IDTR} (interrupt descriptor table register). These are
9602 the only instructions which directly use \e{linear} addresses, rather
9603 than segment/offset pairs.
9605 \c{LLDT} takes a segment selector as an operand. The processor looks
9606 up that selector in the GDT and stores the limit and base address
9607 given there into the \c{LDTR} (local descriptor table register).
9609 See also \c{SGDT}, \c{SIDT} and \c{SLDT} (\k{insSGDT}).
9612 \S{insLMSW} \i\c{LMSW}: Load/Store Machine Status Word
9614 \c LMSW r/m16 ; 0F 01 /6 [286,PRIV]
9616 \c{LMSW} loads the bottom four bits of the source operand into the
9617 bottom four bits of the \c{CR0} control register (or the Machine
9618 Status Word, on 286 processors). See also \c{SMSW} (\k{insSMSW}).
9621 \S{insLOADALL} \i\c{LOADALL}, \i\c{LOADALL286}: Load Processor State
9623 \c LOADALL ; 0F 07 [386,UNDOC]
9624 \c LOADALL286 ; 0F 05 [286,UNDOC]
9626 This instruction, in its two different-opcode forms, is apparently
9627 supported on most 286 processors, some 386 and possibly some 486.
9628 The opcode differs between the 286 and the 386.
9630 The function of the instruction is to load all information relating
9631 to the state of the processor out of a block of memory: on the 286,
9632 this block is located implicitly at absolute address \c{0x800}, and
9633 on the 386 and 486 it is at \c{[ES:EDI]}.
9636 \S{insLODSB} \i\c{LODSB}, \i\c{LODSW}, \i\c{LODSD}: Load from String
9638 \c LODSB ; AC [8086]
9639 \c LODSW ; o16 AD [8086]
9640 \c LODSD ; o32 AD [386]
9642 \c{LODSB} loads a byte from \c{[DS:SI]} or \c{[DS:ESI]} into \c{AL}.
9643 It then increments or decrements (depending on the direction flag:
9644 increments if the flag is clear, decrements if it is set) \c{SI} or
9647 The register used is \c{SI} if the address size is 16 bits, and
9648 \c{ESI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
9649 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
9650 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
9652 The segment register used to load from \c{[SI]} or \c{[ESI]} can be
9653 overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
9654 example, \c{ES LODSB}).
9656 \c{LODSW} and \c{LODSD} work in the same way, but they load a
9657 word or a doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement
9658 the addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of 1.
9661 \S{insLOOP} \i\c{LOOP}, \i\c{LOOPE}, \i\c{LOOPZ}, \i\c{LOOPNE}, \i\c{LOOPNZ}: Loop with Counter
9663 \c LOOP imm ; E2 rb [8086]
9664 \c LOOP imm,CX ; a16 E2 rb [8086]
9665 \c LOOP imm,ECX ; a32 E2 rb [386]
9667 \c LOOPE imm ; E1 rb [8086]
9668 \c LOOPE imm,CX ; a16 E1 rb [8086]
9669 \c LOOPE imm,ECX ; a32 E1 rb [386]
9670 \c LOOPZ imm ; E1 rb [8086]
9671 \c LOOPZ imm,CX ; a16 E1 rb [8086]
9672 \c LOOPZ imm,ECX ; a32 E1 rb [386]
9674 \c LOOPNE imm ; E0 rb [8086]
9675 \c LOOPNE imm,CX ; a16 E0 rb [8086]
9676 \c LOOPNE imm,ECX ; a32 E0 rb [386]
9677 \c LOOPNZ imm ; E0 rb [8086]
9678 \c LOOPNZ imm,CX ; a16 E0 rb [8086]
9679 \c LOOPNZ imm,ECX ; a32 E0 rb [386]
9681 \c{LOOP} decrements its counter register (either \c{CX} or \c{ECX} -
9682 if one is not specified explicitly, the \c{BITS} setting dictates
9683 which is used) by one, and if the counter does not become zero as a
9684 result of this operation, it jumps to the given label. The jump has
9685 a range of 128 bytes.
9687 \c{LOOPE} (or its synonym \c{LOOPZ}) adds the additional condition
9688 that it only jumps if the counter is nonzero \e{and} the zero flag
9689 is set. Similarly, \c{LOOPNE} (and \c{LOOPNZ}) jumps only if the
9690 counter is nonzero and the zero flag is clear.
9693 \S{insLSL} \i\c{LSL}: Load Segment Limit
9695 \c LSL reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F 03 /r [286,PRIV]
9696 \c LSL reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F 03 /r [286,PRIV]
9698 \c{LSL} is given a segment selector in its source (second) operand;
9699 it computes the segment limit value by loading the segment limit
9700 field from the associated segment descriptor in the \c{GDT} or \c{LDT}.
9701 (This involves shifting left by 12 bits if the segment limit is
9702 page-granular, and not if it is byte-granular; so you end up with a
9703 byte limit in either case.) The segment limit obtained is then
9704 loaded into the destination (first) operand.
9707 \S{insLTR} \i\c{LTR}: Load Task Register
9709 \c LTR r/m16 ; 0F 00 /3 [286,PRIV]
9711 \c{LTR} looks up the segment base and limit in the GDT or LDT
9712 descriptor specified by the segment selector given as its operand,
9713 and loads them into the Task Register.
9716 \S{insMASKMOVDQU} \i\c{MASKMOVDQU}: Byte Mask Write
9718 \c MASKMOVDQU xmm1,xmm2 ; 66 0F F7 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9720 \c{MASKMOVDQU} stores data from xmm1 to the location specified by
9721 \c{ES:(E)DI}. The size of the store depends on the address-size
9722 attribute. The most significant bit in each byte of the mask
9723 register xmm2 is used to selectively write the data (0 = no write,
9724 1 = write) on a per-byte basis.
9727 \S{insMASKMOVQ} \i\c{MASKMOVQ}: Byte Mask Write
9729 \c MASKMOVQ mm1,mm2 ; 0F F7 /r [KATMAI,MMX]
9731 \c{MASKMOVQ} stores data from mm1 to the location specified by
9732 \c{ES:(E)DI}. The size of the store depends on the address-size
9733 attribute. The most significant bit in each byte of the mask
9734 register mm2 is used to selectively write the data (0 = no write,
9735 1 = write) on a per-byte basis.
9738 \S{insMAXPD} \i\c{MAXPD}: Return Packed Double-Precision FP Maximum
9740 \c MAXPD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 5F /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9742 \c{MAXPD} performs a SIMD compare of the packed double-precision
9743 FP numbers from xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the maximum values
9744 of each pair of values in xmm1. If the values being compared are
9745 both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m128) would be returned. If source2
9746 (xmm2/m128) is an SNaN, this SNaN is forwarded unchanged to the
9747 destination (i.e., a QNaN version of the SNaN is not returned).
9750 \S{insMAXPS} \i\c{MAXPS}: Return Packed Single-Precision FP Maximum
9752 \c MAXPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 5F /r [KATMAI,SSE]
9754 \c{MAXPS} performs a SIMD compare of the packed single-precision
9755 FP numbers from xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the maximum values
9756 of each pair of values in xmm1. If the values being compared are
9757 both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m128) would be returned. If source2
9758 (xmm2/m128) is an SNaN, this SNaN is forwarded unchanged to the
9759 destination (i.e., a QNaN version of the SNaN is not returned).
9762 \S{insMAXSD} \i\c{MAXSD}: Return Scalar Double-Precision FP Maximum
9764 \c MAXSD xmm1,xmm2/m64 ; F2 0F 5F /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9766 \c{MAXSD} compares the low-order double-precision FP numbers from
9767 xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the maximum value in xmm1. If the
9768 values being compared are both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m64) would
9769 be returned. If source2 (xmm2/m64) is an SNaN, this SNaN is
9770 forwarded unchanged to the destination (i.e., a QNaN version of
9771 the SNaN is not returned). The high quadword of the destination
9775 \S{insMAXSS} \i\c{MAXSS}: Return Scalar Single-Precision FP Maximum
9777 \c MAXSS xmm1,xmm2/m32 ; F3 0F 5F /r [KATMAI,SSE]
9779 \c{MAXSS} compares the low-order single-precision FP numbers from
9780 xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the maximum value in xmm1. If the
9781 values being compared are both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m32) would
9782 be returned. If source2 (xmm2/m32) is an SNaN, this SNaN is
9783 forwarded unchanged to the destination (i.e., a QNaN version of
9784 the SNaN is not returned). The high three doublewords of the
9785 destination are left unchanged.
9788 \S{insMFENCE} \i\c{MFENCE}: Memory Fence
9790 \c MFENCE ; 0F AE /6 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9792 \c{MFENCE} performs a serialising operation on all loads from memory
9793 and writes to memory that were issued before the \c{MFENCE} instruction.
9794 This guarantees that all memory reads and writes before the \c{MFENCE}
9795 instruction are completed before any reads and writes after the
9796 \c{MFENCE} instruction.
9798 \c{MFENCE} is ordered respective to other \c{MFENCE} instructions,
9799 \c{LFENCE}, \c{SFENCE}, any memory read and any other serialising
9800 instruction (such as \c{CPUID}).
9802 Weakly ordered memory types can be used to achieve higher processor
9803 performance through such techniques as out-of-order issue, speculative
9804 reads, write-combining, and write-collapsing. The degree to which a
9805 consumer of data recognizes or knows that the data is weakly ordered
9806 varies among applications and may be unknown to the producer of this
9807 data. The \c{MFENCE} instruction provides a performance-efficient way
9808 of ensuring load and store ordering between routines that produce
9809 weakly-ordered results and routines that consume that data.
9811 \c{MFENCE} uses the following ModRM encoding:
9814 \c Reg/Opcode (5:3) = 110B
9817 All other ModRM encodings are defined to be reserved, and use
9818 of these encodings risks incompatibility with future processors.
9820 See also \c{LFENCE} (\k{insLFENCE}) and \c{SFENCE} (\k{insSFENCE}).
9823 \S{insMINPD} \i\c{MINPD}: Return Packed Double-Precision FP Minimum
9825 \c MINPD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 5D /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9827 \c{MINPD} performs a SIMD compare of the packed double-precision
9828 FP numbers from xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the minimum values
9829 of each pair of values in xmm1. If the values being compared are
9830 both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m128) would be returned. If source2
9831 (xmm2/m128) is an SNaN, this SNaN is forwarded unchanged to the
9832 destination (i.e., a QNaN version of the SNaN is not returned).
9835 \S{insMINPS} \i\c{MINPS}: Return Packed Single-Precision FP Minimum
9837 \c MINPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 5D /r [KATMAI,SSE]
9839 \c{MINPS} performs a SIMD compare of the packed single-precision
9840 FP numbers from xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the minimum values
9841 of each pair of values in xmm1. If the values being compared are
9842 both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m128) would be returned. If source2
9843 (xmm2/m128) is an SNaN, this SNaN is forwarded unchanged to the
9844 destination (i.e., a QNaN version of the SNaN is not returned).
9847 \S{insMINSD} \i\c{MINSD}: Return Scalar Double-Precision FP Minimum
9849 \c MINSD xmm1,xmm2/m64 ; F2 0F 5D /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9851 \c{MINSD} compares the low-order double-precision FP numbers from
9852 xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the minimum value in xmm1. If the
9853 values being compared are both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m64) would
9854 be returned. If source2 (xmm2/m64) is an SNaN, this SNaN is
9855 forwarded unchanged to the destination (i.e., a QNaN version of
9856 the SNaN is not returned). The high quadword of the destination
9860 \S{insMINSS} \i\c{MINSS}: Return Scalar Single-Precision FP Minimum
9862 \c MINSS xmm1,xmm2/m32 ; F3 0F 5D /r [KATMAI,SSE]
9864 \c{MINSS} compares the low-order single-precision FP numbers from
9865 xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the minimum value in xmm1. If the
9866 values being compared are both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m32) would
9867 be returned. If source2 (xmm2/m32) is an SNaN, this SNaN is
9868 forwarded unchanged to the destination (i.e., a QNaN version of
9869 the SNaN is not returned). The high three doublewords of the
9870 destination are left unchanged.
9873 \S{insMOV} \i\c{MOV}: Move Data
9875 \c MOV r/m8,reg8 ; 88 /r [8086]
9876 \c MOV r/m16,reg16 ; o16 89 /r [8086]
9877 \c MOV r/m32,reg32 ; o32 89 /r [386]
9878 \c MOV reg8,r/m8 ; 8A /r [8086]
9879 \c MOV reg16,r/m16 ; o16 8B /r [8086]
9880 \c MOV reg32,r/m32 ; o32 8B /r [386]
9882 \c MOV reg8,imm8 ; B0+r ib [8086]
9883 \c MOV reg16,imm16 ; o16 B8+r iw [8086]
9884 \c MOV reg32,imm32 ; o32 B8+r id [386]
9885 \c MOV r/m8,imm8 ; C6 /0 ib [8086]
9886 \c MOV r/m16,imm16 ; o16 C7 /0 iw [8086]
9887 \c MOV r/m32,imm32 ; o32 C7 /0 id [386]
9889 \c MOV AL,memoffs8 ; A0 ow/od [8086]
9890 \c MOV AX,memoffs16 ; o16 A1 ow/od [8086]
9891 \c MOV EAX,memoffs32 ; o32 A1 ow/od [386]
9892 \c MOV memoffs8,AL ; A2 ow/od [8086]
9893 \c MOV memoffs16,AX ; o16 A3 ow/od [8086]
9894 \c MOV memoffs32,EAX ; o32 A3 ow/od [386]
9896 \c MOV r/m16,segreg ; o16 8C /r [8086]
9897 \c MOV r/m32,segreg ; o32 8C /r [386]
9898 \c MOV segreg,r/m16 ; o16 8E /r [8086]
9899 \c MOV segreg,r/m32 ; o32 8E /r [386]
9901 \c MOV reg32,CR0/2/3/4 ; 0F 20 /r [386]
9902 \c MOV reg32,DR0/1/2/3/6/7 ; 0F 21 /r [386]
9903 \c MOV reg32,TR3/4/5/6/7 ; 0F 24 /r [386]
9904 \c MOV CR0/2/3/4,reg32 ; 0F 22 /r [386]
9905 \c MOV DR0/1/2/3/6/7,reg32 ; 0F 23 /r [386]
9906 \c MOV TR3/4/5/6/7,reg32 ; 0F 26 /r [386]
9908 \c{MOV} copies the contents of its source (second) operand into its
9909 destination (first) operand.
9911 In all forms of the \c{MOV} instruction, the two operands are the
9912 same size, except for moving between a segment register and an
9913 \c{r/m32} operand. These instructions are treated exactly like the
9914 corresponding 16-bit equivalent (so that, for example, \c{MOV
9915 DS,EAX} functions identically to \c{MOV DS,AX} but saves a prefix
9916 when in 32-bit mode), except that when a segment register is moved
9917 into a 32-bit destination, the top two bytes of the result are
9920 \c{MOV} may not use \c{CS} as a destination.
9922 \c{CR4} is only a supported register on the Pentium and above.
9924 Test registers are supported on 386/486 processors and on some
9925 non-Intel Pentium class processors.
9928 \S{insMOVAPD} \i\c{MOVAPD}: Move Aligned Packed Double-Precision FP Values
9930 \c MOVAPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 28 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9931 \c MOVAPD xmm1/mem128,xmm2 ; 66 0F 29 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9933 \c{MOVAPD} moves a double quadword containing 2 packed double-precision
9934 FP values from the source operand to the destination. When the source
9935 or destination operand is a memory location, it must be aligned on a
9938 To move data in and out of memory locations that are not known to be on
9939 16-byte boundaries, use the \c{MOVUPD} instruction (\k{insMOVUPD}).
9942 \S{insMOVAPS} \i\c{MOVAPS}: Move Aligned Packed Single-Precision FP Values
9944 \c MOVAPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F 28 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
9945 \c MOVAPS xmm1/mem128,xmm2 ; 0F 29 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
9947 \c{MOVAPS} moves a double quadword containing 4 packed single-precision
9948 FP values from the source operand to the destination. When the source
9949 or destination operand is a memory location, it must be aligned on a
9952 To move data in and out of memory locations that are not known to be on
9953 16-byte boundaries, use the \c{MOVUPS} instruction (\k{insMOVUPS}).
9956 \S{insMOVD} \i\c{MOVD}: Move Doubleword to/from MMX Register
9958 \c MOVD mm,r/m32 ; 0F 6E /r [PENT,MMX]
9959 \c MOVD r/m32,mm ; 0F 7E /r [PENT,MMX]
9960 \c MOVD xmm,r/m32 ; 66 0F 6E /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9961 \c MOVD r/m32,xmm ; 66 0F 7E /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9963 \c{MOVD} copies 32 bits from its source (second) operand into its
9964 destination (first) operand. When the destination is a 64-bit \c{MMX}
9965 register or a 128-bit \c{XMM} register, the input value is zero-extended
9966 to fill the destination register.
9969 \S{insMOVDQ2Q} \i\c{MOVDQ2Q}: Move Quadword from XMM to MMX register.
9971 \c MOVDQ2Q mm,xmm ; F2 OF D6 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9973 \c{MOVDQ2Q} moves the low quadword from the source operand to the
9974 destination operand.
9977 \S{insMOVDQA} \i\c{MOVDQA}: Move Aligned Double Quadword
9979 \c MOVDQA xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 OF 6F /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9980 \c MOVDQA xmm1/m128,xmm2 ; 66 OF 7F /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9982 \c{MOVDQA} moves a double quadword from the source operand to the
9983 destination operand. When the source or destination operand is a
9984 memory location, it must be aligned to a 16-byte boundary.
9986 To move a double quadword to or from unaligned memory locations,
9987 use the \c{MOVDQU} instruction (\k{insMOVDQU}).
9990 \S{insMOVDQU} \i\c{MOVDQU}: Move Unaligned Double Quadword
9992 \c MOVDQU xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; F3 OF 6F /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9993 \c MOVDQU xmm1/m128,xmm2 ; F3 OF 7F /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
9995 \c{MOVDQU} moves a double quadword from the source operand to the
9996 destination operand. When the source or destination operand is a
9997 memory location, the memory may be unaligned.
9999 To move a double quadword to or from known aligned memory locations,
10000 use the \c{MOVDQA} instruction (\k{insMOVDQA}).
10003 \S{insMOVHLPS} \i\c{MOVHLPS}: Move Packed Single-Precision FP High to Low
10005 \c MOVHLPS xmm1,xmm2 ; OF 12 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10007 \c{MOVHLPS} moves the two packed single-precision FP values from the
10008 high quadword of the source register xmm2 to the low quadword of the
10009 destination register, xmm2. The upper quadword of xmm1 is left unchanged.
10011 The operation of this instruction is:
10013 \c dst[0-63] := src[64-127],
10014 \c dst[64-127] remains unchanged.
10017 \S{insMOVHPD} \i\c{MOVHPD}: Move High Packed Double-Precision FP
10019 \c MOVHPD xmm,m64 ; 66 OF 16 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10020 \c MOVHPD m64,xmm ; 66 OF 17 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10022 \c{MOVHPD} moves a double-precision FP value between the source and
10023 destination operands. One of the operands is a 64-bit memory location,
10024 the other is the high quadword of an \c{XMM} register.
10026 The operation of this instruction is:
10028 \c mem[0-63] := xmm[64-127];
10032 \c xmm[0-63] remains unchanged;
10033 \c xmm[64-127] := mem[0-63].
10036 \S{insMOVHPS} \i\c{MOVHPS}: Move High Packed Single-Precision FP
10038 \c MOVHPS xmm,m64 ; 0F 16 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10039 \c MOVHPS m64,xmm ; 0F 17 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10041 \c{MOVHPS} moves two packed single-precision FP values between the source
10042 and destination operands. One of the operands is a 64-bit memory location,
10043 the other is the high quadword of an \c{XMM} register.
10045 The operation of this instruction is:
10047 \c mem[0-63] := xmm[64-127];
10051 \c xmm[0-63] remains unchanged;
10052 \c xmm[64-127] := mem[0-63].
10055 \S{insMOVLHPS} \i\c{MOVLHPS}: Move Packed Single-Precision FP Low to High
10057 \c MOVLHPS xmm1,xmm2 ; OF 16 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10059 \c{MOVLHPS} moves the two packed single-precision FP values from the
10060 low quadword of the source register xmm2 to the high quadword of the
10061 destination register, xmm2. The low quadword of xmm1 is left unchanged.
10063 The operation of this instruction is:
10065 \c dst[0-63] remains unchanged;
10066 \c dst[64-127] := src[0-63].
10068 \S{insMOVLPD} \i\c{MOVLPD}: Move Low Packed Double-Precision FP
10070 \c MOVLPD xmm,m64 ; 66 OF 12 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10071 \c MOVLPD m64,xmm ; 66 OF 13 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10073 \c{MOVLPD} moves a double-precision FP value between the source and
10074 destination operands. One of the operands is a 64-bit memory location,
10075 the other is the low quadword of an \c{XMM} register.
10077 The operation of this instruction is:
10079 \c mem(0-63) := xmm(0-63);
10083 \c xmm(0-63) := mem(0-63);
10084 \c xmm(64-127) remains unchanged.
10086 \S{insMOVLPS} \i\c{MOVLPS}: Move Low Packed Single-Precision FP
10088 \c MOVLPS xmm,m64 ; OF 12 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10089 \c MOVLPS m64,xmm ; OF 13 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10091 \c{MOVLPS} moves two packed single-precision FP values between the source
10092 and destination operands. One of the operands is a 64-bit memory location,
10093 the other is the low quadword of an \c{XMM} register.
10095 The operation of this instruction is:
10097 \c mem(0-63) := xmm(0-63);
10101 \c xmm(0-63) := mem(0-63);
10102 \c xmm(64-127) remains unchanged.
10105 \S{insMOVMSKPD} \i\c{MOVMSKPD}: Extract Packed Double-Precision FP Sign Mask
10107 \c MOVMSKPD reg32,xmm ; 66 0F 50 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10109 \c{MOVMSKPD} inserts a 2-bit mask in r32, formed of the most significant
10110 bits of each double-precision FP number of the source operand.
10113 \S{insMOVMSKPS} \i\c{MOVMSKPS}: Extract Packed Single-Precision FP Sign Mask
10115 \c MOVMSKPS reg32,xmm ; 0F 50 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10117 \c{MOVMSKPS} inserts a 4-bit mask in r32, formed of the most significant
10118 bits of each single-precision FP number of the source operand.
10121 \S{insMOVNTDQ} \i\c{MOVNTDQ}: Move Double Quadword Non Temporal
10123 \c MOVNTDQ m128,xmm ; 66 0F E7 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10125 \c{MOVNTDQ} moves the double quadword from the \c{XMM} source
10126 register to the destination memory location, using a non-temporal
10127 hint. This store instruction minimizes cache pollution.
10130 \S{insMOVNTI} \i\c{MOVNTI}: Move Doubleword Non Temporal
10132 \c MOVNTI m32,reg32 ; 0F C3 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10134 \c{MOVNTI} moves the doubleword in the source register
10135 to the destination memory location, using a non-temporal
10136 hint. This store instruction minimizes cache pollution.
10139 \S{insMOVNTPD} \i\c{MOVNTPD}: Move Aligned Four Packed Single-Precision
10140 FP Values Non Temporal
10142 \c MOVNTPD m128,xmm ; 66 0F 2B /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10144 \c{MOVNTPD} moves the double quadword from the \c{XMM} source
10145 register to the destination memory location, using a non-temporal
10146 hint. This store instruction minimizes cache pollution. The memory
10147 location must be aligned to a 16-byte boundary.
10150 \S{insMOVNTPS} \i\c{MOVNTPS}: Move Aligned Four Packed Single-Precision
10151 FP Values Non Temporal
10153 \c MOVNTPS m128,xmm ; 0F 2B /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10155 \c{MOVNTPS} moves the double quadword from the \c{XMM} source
10156 register to the destination memory location, using a non-temporal
10157 hint. This store instruction minimizes cache pollution. The memory
10158 location must be aligned to a 16-byte boundary.
10161 \S{insMOVNTQ} \i\c{MOVNTQ}: Move Quadword Non Temporal
10163 \c MOVNTQ m64,mm ; 0F E7 /r [KATMAI,MMX]
10165 \c{MOVNTQ} moves the quadword in the \c{MMX} source register
10166 to the destination memory location, using a non-temporal
10167 hint. This store instruction minimizes cache pollution.
10170 \S{insMOVQ} \i\c{MOVQ}: Move Quadword to/from MMX Register
10172 \c MOVQ mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 6F /r [PENT,MMX]
10173 \c MOVQ mm1/m64,mm2 ; 0F 7F /r [PENT,MMX]
10175 \c MOVQ xmm1,xmm2/m64 ; F3 0F 7E /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10176 \c MOVQ xmm1/m64,xmm2 ; 66 0F D6 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10178 \c{MOVQ} copies 64 bits from its source (second) operand into its
10179 destination (first) operand. When the source is an \c{XMM} register,
10180 the low quadword is moved. When the destination is an \c{XMM} register,
10181 the destination is the low quadword, and the high quadword is cleared.
10184 \S{insMOVQ2DQ} \i\c{MOVQ2DQ}: Move Quadword from MMX to XMM register.
10186 \c MOVQ2DQ xmm,mm ; F3 OF D6 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10188 \c{MOVQ2DQ} moves the quadword from the source operand to the low
10189 quadword of the destination operand, and clears the high quadword.
10192 \S{insMOVSB} \i\c{MOVSB}, \i\c{MOVSW}, \i\c{MOVSD}: Move String
10194 \c MOVSB ; A4 [8086]
10195 \c MOVSW ; o16 A5 [8086]
10196 \c MOVSD ; o32 A5 [386]
10198 \c{MOVSB} copies the byte at \c{[DS:SI]} or \c{[DS:ESI]} to
10199 \c{[ES:DI]} or \c{[ES:EDI]}. It then increments or decrements
10200 (depending on the direction flag: increments if the flag is clear,
10201 decrements if it is set) \c{SI} and \c{DI} (or \c{ESI} and \c{EDI}).
10203 The registers used are \c{SI} and \c{DI} if the address size is 16
10204 bits, and \c{ESI} and \c{EDI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use
10205 an address size not equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can
10206 use an explicit \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
10208 The segment register used to load from \c{[SI]} or \c{[ESI]} can be
10209 overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
10210 example, \c{es movsb}). The use of \c{ES} for the store to \c{[DI]}
10211 or \c{[EDI]} cannot be overridden.
10213 \c{MOVSW} and \c{MOVSD} work in the same way, but they copy a word
10214 or a doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement the
10215 addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of 1.
10217 The \c{REP} prefix may be used to repeat the instruction \c{CX} (or
10218 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times.
10221 \S{insMOVSD} \i\c{MOVSD}: Move Scalar Double-Precision FP Value
10223 \c MOVSD xmm1,xmm2/m64 ; F2 0F 10 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10224 \c MOVSD xmm1/m64,xmm2 ; F2 0F 11 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10226 \c{MOVSD} moves a double-precision FP value from the source operand
10227 to the destination operand. When the source or destination is a
10228 register, the low-order FP value is read or written.
10231 \S{insMOVSS} \i\c{MOVSS}: Move Scalar Single-Precision FP Value
10233 \c MOVSS xmm1,xmm2/m32 ; F3 0F 10 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10234 \c MOVSS xmm1/m32,xmm2 ; F3 0F 11 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10236 \c{MOVSS} moves a single-precision FP value from the source operand
10237 to the destination operand. When the source or destination is a
10238 register, the low-order FP value is read or written.
10241 \S{insMOVSX} \i\c{MOVSX}, \i\c{MOVZX}: Move Data with Sign or Zero Extend
10243 \c MOVSX reg16,r/m8 ; o16 0F BE /r [386]
10244 \c MOVSX reg32,r/m8 ; o32 0F BE /r [386]
10245 \c MOVSX reg32,r/m16 ; o32 0F BF /r [386]
10247 \c MOVZX reg16,r/m8 ; o16 0F B6 /r [386]
10248 \c MOVZX reg32,r/m8 ; o32 0F B6 /r [386]
10249 \c MOVZX reg32,r/m16 ; o32 0F B7 /r [386]
10251 \c{MOVSX} sign-extends its source (second) operand to the length of
10252 its destination (first) operand, and copies the result into the
10253 destination operand. \c{MOVZX} does the same, but zero-extends
10254 rather than sign-extending.
10257 \S{insMOVUPD} \i\c{MOVUPD}: Move Unaligned Packed Double-Precision FP Values
10259 \c MOVUPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 10 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10260 \c MOVUPD xmm1/mem128,xmm2 ; 66 0F 11 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10262 \c{MOVUPD} moves a double quadword containing 2 packed double-precision
10263 FP values from the source operand to the destination. This instruction
10264 makes no assumptions about alignment of memory operands.
10266 To move data in and out of memory locations that are known to be on 16-byte
10267 boundaries, use the \c{MOVAPD} instruction (\k{insMOVAPD}).
10270 \S{insMOVUPS} \i\c{MOVUPS}: Move Unaligned Packed Single-Precision FP Values
10272 \c MOVUPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F 10 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10273 \c MOVUPS xmm1/mem128,xmm2 ; 0F 11 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10275 \c{MOVUPS} moves a double quadword containing 4 packed single-precision
10276 FP values from the source operand to the destination. This instruction
10277 makes no assumptions about alignment of memory operands.
10279 To move data in and out of memory locations that are known to be on 16-byte
10280 boundaries, use the \c{MOVAPS} instruction (\k{insMOVAPS}).
10283 \S{insMUL} \i\c{MUL}: Unsigned Integer Multiply
10285 \c MUL r/m8 ; F6 /4 [8086]
10286 \c MUL r/m16 ; o16 F7 /4 [8086]
10287 \c MUL r/m32 ; o32 F7 /4 [386]
10289 \c{MUL} performs unsigned integer multiplication. The other operand
10290 to the multiplication, and the destination operand, are implicit, in
10293 \b For \c{MUL r/m8}, \c{AL} is multiplied by the given operand; the
10294 product is stored in \c{AX}.
10296 \b For \c{MUL r/m16}, \c{AX} is multiplied by the given operand;
10297 the product is stored in \c{DX:AX}.
10299 \b For \c{MUL r/m32}, \c{EAX} is multiplied by the given operand;
10300 the product is stored in \c{EDX:EAX}.
10302 Signed integer multiplication is performed by the \c{IMUL}
10303 instruction: see \k{insIMUL}.
10306 \S{insMULPD} \i\c{MULPD}: Packed Single-FP Multiply
10308 \c MULPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 66 0F 59 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10310 \c{MULPD} performs a SIMD multiply of the packed double-precision FP
10311 values in both operands, and stores the results in the destination register.
10314 \S{insMULPS} \i\c{MULPS}: Packed Single-FP Multiply
10316 \c MULPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128 ; 0F 59 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10318 \c{MULPS} performs a SIMD multiply of the packed single-precision FP
10319 values in both operands, and stores the results in the destination register.
10322 \S{insMULSD} \i\c{MULSD}: Scalar Single-FP Multiply
10324 \c MULSD xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F2 0F 59 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10326 \c{MULSD} multiplies the lowest double-precision FP values of both
10327 operands, and stores the result in the low quadword of xmm1.
10330 \S{insMULSS} \i\c{MULSS}: Scalar Single-FP Multiply
10332 \c MULSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32 ; F3 0F 59 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10334 \c{MULSS} multiplies the lowest single-precision FP values of both
10335 operands, and stores the result in the low doubleword of xmm1.
10338 \S{insNEG} \i\c{NEG}, \i\c{NOT}: Two's and One's Complement
10340 \c NEG r/m8 ; F6 /3 [8086]
10341 \c NEG r/m16 ; o16 F7 /3 [8086]
10342 \c NEG r/m32 ; o32 F7 /3 [386]
10344 \c NOT r/m8 ; F6 /2 [8086]
10345 \c NOT r/m16 ; o16 F7 /2 [8086]
10346 \c NOT r/m32 ; o32 F7 /2 [386]
10348 \c{NEG} replaces the contents of its operand by the two's complement
10349 negation (invert all the bits and then add one) of the original
10350 value. \c{NOT}, similarly, performs one's complement (inverts all
10354 \S{insNOP} \i\c{NOP}: No Operation
10358 \c{NOP} performs no operation. Its opcode is the same as that
10359 generated by \c{XCHG AX,AX} or \c{XCHG EAX,EAX} (depending on the
10360 processor mode; see \k{insXCHG}).
10363 \S{insOR} \i\c{OR}: Bitwise OR
10365 \c OR r/m8,reg8 ; 08 /r [8086]
10366 \c OR r/m16,reg16 ; o16 09 /r [8086]
10367 \c OR r/m32,reg32 ; o32 09 /r [386]
10369 \c OR reg8,r/m8 ; 0A /r [8086]
10370 \c OR reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0B /r [8086]
10371 \c OR reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0B /r [386]
10373 \c OR r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /1 ib [8086]
10374 \c OR r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /1 iw [8086]
10375 \c OR r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /1 id [386]
10377 \c OR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /1 ib [8086]
10378 \c OR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /1 ib [386]
10380 \c OR AL,imm8 ; 0C ib [8086]
10381 \c OR AX,imm16 ; o16 0D iw [8086]
10382 \c OR EAX,imm32 ; o32 0D id [386]
10384 \c{OR} performs a bitwise OR operation between its two operands
10385 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if at least one of the
10386 corresponding bits of the two inputs was 1), and stores the result
10387 in the destination (first) operand.
10389 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
10390 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
10391 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
10392 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
10393 form of the instruction.
10395 The MMX instruction \c{POR} (see \k{insPOR}) performs the same
10396 operation on the 64-bit MMX registers.
10399 \S{insORPD} \i\c{ORPD}: Bit-wise Logical OR of Double-Precision FP Data
10401 \c ORPD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 56 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10403 \c{ORPD} return a bit-wise logical OR between xmm1 and xmm2/mem,
10404 and stores the result in xmm1. If the source operand is a memory
10405 location, it must be aligned to a 16-byte boundary.
10408 \S{insORPS} \i\c{ORPS}: Bit-wise Logical OR of Single-Precision FP Data
10410 \c ORPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 56 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
10412 \c{ORPS} return a bit-wise logical OR between xmm1 and xmm2/mem,
10413 and stores the result in xmm1. If the source operand is a memory
10414 location, it must be aligned to a 16-byte boundary.
10417 \S{insOUT} \i\c{OUT}: Output Data to I/O Port
10419 \c OUT imm8,AL ; E6 ib [8086]
10420 \c OUT imm8,AX ; o16 E7 ib [8086]
10421 \c OUT imm8,EAX ; o32 E7 ib [386]
10422 \c OUT DX,AL ; EE [8086]
10423 \c OUT DX,AX ; o16 EF [8086]
10424 \c OUT DX,EAX ; o32 EF [386]
10426 \c{OUT} writes the contents of the given source register to the
10427 specified I/O port. The port number may be specified as an immediate
10428 value if it is between 0 and 255, and otherwise must be stored in
10429 \c{DX}. See also \c{IN} (\k{insIN}).
10432 \S{insOUTSB} \i\c{OUTSB}, \i\c{OUTSW}, \i\c{OUTSD}: Output String to I/O Port
10434 \c OUTSB ; 6E [186]
10435 \c OUTSW ; o16 6F [186]
10436 \c OUTSD ; o32 6F [386]
10438 \c{OUTSB} loads a byte from \c{[DS:SI]} or \c{[DS:ESI]} and writes
10439 it to the I/O port specified in \c{DX}. It then increments or
10440 decrements (depending on the direction flag: increments if the flag
10441 is clear, decrements if it is set) \c{SI} or \c{ESI}.
10443 The register used is \c{SI} if the address size is 16 bits, and
10444 \c{ESI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
10445 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
10446 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
10448 The segment register used to load from \c{[SI]} or \c{[ESI]} can be
10449 overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
10450 example, \c{es outsb}).
10452 \c{OUTSW} and \c{OUTSD} work in the same way, but they output a
10453 word or a doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement
10454 the addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of 1.
10456 The \c{REP} prefix may be used to repeat the instruction \c{CX} (or
10457 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times.
10460 \S{insPACKSSDW} \i\c{PACKSSDW}, \i\c{PACKSSWB}, \i\c{PACKUSWB}: Pack Data
10462 \c PACKSSDW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 6B /r [PENT,MMX]
10463 \c PACKSSWB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 63 /r [PENT,MMX]
10464 \c PACKUSWB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 67 /r [PENT,MMX]
10466 \c PACKSSDW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 6B /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10467 \c PACKSSWB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 63 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10468 \c PACKUSWB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 67 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10470 All these instructions start by combining the source and destination
10471 operands, and then splitting the result in smaller sections which it
10472 then packs into the destination register. The \c{MMX} versions pack
10473 two 64-bit operands into one 64-bit register, while the \c{SSE}
10474 versions pack two 128-bit operands into one 128-bit register.
10476 \b \c{PACKSSWB} splits the combined value into words, and then reduces
10477 the words to bytes, using signed saturation. It then packs the bytes
10478 into the destination register in the same order the words were in.
10480 \b \c{PACKSSDW} performs the same operation as \c{PACKSSWB}, except that
10481 it reduces doublewords to words, then packs them into the destination
10484 \b \c{PACKUSWB} performs the same operation as \c{PACKSSWB}, except that
10485 it uses unsigned saturation when reducing the size of the elements.
10487 To perform signed saturation on a number, it is replaced by the largest
10488 signed number (\c{7FFFh} or \c{7Fh}) that \e{will} fit, and if it is too
10489 small it is replaced by the smallest signed number (\c{8000h} or
10490 \c{80h}) that will fit. To perform unsigned saturation, the input is
10491 treated as unsigned, and the input is replaced by the largest unsigned
10492 number that will fit.
10495 \S{insPADDB} \i\c{PADDB}, \i\c{PADDW}, \i\c{PADDD}: Add Packed Integers
10497 \c PADDB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F FC /r [PENT,MMX]
10498 \c PADDW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F FD /r [PENT,MMX]
10499 \c PADDD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F FE /r [PENT,MMX]
10501 \c PADDB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F FC /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10502 \c PADDW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F FD /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10503 \c PADDD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F FE /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10505 \c{PADDx} performs packed addition of the two operands, storing the
10506 result in the destination (first) operand.
10508 \b \c{PADDB} treats the operands as packed bytes, and adds each byte
10511 \b \c{PADDW} treats the operands as packed words;
10513 \b \c{PADDD} treats its operands as packed doublewords.
10515 When an individual result is too large to fit in its destination, it
10516 is wrapped around and the low bits are stored, with the carry bit
10520 \S{insPADDQ} \i\c{PADDQ}: Add Packed Quadword Integers
10522 \c PADDQ mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F D4 /r [PENT,MMX]
10524 \c PADDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F D4 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10526 \c{PADDQ} adds the quadwords in the source and destination operands, and
10527 stores the result in the destination register.
10529 When an individual result is too large to fit in its destination, it
10530 is wrapped around and the low bits are stored, with the carry bit
10534 \S{insPADDSB} \i\c{PADDSB}, \i\c{PADDSW}: Add Packed Signed Integers With Saturation
10536 \c PADDSB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F EC /r [PENT,MMX]
10537 \c PADDSW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F ED /r [PENT,MMX]
10539 \c PADDSB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F EC /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10540 \c PADDSW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F ED /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10542 \c{PADDSx} performs packed addition of the two operands, storing the
10543 result in the destination (first) operand.
10544 \c{PADDSB} treats the operands as packed bytes, and adds each byte
10545 individually; and \c{PADDSW} treats the operands as packed words.
10547 When an individual result is too large to fit in its destination, a
10548 saturated value is stored. The resulting value is the value with the
10549 largest magnitude of the same sign as the result which will fit in
10550 the available space.
10553 \S{insPADDSIW} \i\c{PADDSIW}: MMX Packed Addition to Implicit Destination
10555 \c PADDSIW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 51 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
10557 \c{PADDSIW}, specific to the Cyrix extensions to the MMX instruction
10558 set, performs the same function as \c{PADDSW}, except that the result
10559 is placed in an implied register.
10561 To work out the implied register, invert the lowest bit in the register
10562 number. So \c{PADDSIW MM0,MM2} would put the result in \c{MM1}, but
10563 \c{PADDSIW MM1,MM2} would put the result in \c{MM0}.
10566 \S{insPADDUSB} \i\c{PADDUSB}, \i\c{PADDUSW}: Add Packed Unsigned Integers With Saturation
10568 \c PADDUSB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F DC /r [PENT,MMX]
10569 \c PADDUSW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F DD /r [PENT,MMX]
10571 \c PADDUSB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F DC /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10572 \c PADDUSW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F DD /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10574 \c{PADDUSx} performs packed addition of the two operands, storing the
10575 result in the destination (first) operand.
10576 \c{PADDUSB} treats the operands as packed bytes, and adds each byte
10577 individually; and \c{PADDUSW} treats the operands as packed words.
10579 When an individual result is too large to fit in its destination, a
10580 saturated value is stored. The resulting value is the maximum value
10581 that will fit in the available space.
10584 \S{insPAND} \i\c{PAND}, \i\c{PANDN}: MMX Bitwise AND and AND-NOT
10586 \c PAND mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F DB /r [PENT,MMX]
10587 \c PANDN mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F DF /r [PENT,MMX]
10589 \c PAND xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F DB /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10590 \c PANDN xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F DF /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10593 \c{PAND} performs a bitwise AND operation between its two operands
10594 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if the corresponding
10595 bits of the two inputs were both 1), and stores the result in the
10596 destination (first) operand.
10598 \c{PANDN} performs the same operation, but performs a one's
10599 complement operation on the destination (first) operand first.
10602 \S{insPAUSE} \i\c{PAUSE}: Spin Loop Hint
10604 \c PAUSE ; F3 90 [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10606 \c{PAUSE} provides a hint to the processor that the following code
10607 is a spin loop. This improves processor performance by bypassing
10608 possible memory order violations. On older processors, this instruction
10609 operates as a \c{NOP}.
10612 \S{insPAVEB} \i\c{PAVEB}: MMX Packed Average
10614 \c PAVEB mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 50 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
10616 \c{PAVEB}, specific to the Cyrix MMX extensions, treats its two
10617 operands as vectors of eight unsigned bytes, and calculates the
10618 average of the corresponding bytes in the operands. The resulting
10619 vector of eight averages is stored in the first operand.
10621 This opcode maps to \c{MOVMSKPS r32, xmm} on processors that support
10622 the SSE instruction set.
10625 \S{insPAVGB} \i\c{PAVGB} \i\c{PAVGW}: Average Packed Integers
10627 \c PAVGB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F E0 /r [KATMAI,MMX]
10628 \c PAVGW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F E3 /r [KATMAI,MMX,SM]
10630 \c PAVGB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F E0 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10631 \c PAVGW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F E3 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10633 \c{PAVGB} and \c{PAVGW} add the unsigned data elements of the source
10634 operand to the unsigned data elements of the destination register,
10635 then adds 1 to the temporary results. The results of the add are then
10636 each independently right-shifted by one bit position. The high order
10637 bits of each element are filled with the carry bits of the corresponding
10640 \b \c{PAVGB} operates on packed unsigned bytes, and
10642 \b \c{PAVGW} operates on packed unsigned words.
10645 \S{insPAVGUSB} \i\c{PAVGUSB}: Average of unsigned packed 8-bit values
10647 \c PAVGUSB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r BF [PENT,3DNOW]
10649 \c{PAVGUSB} adds the unsigned data elements of the source operand to
10650 the unsigned data elements of the destination register, then adds 1
10651 to the temporary results. The results of the add are then each
10652 independently right-shifted by one bit position. The high order bits
10653 of each element are filled with the carry bits of the corresponding
10656 This instruction performs exactly the same operations as the \c{PAVGB}
10657 \c{MMX} instruction (\k{insPAVGB}).
10660 \S{insPCMPEQB} \i\c{PCMPxx}: Compare Packed Integers.
10662 \c PCMPEQB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 74 /r [PENT,MMX]
10663 \c PCMPEQW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 75 /r [PENT,MMX]
10664 \c PCMPEQD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 76 /r [PENT,MMX]
10666 \c PCMPGTB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 64 /r [PENT,MMX]
10667 \c PCMPGTW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 65 /r [PENT,MMX]
10668 \c PCMPGTD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 66 /r [PENT,MMX]
10670 \c PCMPEQB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 74 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10671 \c PCMPEQW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 75 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10672 \c PCMPEQD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 76 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10674 \c PCMPGTB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 64 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10675 \c PCMPGTW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 65 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10676 \c PCMPGTD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 66 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10678 The \c{PCMPxx} instructions all treat their operands as vectors of
10679 bytes, words, or doublewords; corresponding elements of the source
10680 and destination are compared, and the corresponding element of the
10681 destination (first) operand is set to all zeros or all ones
10682 depending on the result of the comparison.
10684 \b \c{PCMPxxB} treats the operands as vectors of bytes;
10686 \b \c{PCMPxxW} treats the operands as vectors of words;
10688 \b \c{PCMPxxD} treats the operands as vectors of doublewords;
10690 \b \c{PCMPEQx} sets the corresponding element of the destination
10691 operand to all ones if the two elements compared are equal;
10693 \b \c{PCMPGTx} sets the destination element to all ones if the element
10694 of the first (destination) operand is greater (treated as a signed
10695 integer) than that of the second (source) operand.
10698 \S{insPDISTIB} \i\c{PDISTIB}: MMX Packed Distance and Accumulate
10699 with Implied Register
10701 \c PDISTIB mm,m64 ; 0F 54 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
10703 \c{PDISTIB}, specific to the Cyrix MMX extensions, treats its two
10704 input operands as vectors of eight unsigned bytes. For each byte
10705 position, it finds the absolute difference between the bytes in that
10706 position in the two input operands, and adds that value to the byte
10707 in the same position in the implied output register. The addition is
10708 saturated to an unsigned byte in the same way as \c{PADDUSB}.
10710 To work out the implied register, invert the lowest bit in the register
10711 number. So \c{PDISTIB MM0,M64} would put the result in \c{MM1}, but
10712 \c{PDISTIB MM1,M64} would put the result in \c{MM0}.
10714 Note that \c{PDISTIB} cannot take a register as its second source
10719 \c dstI[0-7] := dstI[0-7] + ABS(src0[0-7] - src1[0-7]),
10720 \c dstI[8-15] := dstI[8-15] + ABS(src0[8-15] - src1[8-15]),
10723 \c dstI[56-63] := dstI[56-63] + ABS(src0[56-63] - src1[56-63]).
10726 \S{insPEXTRW} \i\c{PEXTRW}: Extract Word
10728 \c PEXTRW reg32,mm,imm8 ; 0F C5 /r ib [KATMAI,MMX]
10729 \c PEXTRW reg32,xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F C5 /r ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10731 \c{PEXTRW} moves the word in the source register (second operand)
10732 that is pointed to by the count operand (third operand), into the
10733 lower half of a 32-bit general purpose register. The upper half of
10734 the register is cleared to all 0s.
10736 When the source operand is an \c{MMX} register, the two least
10737 significant bits of the count specify the source word. When it is
10738 an \c{SSE} register, the three least significant bits specify the
10742 \S{insPF2ID} \i\c{PF2ID}: Packed Single-Precision FP to Integer Convert
10744 \c PF2ID mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 1D [PENT,3DNOW]
10746 \c{PF2ID} converts two single-precision FP values in the source operand
10747 to signed 32-bit integers, using truncation, and stores them in the
10748 destination operand. Source values that are outside the range supported
10749 by the destination are saturated to the largest absolute value of the
10753 \S{insPF2IW} \i\c{PF2IW}: Packed Single-Precision FP to Integer Word Convert
10755 \c PF2IW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 1C [PENT,3DNOW]
10757 \c{PF2IW} converts two single-precision FP values in the source operand
10758 to signed 16-bit integers, using truncation, and stores them in the
10759 destination operand. Source values that are outside the range supported
10760 by the destination are saturated to the largest absolute value of the
10763 \b In the K6-2 and K6-III, the 16-bit value is zero-extended to 32-bits
10766 \b In the K6-2+, K6-III+ and Athlon processors, the value is sign-extended
10767 to 32-bits before storing.
10770 \S{insPFACC} \i\c{PFACC}: Packed Single-Precision FP Accumulate
10772 \c PFACC mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r AE [PENT,3DNOW]
10774 \c{PFACC} adds the two single-precision FP values from the destination
10775 operand together, then adds the two single-precision FP values from the
10776 source operand, and places the results in the low and high doublewords
10777 of the destination operand.
10781 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] + dst[32-63],
10782 \c dst[32-63] := src[0-31] + src[32-63].
10785 \S{insPFADD} \i\c{PFADD}: Packed Single-Precision FP Addition
10787 \c PFADD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 9E [PENT,3DNOW]
10789 \c{PFADD} performs addition on each of two packed single-precision
10792 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] + src[0-31],
10793 \c dst[32-63] := dst[32-63] + src[32-63].
10796 \S{insPFCMP} \i\c{PFCMPxx}: Packed Single-Precision FP Compare
10797 \I\c{PFCMPEQ} \I\c{PFCMPGE} \I\c{PFCMPGT}
10799 \c PFCMPEQ mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r B0 [PENT,3DNOW]
10800 \c PFCMPGE mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 90 [PENT,3DNOW]
10801 \c PFCMPGT mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r A0 [PENT,3DNOW]
10803 The \c{PFCMPxx} instructions compare the packed single-point FP values
10804 in the source and destination operands, and set the destination
10805 according to the result. If the condition is true, the destination is
10806 set to all 1s, otherwise it's set to all 0s.
10808 \b \c{PFCMPEQ} tests whether dst == src;
10810 \b \c{PFCMPGE} tests whether dst >= src;
10812 \b \c{PFCMPGT} tests whether dst > src.
10815 \S{insPFMAX} \i\c{PFMAX}: Packed Single-Precision FP Maximum
10817 \c PFMAX mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r A4 [PENT,3DNOW]
10819 \c{PFMAX} returns the higher of each pair of single-precision FP values.
10820 If the higher value is zero, it is returned as positive zero.
10823 \S{insPFMIN} \i\c{PFMIN}: Packed Single-Precision FP Minimum
10825 \c PFMIN mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 94 [PENT,3DNOW]
10827 \c{PFMIN} returns the lower of each pair of single-precision FP values.
10828 If the lower value is zero, it is returned as positive zero.
10831 \S{insPFMUL} \i\c{PFMUL}: Packed Single-Precision FP Multiply
10833 \c PFMUL mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r B4 [PENT,3DNOW]
10835 \c{PFMUL} returns the product of each pair of single-precision FP values.
10837 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] * src[0-31],
10838 \c dst[32-63] := dst[32-63] * src[32-63].
10841 \S{insPFNACC} \i\c{PFNACC}: Packed Single-Precision FP Negative Accumulate
10843 \c PFNACC mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 8A [PENT,3DNOW]
10845 \c{PFNACC} performs a negative accumulate of the two single-precision
10846 FP values in the source and destination registers. The result of the
10847 accumulate from the destination register is stored in the low doubleword
10848 of the destination, and the result of the source accumulate is stored in
10849 the high doubleword of the destination register.
10853 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] - dst[32-63],
10854 \c dst[32-63] := src[0-31] - src[32-63].
10857 \S{insPFPNACC} \i\c{PFPNACC}: Packed Single-Precision FP Mixed Accumulate
10859 \c PFPNACC mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 8E [PENT,3DNOW]
10861 \c{PFPNACC} performs a positive accumulate of the two single-precision
10862 FP values in the source register and a negative accumulate of the
10863 destination register. The result of the accumulate from the destination
10864 register is stored in the low doubleword of the destination, and the
10865 result of the source accumulate is stored in the high doubleword of the
10866 destination register.
10870 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] - dst[32-63],
10871 \c dst[32-63] := src[0-31] + src[32-63].
10874 \S{insPFRCP} \i\c{PFRCP}: Packed Single-Precision FP Reciprocal Approximation
10876 \c PFRCP mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 96 [PENT,3DNOW]
10878 \c{PFRCP} performs a low precision estimate of the reciprocal of the
10879 low-order single-precision FP value in the source operand, storing the
10880 result in both halves of the destination register. The result is accurate
10883 For higher precision reciprocals, this instruction should be followed by
10884 two more instructions: \c{PFRCPIT1} (\k{insPFRCPIT1}) and \c{PFRCPIT2}
10885 (\k{insPFRCPIT1}). This will result in a 24-bit accuracy. For more details,
10886 see the AMD 3DNow! technology manual.
10889 \S{insPFRCPIT1} \i\c{PFRCPIT1}: Packed Single-Precision FP Reciprocal,
10890 First Iteration Step
10892 \c PFRCPIT1 mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r A6 [PENT,3DNOW]
10894 \c{PFRCPIT1} performs the first intermediate step in the calculation of
10895 the reciprocal of a single-precision FP value. The first source value
10896 (\c{mm1} is the original value, and the second source value (\c{mm2/m64}
10897 is the result of a \c{PFRCP} instruction.
10899 For the final step in a reciprocal, returning the full 24-bit accuracy
10900 of a single-precision FP value, see \c{PFRCPIT2} (\k{insPFRCPIT2}). For
10901 more details, see the AMD 3DNow! technology manual.
10904 \S{insPFRCPIT2} \i\c{PFRCPIT2}: Packed Single-Precision FP
10905 Reciprocal/ Reciprocal Square Root, Second Iteration Step
10907 \c PFRCPIT2 mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r B6 [PENT,3DNOW]
10909 \c{PFRCPIT2} performs the second and final intermediate step in the
10910 calculation of a reciprocal or reciprocal square root, refining the
10911 values returned by the \c{PFRCP} and \c{PFRSQRT} instructions,
10914 The first source value (\c{mm1}) is the output of either a \c{PFRCPIT1}
10915 or a \c{PFRSQIT1} instruction, and the second source is the output of
10916 either the \c{PFRCP} or the \c{PFRSQRT} instruction. For more details,
10917 see the AMD 3DNow! technology manual.
10920 \S{insPFRSQIT1} \i\c{PFRSQIT1}: Packed Single-Precision FP Reciprocal
10921 Square Root, First Iteration Step
10923 \c PFRSQIT1 mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r A7 [PENT,3DNOW]
10925 \c{PFRSQIT1} performs the first intermediate step in the calculation of
10926 the reciprocal square root of a single-precision FP value. The first
10927 source value (\c{mm1} is the square of the result of a \c{PFRSQRT}
10928 instruction, and the second source value (\c{mm2/m64} is the original
10931 For the final step in a calculation, returning the full 24-bit accuracy
10932 of a single-precision FP value, see \c{PFRCPIT2} (\k{insPFRCPIT2}). For
10933 more details, see the AMD 3DNow! technology manual.
10936 \S{insPFRSQRT} \i\c{PFRSQRT}: Packed Single-Precision FP Reciprocal
10937 Square Root Approximation
10939 \c PFRSQRT mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 97 [PENT,3DNOW]
10941 \c{PFRSQRT} performs a low precision estimate of the reciprocal square
10942 root of the low-order single-precision FP value in the source operand,
10943 storing the result in both halves of the destination register. The result
10944 is accurate to 15 bits.
10946 For higher precision reciprocals, this instruction should be followed by
10947 two more instructions: \c{PFRSQIT1} (\k{insPFRSQIT1}) and \c{PFRCPIT2}
10948 (\k{insPFRCPIT1}). This will result in a 24-bit accuracy. For more details,
10949 see the AMD 3DNow! technology manual.
10952 \S{insPFSUB} \i\c{PFSUB}: Packed Single-Precision FP Subtract
10954 \c PFSUB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 9A [PENT,3DNOW]
10956 \c{PFSUB} subtracts the single-precision FP values in the source from
10957 those in the destination, and stores the result in the destination
10960 \c dst[0-31] := dst[0-31] - src[0-31],
10961 \c dst[32-63] := dst[32-63] - src[32-63].
10964 \S{insPFSUBR} \i\c{PFSUBR}: Packed Single-Precision FP Reverse Subtract
10966 \c PFSUBR mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r AA [PENT,3DNOW]
10968 \c{PFSUBR} subtracts the single-precision FP values in the destination
10969 from those in the source, and stores the result in the destination
10972 \c dst[0-31] := src[0-31] - dst[0-31],
10973 \c dst[32-63] := src[32-63] - dst[32-63].
10976 \S{insPI2FD} \i\c{PI2FD}: Packed Doubleword Integer to Single-Precision FP Convert
10978 \c PI2FD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 0D [PENT,3DNOW]
10980 \c{PF2ID} converts two signed 32-bit integers in the source operand
10981 to single-precision FP values, using truncation of significant digits,
10982 and stores them in the destination operand.
10985 \S{insPF2IW} \i\c{PF2IW}: Packed Word Integer to Single-Precision FP Convert
10987 \c PI2FW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r 0C [PENT,3DNOW]
10989 \c{PF2IW} converts two signed 16-bit integers in the source operand
10990 to single-precision FP values, and stores them in the destination
10991 operand. The input values are in the low word of each doubleword.
10994 \S{insPINSRW} \i\c{PINSRW}: Insert Word
10996 \c PINSRW mm,r16/r32/m16,imm8 ;0F C4 /r ib [KATMAI,MMX]
10997 \c PINSRW xmm,r16/r32/m16,imm8 ;66 0F C4 /r ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
10999 \c{PINSRW} loads a word from a 16-bit register (or the low half of a
11000 32-bit register), or from memory, and loads it to the word position
11001 in the destination register, pointed at by the count operand (third
11002 operand). If the destination is an \c{MMX} register, the low two bits
11003 of the count byte are used, if it is an \c{XMM} register the low 3
11004 bits are used. The insertion is done in such a way that the other
11005 words from the destination register are left untouched.
11008 \S{insPMACHRIW} \i\c{PMACHRIW}: Packed Multiply and Accumulate with Rounding
11010 \c PMACHRIW mm,m64 ; 0F 5E /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11012 \c{PMACHRIW} takes two packed 16-bit integer inputs, multiplies the
11013 values in the inputs, rounds on bit 15 of each result, then adds bits
11014 15-30 of each result to the corresponding position of the \e{implied}
11015 destination register.
11017 The operation of this instruction is:
11019 \c dstI[0-15] := dstI[0-15] + (mm[0-15] *m64[0-15]
11020 \c + 0x00004000)[15-30],
11021 \c dstI[16-31] := dstI[16-31] + (mm[16-31]*m64[16-31]
11022 \c + 0x00004000)[15-30],
11023 \c dstI[32-47] := dstI[32-47] + (mm[32-47]*m64[32-47]
11024 \c + 0x00004000)[15-30],
11025 \c dstI[48-63] := dstI[48-63] + (mm[48-63]*m64[48-63]
11026 \c + 0x00004000)[15-30].
11028 Note that \c{PMACHRIW} cannot take a register as its second source
11032 \S{insPMADDWD} \i\c{PMADDWD}: MMX Packed Multiply and Add
11034 \c PMADDWD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F F5 /r [PENT,MMX]
11035 \c PMADDWD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F F5 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11037 \c{PMADDWD} treats its two inputs as vectors of signed words. It
11038 multiplies corresponding elements of the two operands, giving doubleword
11039 results. These are then added together in pairs and stored in the
11040 destination operand.
11042 The operation of this instruction is:
11044 \c dst[0-31] := (dst[0-15] * src[0-15])
11045 \c + (dst[16-31] * src[16-31]);
11046 \c dst[32-63] := (dst[32-47] * src[32-47])
11047 \c + (dst[48-63] * src[48-63]);
11049 The following apply to the \c{SSE} version of the instruction:
11051 \c dst[64-95] := (dst[64-79] * src[64-79])
11052 \c + (dst[80-95] * src[80-95]);
11053 \c dst[96-127] := (dst[96-111] * src[96-111])
11054 \c + (dst[112-127] * src[112-127]).
11057 \S{insPMAGW} \i\c{PMAGW}: MMX Packed Magnitude
11059 \c PMAGW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 52 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11061 \c{PMAGW}, specific to the Cyrix MMX extensions, treats both its
11062 operands as vectors of four signed words. It compares the absolute
11063 values of the words in corresponding positions, and sets each word
11064 of the destination (first) operand to whichever of the two words in
11065 that position had the larger absolute value.
11068 \S{insPMAXSW} \i\c{PMAXSW}: Packed Signed Integer Word Maximum
11070 \c PMAXSW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F EE /r [KATMAI,MMX]
11071 \c PMAXSW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F EE /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11073 \c{PMAXSW} compares each pair of words in the two source operands, and
11074 for each pair it stores the maximum value in the destination register.
11077 \S{insPMAXUB} \i\c{PMAXUB}: Packed Unsigned Integer Byte Maximum
11079 \c PMAXUB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F DE /r [KATMAI,MMX]
11080 \c PMAXUB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F DE /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11082 \c{PMAXUB} compares each pair of bytes in the two source operands, and
11083 for each pair it stores the maximum value in the destination register.
11086 \S{insPMINSW} \i\c{PMINSW}: Packed Signed Integer Word Minimum
11088 \c PMINSW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F EA /r [KATMAI,MMX]
11089 \c PMINSW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F EA /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11091 \c{PMINSW} compares each pair of words in the two source operands, and
11092 for each pair it stores the minimum value in the destination register.
11095 \S{insPMINUB} \i\c{PMINUB}: Packed Unsigned Integer Byte Minimum
11097 \c PMINUB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F DA /r [KATMAI,MMX]
11098 \c PMINUB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F DA /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11100 \c{PMINUB} compares each pair of bytes in the two source operands, and
11101 for each pair it stores the minimum value in the destination register.
11104 \S{insPMOVMSKB} \i\c{PMOVMSKB}: Move Byte Mask To Integer
11106 \c PMOVMSKB reg32,mm ; 0F D7 /r [KATMAI,MMX]
11107 \c PMOVMSKB reg32,xmm ; 66 0F D7 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11109 \c{PMOVMSKB} returns an 8-bit or 16-bit mask formed of the most
11110 significant bits of each byte of source operand (8-bits for an
11111 \c{MMX} register, 16-bits for an \c{XMM} register).
11114 \S{insPMULHRW} \i\c{PMULHRWC}, \i\c{PMULHRIW}: Multiply Packed 16-bit Integers
11115 With Rounding, and Store High Word
11117 \c PMULHRWC mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 59 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11118 \c PMULHRIW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 5D /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11120 These instructions take two packed 16-bit integer inputs, multiply the
11121 values in the inputs, round on bit 15 of each result, then store bits
11122 15-30 of each result to the corresponding position of the destination
11125 \b For \c{PMULHRWC}, the destination is the first source operand.
11127 \b For \c{PMULHRIW}, the destination is an implied register (worked out
11128 as described for \c{PADDSIW} (\k{insPADDSIW})).
11130 The operation of this instruction is:
11132 \c dst[0-15] := (src1[0-15] *src2[0-15] + 0x00004000)[15-30]
11133 \c dst[16-31] := (src1[16-31]*src2[16-31] + 0x00004000)[15-30]
11134 \c dst[32-47] := (src1[32-47]*src2[32-47] + 0x00004000)[15-30]
11135 \c dst[48-63] := (src1[48-63]*src2[48-63] + 0x00004000)[15-30]
11137 See also \c{PMULHRWA} (\k{insPMULHRWA}) for a 3DNow! version of this
11141 \S{insPMULHRWA} \i\c{PMULHRWA}: Multiply Packed 16-bit Integers
11142 With Rounding, and Store High Word
11144 \c PMULHRWA mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r B7 [PENT,3DNOW]
11146 \c{PMULHRWA} takes two packed 16-bit integer inputs, multiplies
11147 the values in the inputs, rounds on bit 16 of each result, then
11148 stores bits 16-31 of each result to the corresponding position
11149 of the destination register.
11151 The operation of this instruction is:
11153 \c dst[0-15] := (src1[0-15] *src2[0-15] + 0x00008000)[16-31];
11154 \c dst[16-31] := (src1[16-31]*src2[16-31] + 0x00008000)[16-31];
11155 \c dst[32-47] := (src1[32-47]*src2[32-47] + 0x00008000)[16-31];
11156 \c dst[48-63] := (src1[48-63]*src2[48-63] + 0x00008000)[16-31].
11158 See also \c{PMULHRWC} (\k{insPMULHRW}) for a Cyrix version of this
11162 \S{insPMULHUW} \i\c{PMULHUW}: Multiply Packed 16-bit Integers,
11163 and Store High Word
11165 \c PMULHUW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F E4 /r [KATMAI,MMX]
11166 \c PMULHUW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F E4 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11168 \c{PMULHUW} takes two packed unsigned 16-bit integer inputs, multiplies
11169 the values in the inputs, then stores bits 16-31 of each result to the
11170 corresponding position of the destination register.
11173 \S{insPMULHW} \i\c{PMULHW}, \i\c{PMULLW}: Multiply Packed 16-bit Integers,
11176 \c PMULHW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F E5 /r [PENT,MMX]
11177 \c PMULLW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F D5 /r [PENT,MMX]
11179 \c PMULHW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F E5 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11180 \c PMULLW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F D5 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11182 \c{PMULxW} takes two packed unsigned 16-bit integer inputs, and
11183 multiplies the values in the inputs, forming doubleword results.
11185 \b \c{PMULHW} then stores the top 16 bits of each doubleword in the
11186 destination (first) operand;
11188 \b \c{PMULLW} stores the bottom 16 bits of each doubleword in the
11189 destination operand.
11192 \S{insPMULUDQ} \i\c{PMULUDQ}: Multiply Packed Unsigned
11193 32-bit Integers, and Store.
11195 \c PMULUDQ mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F F4 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11196 \c PMULUDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F F4 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11198 \c{PMULUDQ} takes two packed unsigned 32-bit integer inputs, and
11199 multiplies the values in the inputs, forming quadword results. The
11200 source is either an unsigned doubleword in the low doubleword of a
11201 64-bit operand, or it's two unsigned doublewords in the first and
11202 third doublewords of a 128-bit operand. This produces either one or
11203 two 64-bit results, which are stored in the respective quadword
11204 locations of the destination register.
11208 \c dst[0-63] := dst[0-31] * src[0-31];
11209 \c dst[64-127] := dst[64-95] * src[64-95].
11212 \S{insPMVccZB} \i\c{PMVccZB}: MMX Packed Conditional Move
11214 \c PMVZB mmxreg,mem64 ; 0F 58 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11215 \c PMVNZB mmxreg,mem64 ; 0F 5A /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11216 \c PMVLZB mmxreg,mem64 ; 0F 5B /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11217 \c PMVGEZB mmxreg,mem64 ; 0F 5C /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11219 These instructions, specific to the Cyrix MMX extensions, perform
11220 parallel conditional moves. The two input operands are treated as
11221 vectors of eight bytes. Each byte of the destination (first) operand
11222 is either written from the corresponding byte of the source (second)
11223 operand, or left alone, depending on the value of the byte in the
11224 \e{implied} operand (specified in the same way as \c{PADDSIW}, in
11227 \b \c{PMVZB} performs each move if the corresponding byte in the
11228 implied operand is zero;
11230 \b \c{PMVNZB} moves if the byte is non-zero;
11232 \b \c{PMVLZB} moves if the byte is less than zero;
11234 \b \c{PMVGEZB} moves if the byte is greater than or equal to zero.
11236 Note that these instructions cannot take a register as their second
11240 \S{insPOP} \i\c{POP}: Pop Data from Stack
11242 \c POP reg16 ; o16 58+r [8086]
11243 \c POP reg32 ; o32 58+r [386]
11245 \c POP r/m16 ; o16 8F /0 [8086]
11246 \c POP r/m32 ; o32 8F /0 [386]
11248 \c POP CS ; 0F [8086,UNDOC]
11249 \c POP DS ; 1F [8086]
11250 \c POP ES ; 07 [8086]
11251 \c POP SS ; 17 [8086]
11252 \c POP FS ; 0F A1 [386]
11253 \c POP GS ; 0F A9 [386]
11255 \c{POP} loads a value from the stack (from \c{[SS:SP]} or
11256 \c{[SS:ESP]}) and then increments the stack pointer.
11258 The address-size attribute of the instruction determines whether
11259 \c{SP} or \c{ESP} is used as the stack pointer: to deliberately
11260 override the default given by the \c{BITS} setting, you can use an
11261 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
11263 The operand-size attribute of the instruction determines whether the
11264 stack pointer is incremented by 2 or 4: this means that segment
11265 register pops in \c{BITS 32} mode will pop 4 bytes off the stack and
11266 discard the upper two of them. If you need to override that, you can
11267 use an \i\c{o16} or \i\c{o32} prefix.
11269 The above opcode listings give two forms for general-purpose
11270 register pop instructions: for example, \c{POP BX} has the two forms
11271 \c{5B} and \c{8F C3}. NASM will always generate the shorter form
11272 when given \c{POP BX}. NDISASM will disassemble both.
11274 \c{POP CS} is not a documented instruction, and is not supported on
11275 any processor above the 8086 (since they use \c{0Fh} as an opcode
11276 prefix for instruction set extensions). However, at least some 8086
11277 processors do support it, and so NASM generates it for completeness.
11280 \S{insPOPA} \i\c{POPAx}: Pop All General-Purpose Registers
11283 \c POPAW ; o16 61 [186]
11284 \c POPAD ; o32 61 [386]
11286 \b \c{POPAW} pops a word from the stack into each of, successively,
11287 \c{DI}, \c{SI}, \c{BP}, nothing (it discards a word from the stack
11288 which was a placeholder for \c{SP}), \c{BX}, \c{DX}, \c{CX} and
11289 \c{AX}. It is intended to reverse the operation of \c{PUSHAW} (see
11290 \k{insPUSHA}), but it ignores the value for \c{SP} that was pushed
11291 on the stack by \c{PUSHAW}.
11293 \b \c{POPAD} pops twice as much data, and places the results in
11294 \c{EDI}, \c{ESI}, \c{EBP}, nothing (placeholder for \c{ESP}),
11295 \c{EBX}, \c{EDX}, \c{ECX} and \c{EAX}. It reverses the operation of
11298 \c{POPA} is an alias mnemonic for either \c{POPAW} or \c{POPAD},
11299 depending on the current \c{BITS} setting.
11301 Note that the registers are popped in reverse order of their numeric
11302 values in opcodes (see \k{iref-rv}).
11305 \S{insPOPF} \i\c{POPFx}: Pop Flags Register
11307 \c POPF ; 9D [8086]
11308 \c POPFW ; o16 9D [8086]
11309 \c POPFD ; o32 9D [386]
11311 \b \c{POPFW} pops a word from the stack and stores it in the bottom 16
11312 bits of the flags register (or the whole flags register, on
11313 processors below a 386).
11315 \b \c{POPFD} pops a doubleword and stores it in the entire flags register.
11317 \c{POPF} is an alias mnemonic for either \c{POPFW} or \c{POPFD},
11318 depending on the current \c{BITS} setting.
11320 See also \c{PUSHF} (\k{insPUSHF}).
11323 \S{insPOR} \i\c{POR}: MMX Bitwise OR
11325 \c POR mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F EB /r [PENT,MMX]
11326 \c POR xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F EB /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11328 \c{POR} performs a bitwise OR operation between its two operands
11329 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if at least one of the
11330 corresponding bits of the two inputs was 1), and stores the result
11331 in the destination (first) operand.
11334 \S{insPREFETCH} \i\c{PREFETCH}: Prefetch Data Into Caches
11336 \c PREFETCH mem8 ; 0F 0D /0 [PENT,3DNOW]
11337 \c PREFETCHW mem8 ; 0F 0D /1 [PENT,3DNOW]
11339 \c{PREFETCH} and \c{PREFETCHW} fetch the line of data from memory that
11340 contains the specified byte. \c{PREFETCHW} performs differently on the
11341 Athlon to earlier processors.
11343 For more details, see the 3DNow! Technology Manual.
11346 \S{insPREFETCHh} \i\c{PREFETCHh}: Prefetch Data Into Caches
11347 \I\c{PREFETCHNTA} \I\c{PREFETCHT0} \I\c{PREFETCHT1} \I\c{PREFETCHT2}
11349 \c PREFETCHNTA m8 ; 0F 18 /0 [KATMAI]
11350 \c PREFETCHT0 m8 ; 0F 18 /1 [KATMAI]
11351 \c PREFETCHT1 m8 ; 0F 18 /2 [KATMAI]
11352 \c PREFETCHT2 m8 ; 0F 18 /3 [KATMAI]
11354 The \c{PREFETCHh} instructions fetch the line of data from memory
11355 that contains the specified byte. It is placed in the cache
11356 according to rules specified by locality hints \c{h}:
11360 \b \c{T0} (temporal data) - prefetch data into all levels of the
11363 \b \c{T1} (temporal data with respect to first level cache) -
11364 prefetch data into level 2 cache and higher.
11366 \b \c{T2} (temporal data with respect to second level cache) -
11367 prefetch data into level 2 cache and higher.
11369 \b \c{NTA} (non-temporal data with respect to all cache levels) -
11370 prefetch data into non-temporal cache structure and into a
11371 location close to the processor, minimizing cache pollution.
11373 Note that this group of instructions doesn't provide a guarantee
11374 that the data will be in the cache when it is needed. For more
11375 details, see the Intel IA32 Software Developer Manual, Volume 2.
11378 \S{insPSADBW} \i\c{PSADBW}: Packed Sum of Absolute Differences
11380 \c PSADBW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F F6 /r [KATMAI,MMX]
11381 \c PSADBW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F F6 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11383 \c{PSADBW} The PSADBW instruction computes the absolute value of the
11384 difference of the packed unsigned bytes in the two source operands.
11385 These differences are then summed to produce a word result in the lower
11386 16-bit field of the destination register; the rest of the register is
11387 cleared. The destination operand is an \c{MMX} or an \c{XMM} register.
11388 The source operand can either be a register or a memory operand.
11391 \S{insPSHUFD} \i\c{PSHUFD}: Shuffle Packed Doublewords
11393 \c PSHUFD xmm1,xmm2/m128,imm8 ; 66 0F 70 /r ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11395 \c{PSHUFD} shuffles the doublewords in the source (second) operand
11396 according to the encoding specified by imm8, and stores the result
11397 in the destination (first) operand.
11399 Bits 0 and 1 of imm8 encode the source position of the doubleword to
11400 be copied to position 0 in the destination operand. Bits 2 and 3
11401 encode for position 1, bits 4 and 5 encode for position 2, and bits
11402 6 and 7 encode for position 3. For example, an encoding of 10 in
11403 bits 0 and 1 of imm8 indicates that the doubleword at bits 64-95 of
11404 the source operand will be copied to bits 0-31 of the destination.
11407 \S{insPSHUFHW} \i\c{PSHUFHW}: Shuffle Packed High Words
11409 \c PSHUFHW xmm1,xmm2/m128,imm8 ; F3 0F 70 /r ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11411 \c{PSHUFW} shuffles the words in the high quadword of the source
11412 (second) operand according to the encoding specified by imm8, and
11413 stores the result in the high quadword of the destination (first)
11416 The operation of this instruction is similar to the \c{PSHUFW}
11417 instruction, except that the source and destination are the top
11418 quadword of a 128-bit operand, instead of being 64-bit operands.
11419 The low quadword is copied from the source to the destination
11420 without any changes.
11423 \S{insPSHUFLW} \i\c{PSHUFLW}: Shuffle Packed Low Words
11425 \c PSHUFLW xmm1,xmm2/m128,imm8 ; F2 0F 70 /r ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11427 \c{PSHUFLW} shuffles the words in the low quadword of the source
11428 (second) operand according to the encoding specified by imm8, and
11429 stores the result in the low quadword of the destination (first)
11432 The operation of this instruction is similar to the \c{PSHUFW}
11433 instruction, except that the source and destination are the low
11434 quadword of a 128-bit operand, instead of being 64-bit operands.
11435 The high quadword is copied from the source to the destination
11436 without any changes.
11439 \S{insPSHUFW} \i\c{PSHUFW}: Shuffle Packed Words
11441 \c PSHUFW mm1,mm2/m64,imm8 ; 0F 70 /r ib [KATMAI,MMX]
11443 \c{PSHUFW} shuffles the words in the source (second) operand
11444 according to the encoding specified by imm8, and stores the result
11445 in the destination (first) operand.
11447 Bits 0 and 1 of imm8 encode the source position of the word to be
11448 copied to position 0 in the destination operand. Bits 2 and 3 encode
11449 for position 1, bits 4 and 5 encode for position 2, and bits 6 and 7
11450 encode for position 3. For example, an encoding of 10 in bits 0 and 1
11451 of imm8 indicates that the word at bits 32-47 of the source operand
11452 will be copied to bits 0-15 of the destination.
11455 \S{insPSLLD} \i\c{PSLLx}: Packed Data Bit Shift Left Logical
11457 \c PSLLW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F F1 /r [PENT,MMX]
11458 \c PSLLW mm,imm8 ; 0F 71 /6 ib [PENT,MMX]
11460 \c PSLLW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F F1 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11461 \c PSLLW xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F 71 /6 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11463 \c PSLLD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F F2 /r [PENT,MMX]
11464 \c PSLLD mm,imm8 ; 0F 72 /6 ib [PENT,MMX]
11466 \c PSLLD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F F2 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11467 \c PSLLD xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F 72 /6 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11469 \c PSLLQ mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F F3 /r [PENT,MMX]
11470 \c PSLLQ mm,imm8 ; 0F 73 /6 ib [PENT,MMX]
11472 \c PSLLQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F F3 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11473 \c PSLLQ xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F 73 /6 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11475 \c PSLLDQ xmm1,imm8 ; 66 0F 73 /7 ib [PENT,MMX]
11477 \c{PSLLx} performs logical left shifts of the data elements in the
11478 destination (first) operand, moving each bit in the separate elements
11479 left by the number of bits specified in the source (second) operand,
11480 clearing the low-order bits as they are vacated.
11482 \b \c{PSLLW} shifts word sized elements.
11484 \b \c{PSLLD} shifts doubleword sized elements.
11486 \b \c{PSLLQ} shifts quadword sized elements.
11488 \b \c{PSLLDQ} shifts double quadword sized elements.
11491 \S{insPSRAD} \i\c{PSRAx}: Packed Data Bit Shift Right Arithmetic
11493 \c PSRAW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F E1 /r [PENT,MMX]
11494 \c PSRAW mm,imm8 ; 0F 71 /4 ib [PENT,MMX]
11496 \c PSRAW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F E1 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11497 \c PSRAW xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F 71 /4 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11499 \c PSRAD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F E2 /r [PENT,MMX]
11500 \c PSRAD mm,imm8 ; 0F 72 /4 ib [PENT,MMX]
11502 \c PSRAD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F E2 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11503 \c PSRAD xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F 72 /4 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11505 \c{PSRAx} performs arithmetic right shifts of the data elements in the
11506 destination (first) operand, moving each bit in the separate elements
11507 right by the number of bits specified in the source (second) operand,
11508 setting the high-order bits to the value of the original sign bit.
11510 \b \c{PSRAW} shifts word sized elements.
11512 \b \c{PSRAD} shifts doubleword sized elements.
11515 \S{insPSRLD} \i\c{PSRLx}: Packed Data Bit Shift Right Logical
11517 \c PSRLW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F D1 /r [PENT,MMX]
11518 \c PSRLW mm,imm8 ; 0F 71 /2 ib [PENT,MMX]
11520 \c PSRLW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F D1 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11521 \c PSRLW xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F 71 /2 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11523 \c PSRLD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F D2 /r [PENT,MMX]
11524 \c PSRLD mm,imm8 ; 0F 72 /2 ib [PENT,MMX]
11526 \c PSRLD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F D2 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11527 \c PSRLD xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F 72 /2 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11529 \c PSRLQ mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F D3 /r [PENT,MMX]
11530 \c PSRLQ mm,imm8 ; 0F 73 /2 ib [PENT,MMX]
11532 \c PSRLQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F D3 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11533 \c PSRLQ xmm,imm8 ; 66 0F 73 /2 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11535 \c PSRLDQ xmm1,imm8 ; 66 0F 73 /3 ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11537 \c{PSRLx} performs logical right shifts of the data elements in the
11538 destination (first) operand, moving each bit in the separate elements
11539 right by the number of bits specified in the source (second) operand,
11540 clearing the high-order bits as they are vacated.
11542 \b \c{PSRLW} shifts word sized elements.
11544 \b \c{PSRLD} shifts doubleword sized elements.
11546 \b \c{PSRLQ} shifts quadword sized elements.
11548 \b \c{PSRLDQ} shifts double quadword sized elements.
11551 \S{insPSUBB} \i\c{PSUBx}: Subtract Packed Integers
11553 \c PSUBB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F F8 /r [PENT,MMX]
11554 \c PSUBW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F F9 /r [PENT,MMX]
11555 \c PSUBD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F FA /r [PENT,MMX]
11556 \c PSUBQ mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F FB /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11558 \c PSUBB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F F8 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11559 \c PSUBW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F F9 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11560 \c PSUBD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F FA /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11561 \c PSUBQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F FB /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11563 \c{PSUBx} subtracts packed integers in the source operand from those
11564 in the destination operand. It doesn't differentiate between signed
11565 and unsigned integers, and doesn't set any of the flags.
11567 \b \c{PSUBB} operates on byte sized elements.
11569 \b \c{PSUBW} operates on word sized elements.
11571 \b \c{PSUBD} operates on doubleword sized elements.
11573 \b \c{PSUBQ} operates on quadword sized elements.
11576 \S{insPSUBSB} \i\c{PSUBSxx}, \i\c{PSUBUSx}: Subtract Packed Integers With Saturation
11578 \c PSUBSB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F E8 /r [PENT,MMX]
11579 \c PSUBSW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F E9 /r [PENT,MMX]
11581 \c PSUBSB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F E8 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11582 \c PSUBSW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F E9 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11584 \c PSUBUSB mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F D8 /r [PENT,MMX]
11585 \c PSUBUSW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F D9 /r [PENT,MMX]
11587 \c PSUBUSB xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F D8 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11588 \c PSUBUSW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F D9 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11590 \c{PSUBSx} and \c{PSUBUSx} subtracts packed integers in the source
11591 operand from those in the destination operand, and use saturation for
11592 results that are outside the range supported by the destination operand.
11594 \b \c{PSUBSB} operates on signed bytes, and uses signed saturation on the
11597 \b \c{PSUBSW} operates on signed words, and uses signed saturation on the
11600 \b \c{PSUBUSB} operates on unsigned bytes, and uses signed saturation on
11603 \b \c{PSUBUSW} operates on unsigned words, and uses signed saturation on
11607 \S{insPSUBSIW} \i\c{PSUBSIW}: MMX Packed Subtract with Saturation to
11608 Implied Destination
11610 \c PSUBSIW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 55 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
11612 \c{PSUBSIW}, specific to the Cyrix extensions to the MMX instruction
11613 set, performs the same function as \c{PSUBSW}, except that the
11614 result is not placed in the register specified by the first operand,
11615 but instead in the implied destination register, specified as for
11616 \c{PADDSIW} (\k{insPADDSIW}).
11619 \S{insPSWAPD} \i\c{PSWAPD}: Swap Packed Data
11622 \c PSWAPD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 0F /r BB [PENT,3DNOW]
11624 \c{PSWAPD} swaps the packed doublewords in the source operand, and
11625 stores the result in the destination operand.
11627 In the \c{K6-2} and \c{K6-III} processors, this opcode uses the
11628 mnemonic \c{PSWAPW}, and it swaps the order of words when copying
11629 from the source to the destination.
11631 The operation in the \c{K6-2} and \c{K6-III} processors is
11633 \c dst[0-15] = src[48-63];
11634 \c dst[16-31] = src[32-47];
11635 \c dst[32-47] = src[16-31];
11636 \c dst[48-63] = src[0-15].
11638 The operation in the \c{K6-x+}, \c{ATHLON} and later processors is:
11640 \c dst[0-31] = src[32-63];
11641 \c dst[32-63] = src[0-31].
11644 \S{insPUNPCKHBW} \i\c{PUNPCKxxx}: Unpack and Interleave Data
11646 \c PUNPCKHBW mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 68 /r [PENT,MMX]
11647 \c PUNPCKHWD mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 69 /r [PENT,MMX]
11648 \c PUNPCKHDQ mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F 6A /r [PENT,MMX]
11650 \c PUNPCKHBW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 68 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11651 \c PUNPCKHWD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 69 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11652 \c PUNPCKHDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 6A /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11653 \c PUNPCKHQDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 6D /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11655 \c PUNPCKLBW mm1,mm2/m32 ; 0F 60 /r [PENT,MMX]
11656 \c PUNPCKLWD mm1,mm2/m32 ; 0F 61 /r [PENT,MMX]
11657 \c PUNPCKLDQ mm1,mm2/m32 ; 0F 62 /r [PENT,MMX]
11659 \c PUNPCKLBW xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 60 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11660 \c PUNPCKLWD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 61 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11661 \c PUNPCKLDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 62 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11662 \c PUNPCKLQDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 6C /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11664 \c{PUNPCKxx} all treat their operands as vectors, and produce a new
11665 vector generated by interleaving elements from the two inputs. The
11666 \c{PUNPCKHxx} instructions start by throwing away the bottom half of
11667 each input operand, and the \c{PUNPCKLxx} instructions throw away
11670 The remaining elements, are then interleaved into the destination,
11671 alternating elements from the second (source) operand and the first
11672 (destination) operand: so the leftmost part of each element in the
11673 result always comes from the second operand, and the rightmost from
11676 \b \c{PUNPCKxBW} works a byte at a time, producing word sized output
11679 \b \c{PUNPCKxWD} works a word at a time, producing doubleword sized
11682 \b \c{PUNPCKxDQ} works a doubleword at a time, producing quadword sized
11685 \b \c{PUNPCKxQDQ} works a quadword at a time, producing double quadword
11686 sized output elements.
11688 So, for example, for \c{MMX} operands, if the first operand held
11689 \c{0x7A6A5A4A3A2A1A0A} and the second held \c{0x7B6B5B4B3B2B1B0B},
11692 \b \c{PUNPCKHBW} would return \c{0x7B7A6B6A5B5A4B4A}.
11694 \b \c{PUNPCKHWD} would return \c{0x7B6B7A6A5B4B5A4A}.
11696 \b \c{PUNPCKHDQ} would return \c{0x7B6B5B4B7A6A5A4A}.
11698 \b \c{PUNPCKLBW} would return \c{0x3B3A2B2A1B1A0B0A}.
11700 \b \c{PUNPCKLWD} would return \c{0x3B2B3A2A1B0B1A0A}.
11702 \b \c{PUNPCKLDQ} would return \c{0x3B2B1B0B3A2A1A0A}.
11705 \S{insPUSH} \i\c{PUSH}: Push Data on Stack
11707 \c PUSH reg16 ; o16 50+r [8086]
11708 \c PUSH reg32 ; o32 50+r [386]
11710 \c PUSH r/m16 ; o16 FF /6 [8086]
11711 \c PUSH r/m32 ; o32 FF /6 [386]
11713 \c PUSH CS ; 0E [8086]
11714 \c PUSH DS ; 1E [8086]
11715 \c PUSH ES ; 06 [8086]
11716 \c PUSH SS ; 16 [8086]
11717 \c PUSH FS ; 0F A0 [386]
11718 \c PUSH GS ; 0F A8 [386]
11720 \c PUSH imm8 ; 6A ib [186]
11721 \c PUSH imm16 ; o16 68 iw [186]
11722 \c PUSH imm32 ; o32 68 id [386]
11724 \c{PUSH} decrements the stack pointer (\c{SP} or \c{ESP}) by 2 or 4,
11725 and then stores the given value at \c{[SS:SP]} or \c{[SS:ESP]}.
11727 The address-size attribute of the instruction determines whether
11728 \c{SP} or \c{ESP} is used as the stack pointer: to deliberately
11729 override the default given by the \c{BITS} setting, you can use an
11730 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
11732 The operand-size attribute of the instruction determines whether the
11733 stack pointer is decremented by 2 or 4: this means that segment
11734 register pushes in \c{BITS 32} mode will push 4 bytes on the stack,
11735 of which the upper two are undefined. If you need to override that,
11736 you can use an \i\c{o16} or \i\c{o32} prefix.
11738 The above opcode listings give two forms for general-purpose
11739 \i{register push} instructions: for example, \c{PUSH BX} has the two
11740 forms \c{53} and \c{FF F3}. NASM will always generate the shorter
11741 form when given \c{PUSH BX}. NDISASM will disassemble both.
11743 Unlike the undocumented and barely supported \c{POP CS}, \c{PUSH CS}
11744 is a perfectly valid and sensible instruction, supported on all
11747 The instruction \c{PUSH SP} may be used to distinguish an 8086 from
11748 later processors: on an 8086, the value of \c{SP} stored is the
11749 value it has \e{after} the push instruction, whereas on later
11750 processors it is the value \e{before} the push instruction.
11753 \S{insPUSHA} \i\c{PUSHAx}: Push All General-Purpose Registers
11755 \c PUSHA ; 60 [186]
11756 \c PUSHAD ; o32 60 [386]
11757 \c PUSHAW ; o16 60 [186]
11759 \c{PUSHAW} pushes, in succession, \c{AX}, \c{CX}, \c{DX}, \c{BX},
11760 \c{SP}, \c{BP}, \c{SI} and \c{DI} on the stack, decrementing the
11761 stack pointer by a total of 16.
11763 \c{PUSHAD} pushes, in succession, \c{EAX}, \c{ECX}, \c{EDX},
11764 \c{EBX}, \c{ESP}, \c{EBP}, \c{ESI} and \c{EDI} on the stack,
11765 decrementing the stack pointer by a total of 32.
11767 In both cases, the value of \c{SP} or \c{ESP} pushed is its
11768 \e{original} value, as it had before the instruction was executed.
11770 \c{PUSHA} is an alias mnemonic for either \c{PUSHAW} or \c{PUSHAD},
11771 depending on the current \c{BITS} setting.
11773 Note that the registers are pushed in order of their numeric values
11774 in opcodes (see \k{iref-rv}).
11776 See also \c{POPA} (\k{insPOPA}).
11779 \S{insPUSHF} \i\c{PUSHFx}: Push Flags Register
11781 \c PUSHF ; 9C [8086]
11782 \c PUSHFD ; o32 9C [386]
11783 \c PUSHFW ; o16 9C [8086]
11785 \b \c{PUSHFW} pops a word from the stack and stores it in the
11786 bottom 16 bits of the flags register (or the whole flags register,
11787 on processors below a 386).
11789 \b \c{PUSHFD} pops a doubleword and stores it in the entire flags
11792 \c{PUSHF} is an alias mnemonic for either \c{PUSHFW} or \c{PUSHFD},
11793 depending on the current \c{BITS} setting.
11795 See also \c{POPF} (\k{insPOPF}).
11798 \S{insPXOR} \i\c{PXOR}: MMX Bitwise XOR
11800 \c PXOR mm1,mm2/m64 ; 0F EF /r [PENT,MMX]
11801 \c PXOR xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F EF /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
11803 \c{PXOR} performs a bitwise XOR operation between its two operands
11804 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if exactly one of the
11805 corresponding bits of the two inputs was 1), and stores the result
11806 in the destination (first) operand.
11809 \S{insRCL} \i\c{RCL}, \i\c{RCR}: Bitwise Rotate through Carry Bit
11811 \c RCL r/m8,1 ; D0 /2 [8086]
11812 \c RCL r/m8,CL ; D2 /2 [8086]
11813 \c RCL r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /2 ib [186]
11814 \c RCL r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /2 [8086]
11815 \c RCL r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /2 [8086]
11816 \c RCL r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /2 ib [186]
11817 \c RCL r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /2 [386]
11818 \c RCL r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /2 [386]
11819 \c RCL r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /2 ib [386]
11821 \c RCR r/m8,1 ; D0 /3 [8086]
11822 \c RCR r/m8,CL ; D2 /3 [8086]
11823 \c RCR r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /3 ib [186]
11824 \c RCR r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /3 [8086]
11825 \c RCR r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /3 [8086]
11826 \c RCR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /3 ib [186]
11827 \c RCR r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /3 [386]
11828 \c RCR r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /3 [386]
11829 \c RCR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /3 ib [386]
11831 \c{RCL} and \c{RCR} perform a 9-bit, 17-bit or 33-bit bitwise
11832 rotation operation, involving the given source/destination (first)
11833 operand and the carry bit. Thus, for example, in the operation
11834 \c{RCL AL,1}, a 9-bit rotation is performed in which \c{AL} is
11835 shifted left by 1, the top bit of \c{AL} moves into the carry flag,
11836 and the original value of the carry flag is placed in the low bit of
11839 The number of bits to rotate by is given by the second operand. Only
11840 the bottom five bits of the rotation count are considered by
11841 processors above the 8086.
11843 You can force the longer (286 and upwards, beginning with a \c{C1}
11844 byte) form of \c{RCL foo,1} by using a \c{BYTE} prefix: \c{RCL
11845 foo,BYTE 1}. Similarly with \c{RCR}.
11848 \S{insRCPPS} \i\c{RCPPS}: Packed Single-Precision FP Reciprocal
11850 \c RCPPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 53 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
11852 \c{RCPPS} returns an approximation of the reciprocal of the packed
11853 single-precision FP values from xmm2/m128. The maximum error for this
11854 approximation is: |Error| <= 1.5 x 2^-12
11857 \S{insRCPSS} \i\c{RCPSS}: Scalar Single-Precision FP Reciprocal
11859 \c RCPSS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; F3 0F 53 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
11861 \c{RCPSS} returns an approximation of the reciprocal of the lower
11862 single-precision FP value from xmm2/m32; the upper three fields are
11863 passed through from xmm1. The maximum error for this approximation is:
11864 |Error| <= 1.5 x 2^-12
11867 \S{insRDMSR} \i\c{RDMSR}: Read Model-Specific Registers
11869 \c RDMSR ; 0F 32 [PENT,PRIV]
11871 \c{RDMSR} reads the processor Model-Specific Register (MSR) whose
11872 index is stored in \c{ECX}, and stores the result in \c{EDX:EAX}.
11873 See also \c{WRMSR} (\k{insWRMSR}).
11876 \S{insRDPMC} \i\c{RDPMC}: Read Performance-Monitoring Counters
11878 \c RDPMC ; 0F 33 [P6]
11880 \c{RDPMC} reads the processor performance-monitoring counter whose
11881 index is stored in \c{ECX}, and stores the result in \c{EDX:EAX}.
11883 This instruction is available on P6 and later processors and on MMX
11887 \S{insRDSHR} \i\c{RDSHR}: Read SMM Header Pointer Register
11889 \c RDSHR r/m32 ; 0F 36 /0 [386,CYRIX,SMM]
11891 \c{RDSHR} reads the contents of the SMM header pointer register and
11892 saves it to the destination operand, which can be either a 32 bit
11893 memory location or a 32 bit register.
11895 See also \c{WRSHR} (\k{insWRSHR}).
11898 \S{insRDTSC} \i\c{RDTSC}: Read Time-Stamp Counter
11900 \c RDTSC ; 0F 31 [PENT]
11902 \c{RDTSC} reads the processor's time-stamp counter into \c{EDX:EAX}.
11905 \S{insRET} \i\c{RET}, \i\c{RETF}, \i\c{RETN}: Return from Procedure Call
11908 \c RET imm16 ; C2 iw [8086]
11910 \c RETF ; CB [8086]
11911 \c RETF imm16 ; CA iw [8086]
11913 \c RETN ; C3 [8086]
11914 \c RETN imm16 ; C2 iw [8086]
11916 \b \c{RET}, and its exact synonym \c{RETN}, pop \c{IP} or \c{EIP} from
11917 the stack and transfer control to the new address. Optionally, if a
11918 numeric second operand is provided, they increment the stack pointer
11919 by a further \c{imm16} bytes after popping the return address.
11921 \b \c{RETF} executes a far return: after popping \c{IP}/\c{EIP}, it
11922 then pops \c{CS}, and \e{then} increments the stack pointer by the
11923 optional argument if present.
11926 \S{insROL} \i\c{ROL}, \i\c{ROR}: Bitwise Rotate
11928 \c ROL r/m8,1 ; D0 /0 [8086]
11929 \c ROL r/m8,CL ; D2 /0 [8086]
11930 \c ROL r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /0 ib [186]
11931 \c ROL r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /0 [8086]
11932 \c ROL r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /0 [8086]
11933 \c ROL r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /0 ib [186]
11934 \c ROL r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /0 [386]
11935 \c ROL r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /0 [386]
11936 \c ROL r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /0 ib [386]
11938 \c ROR r/m8,1 ; D0 /1 [8086]
11939 \c ROR r/m8,CL ; D2 /1 [8086]
11940 \c ROR r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /1 ib [186]
11941 \c ROR r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /1 [8086]
11942 \c ROR r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /1 [8086]
11943 \c ROR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /1 ib [186]
11944 \c ROR r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /1 [386]
11945 \c ROR r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /1 [386]
11946 \c ROR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /1 ib [386]
11948 \c{ROL} and \c{ROR} perform a bitwise rotation operation on the given
11949 source/destination (first) operand. Thus, for example, in the
11950 operation \c{ROL AL,1}, an 8-bit rotation is performed in which
11951 \c{AL} is shifted left by 1 and the original top bit of \c{AL} moves
11952 round into the low bit.
11954 The number of bits to rotate by is given by the second operand. Only
11955 the bottom five bits of the rotation count are considered by processors
11958 You can force the longer (286 and upwards, beginning with a \c{C1}
11959 byte) form of \c{ROL foo,1} by using a \c{BYTE} prefix: \c{ROL
11960 foo,BYTE 1}. Similarly with \c{ROR}.
11963 \S{insRSDC} \i\c{RSDC}: Restore Segment Register and Descriptor
11965 \c RSDC segreg,m80 ; 0F 79 /r [486,CYRIX,SMM]
11967 \c{RSDC} restores a segment register (DS, ES, FS, GS, or SS) from mem80,
11968 and sets up its descriptor.
11971 \S{insRSLDT} \i\c{RSLDT}: Restore Segment Register and Descriptor
11973 \c RSLDT m80 ; 0F 7B /0 [486,CYRIX,SMM]
11975 \c{RSLDT} restores the Local Descriptor Table (LDTR) from mem80.
11978 \S{insRSM} \i\c{RSM}: Resume from System-Management Mode
11980 \c RSM ; 0F AA [PENT]
11982 \c{RSM} returns the processor to its normal operating mode when it
11983 was in System-Management Mode.
11986 \S{insRSQRTPS} \i\c{RSQRTPS}: Packed Single-Precision FP Square Root Reciprocal
11988 \c RSQRTPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 52 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
11990 \c{RSQRTPS} computes the approximate reciprocals of the square
11991 roots of the packed single-precision floating-point values in the
11992 source and stores the results in xmm1. The maximum error for this
11993 approximation is: |Error| <= 1.5 x 2^-12
11996 \S{insRSQRTSS} \i\c{RSQRTSS}: Scalar Single-Precision FP Square Root Reciprocal
11998 \c RSQRTSS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; F3 0F 52 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
12000 \c{RSQRTSS} returns an approximation of the reciprocal of the
12001 square root of the lowest order single-precision FP value from
12002 the source, and stores it in the low doubleword of the destination
12003 register. The upper three fields of xmm1 are preserved. The maximum
12004 error for this approximation is: |Error| <= 1.5 x 2^-12
12007 \S{insRSTS} \i\c{RSTS}: Restore TSR and Descriptor
12009 \c RSTS m80 ; 0F 7D /0 [486,CYRIX,SMM]
12011 \c{RSTS} restores Task State Register (TSR) from mem80.
12014 \S{insSAHF} \i\c{SAHF}: Store AH to Flags
12016 \c SAHF ; 9E [8086]
12018 \c{SAHF} sets the low byte of the flags word according to the
12019 contents of the \c{AH} register.
12021 The operation of \c{SAHF} is:
12023 \c AH --> SF:ZF:0:AF:0:PF:1:CF
12025 See also \c{LAHF} (\k{insLAHF}).
12028 \S{insSAL} \i\c{SAL}, \i\c{SAR}: Bitwise Arithmetic Shifts
12030 \c SAL r/m8,1 ; D0 /4 [8086]
12031 \c SAL r/m8,CL ; D2 /4 [8086]
12032 \c SAL r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /4 ib [186]
12033 \c SAL r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /4 [8086]
12034 \c SAL r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /4 [8086]
12035 \c SAL r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /4 ib [186]
12036 \c SAL r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /4 [386]
12037 \c SAL r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /4 [386]
12038 \c SAL r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /4 ib [386]
12040 \c SAR r/m8,1 ; D0 /7 [8086]
12041 \c SAR r/m8,CL ; D2 /7 [8086]
12042 \c SAR r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /7 ib [186]
12043 \c SAR r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /7 [8086]
12044 \c SAR r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /7 [8086]
12045 \c SAR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /7 ib [186]
12046 \c SAR r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /7 [386]
12047 \c SAR r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /7 [386]
12048 \c SAR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /7 ib [386]
12050 \c{SAL} and \c{SAR} perform an arithmetic shift operation on the given
12051 source/destination (first) operand. The vacated bits are filled with
12052 zero for \c{SAL}, and with copies of the original high bit of the
12053 source operand for \c{SAR}.
12055 \c{SAL} is a synonym for \c{SHL} (see \k{insSHL}). NASM will
12056 assemble either one to the same code, but NDISASM will always
12057 disassemble that code as \c{SHL}.
12059 The number of bits to shift by is given by the second operand. Only
12060 the bottom five bits of the shift count are considered by processors
12063 You can force the longer (286 and upwards, beginning with a \c{C1}
12064 byte) form of \c{SAL foo,1} by using a \c{BYTE} prefix: \c{SAL
12065 foo,BYTE 1}. Similarly with \c{SAR}.
12068 \S{insSALC} \i\c{SALC}: Set AL from Carry Flag
12070 \c SALC ; D6 [8086,UNDOC]
12072 \c{SALC} is an early undocumented instruction similar in concept to
12073 \c{SETcc} (\k{insSETcc}). Its function is to set \c{AL} to zero if
12074 the carry flag is clear, or to \c{0xFF} if it is set.
12077 \S{insSBB} \i\c{SBB}: Subtract with Borrow
12079 \c SBB r/m8,reg8 ; 18 /r [8086]
12080 \c SBB r/m16,reg16 ; o16 19 /r [8086]
12081 \c SBB r/m32,reg32 ; o32 19 /r [386]
12083 \c SBB reg8,r/m8 ; 1A /r [8086]
12084 \c SBB reg16,r/m16 ; o16 1B /r [8086]
12085 \c SBB reg32,r/m32 ; o32 1B /r [386]
12087 \c SBB r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /3 ib [8086]
12088 \c SBB r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /3 iw [8086]
12089 \c SBB r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /3 id [386]
12091 \c SBB r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /3 ib [8086]
12092 \c SBB r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /3 ib [386]
12094 \c SBB AL,imm8 ; 1C ib [8086]
12095 \c SBB AX,imm16 ; o16 1D iw [8086]
12096 \c SBB EAX,imm32 ; o32 1D id [386]
12098 \c{SBB} performs integer subtraction: it subtracts its second
12099 operand, plus the value of the carry flag, from its first, and
12100 leaves the result in its destination (first) operand. The flags are
12101 set according to the result of the operation: in particular, the
12102 carry flag is affected and can be used by a subsequent \c{SBB}
12105 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
12106 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
12107 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
12108 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
12109 form of the instruction.
12111 To subtract one number from another without also subtracting the
12112 contents of the carry flag, use \c{SUB} (\k{insSUB}).
12115 \S{insSCASB} \i\c{SCASB}, \i\c{SCASW}, \i\c{SCASD}: Scan String
12117 \c SCASB ; AE [8086]
12118 \c SCASW ; o16 AF [8086]
12119 \c SCASD ; o32 AF [386]
12121 \c{SCASB} compares the byte in \c{AL} with the byte at \c{[ES:DI]}
12122 or \c{[ES:EDI]}, and sets the flags accordingly. It then increments
12123 or decrements (depending on the direction flag: increments if the
12124 flag is clear, decrements if it is set) \c{DI} (or \c{EDI}).
12126 The register used is \c{DI} if the address size is 16 bits, and
12127 \c{EDI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
12128 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
12129 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
12131 Segment override prefixes have no effect for this instruction: the
12132 use of \c{ES} for the load from \c{[DI]} or \c{[EDI]} cannot be
12135 \c{SCASW} and \c{SCASD} work in the same way, but they compare a
12136 word to \c{AX} or a doubleword to \c{EAX} instead of a byte to
12137 \c{AL}, and increment or decrement the addressing registers by 2 or
12140 The \c{REPE} and \c{REPNE} prefixes (equivalently, \c{REPZ} and
12141 \c{REPNZ}) may be used to repeat the instruction up to \c{CX} (or
12142 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times until the
12143 first unequal or equal byte is found.
12146 \S{insSETcc} \i\c{SETcc}: Set Register from Condition
12148 \c SETcc r/m8 ; 0F 90+cc /2 [386]
12150 \c{SETcc} sets the given 8-bit operand to zero if its condition is
12151 not satisfied, and to 1 if it is.
12154 \S{insSFENCE} \i\c{SFENCE}: Store Fence
12156 \c SFENCE ; 0F AE /7 [KATMAI]
12158 \c{SFENCE} performs a serialising operation on all writes to memory
12159 that were issued before the \c{SFENCE} instruction. This guarantees that
12160 all memory writes before the \c{SFENCE} instruction are visible before any
12161 writes after the \c{SFENCE} instruction.
12163 \c{SFENCE} is ordered respective to other \c{SFENCE} instruction, \c{MFENCE},
12164 any memory write and any other serialising instruction (such as \c{CPUID}).
12166 Weakly ordered memory types can be used to achieve higher processor
12167 performance through such techniques as out-of-order issue,
12168 write-combining, and write-collapsing. The degree to which a consumer
12169 of data recognizes or knows that the data is weakly ordered varies
12170 among applications and may be unknown to the producer of this data.
12171 The \c{SFENCE} instruction provides a performance-efficient way of
12172 insuring store ordering between routines that produce weakly-ordered
12173 results and routines that consume this data.
12175 \c{SFENCE} uses the following ModRM encoding:
12178 \c Reg/Opcode (5:3) = 111B
12179 \c R/M (2:0) = 000B
12181 All other ModRM encodings are defined to be reserved, and use
12182 of these encodings risks incompatibility with future processors.
12184 See also \c{LFENCE} (\k{insLFENCE}) and \c{MFENCE} (\k{insMFENCE}).
12187 \S{insSGDT} \i\c{SGDT}, \i\c{SIDT}, \i\c{SLDT}: Store Descriptor Table Pointers
12189 \c SGDT mem ; 0F 01 /0 [286,PRIV]
12190 \c SIDT mem ; 0F 01 /1 [286,PRIV]
12191 \c SLDT r/m16 ; 0F 00 /0 [286,PRIV]
12193 \c{SGDT} and \c{SIDT} both take a 6-byte memory area as an operand:
12194 they store the contents of the GDTR (global descriptor table
12195 register) or IDTR (interrupt descriptor table register) into that
12196 area as a 32-bit linear address and a 16-bit size limit from that
12197 area (in that order). These are the only instructions which directly
12198 use \e{linear} addresses, rather than segment/offset pairs.
12200 \c{SLDT} stores the segment selector corresponding to the LDT (local
12201 descriptor table) into the given operand.
12203 See also \c{LGDT}, \c{LIDT} and \c{LLDT} (\k{insLGDT}).
12206 \S{insSHL} \i\c{SHL}, \i\c{SHR}: Bitwise Logical Shifts
12208 \c SHL r/m8,1 ; D0 /4 [8086]
12209 \c SHL r/m8,CL ; D2 /4 [8086]
12210 \c SHL r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /4 ib [186]
12211 \c SHL r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /4 [8086]
12212 \c SHL r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /4 [8086]
12213 \c SHL r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /4 ib [186]
12214 \c SHL r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /4 [386]
12215 \c SHL r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /4 [386]
12216 \c SHL r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /4 ib [386]
12218 \c SHR r/m8,1 ; D0 /5 [8086]
12219 \c SHR r/m8,CL ; D2 /5 [8086]
12220 \c SHR r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /5 ib [186]
12221 \c SHR r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /5 [8086]
12222 \c SHR r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /5 [8086]
12223 \c SHR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /5 ib [186]
12224 \c SHR r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /5 [386]
12225 \c SHR r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /5 [386]
12226 \c SHR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /5 ib [386]
12228 \c{SHL} and \c{SHR} perform a logical shift operation on the given
12229 source/destination (first) operand. The vacated bits are filled with
12232 A synonym for \c{SHL} is \c{SAL} (see \k{insSAL}). NASM will
12233 assemble either one to the same code, but NDISASM will always
12234 disassemble that code as \c{SHL}.
12236 The number of bits to shift by is given by the second operand. Only
12237 the bottom five bits of the shift count are considered by processors
12240 You can force the longer (286 and upwards, beginning with a \c{C1}
12241 byte) form of \c{SHL foo,1} by using a \c{BYTE} prefix: \c{SHL
12242 foo,BYTE 1}. Similarly with \c{SHR}.
12245 \S{insSHLD} \i\c{SHLD}, \i\c{SHRD}: Bitwise Double-Precision Shifts
12247 \c SHLD r/m16,reg16,imm8 ; o16 0F A4 /r ib [386]
12248 \c SHLD r/m16,reg32,imm8 ; o32 0F A4 /r ib [386]
12249 \c SHLD r/m16,reg16,CL ; o16 0F A5 /r [386]
12250 \c SHLD r/m16,reg32,CL ; o32 0F A5 /r [386]
12252 \c SHRD r/m16,reg16,imm8 ; o16 0F AC /r ib [386]
12253 \c SHRD r/m32,reg32,imm8 ; o32 0F AC /r ib [386]
12254 \c SHRD r/m16,reg16,CL ; o16 0F AD /r [386]
12255 \c SHRD r/m32,reg32,CL ; o32 0F AD /r [386]
12257 \b \c{SHLD} performs a double-precision left shift. It notionally
12258 places its second operand to the right of its first, then shifts
12259 the entire bit string thus generated to the left by a number of
12260 bits specified in the third operand. It then updates only the
12261 \e{first} operand according to the result of this. The second
12262 operand is not modified.
12264 \b \c{SHRD} performs the corresponding right shift: it notionally
12265 places the second operand to the \e{left} of the first, shifts the
12266 whole bit string right, and updates only the first operand.
12268 For example, if \c{EAX} holds \c{0x01234567} and \c{EBX} holds
12269 \c{0x89ABCDEF}, then the instruction \c{SHLD EAX,EBX,4} would update
12270 \c{EAX} to hold \c{0x12345678}. Under the same conditions, \c{SHRD
12271 EAX,EBX,4} would update \c{EAX} to hold \c{0xF0123456}.
12273 The number of bits to shift by is given by the third operand. Only
12274 the bottom five bits of the shift count are considered.
12277 \S{insSHUFPD} \i\c{SHUFPD}: Shuffle Packed Double-Precision FP Values
12279 \c SHUFPD xmm1,xmm2/m128,imm8 ; 66 0F C6 /r ib [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
12281 \c{SHUFPD} moves one of the packed double-precision FP values from
12282 the destination operand into the low quadword of the destination
12283 operand; the upper quadword is generated by moving one of the
12284 double-precision FP values from the source operand into the
12285 destination. The select (third) operand selects which of the values
12286 are moved to the destination register.
12288 The select operand is an 8-bit immediate: bit 0 selects which value
12289 is moved from the destination operand to the result (where 0 selects
12290 the low quadword and 1 selects the high quadword) and bit 1 selects
12291 which value is moved from the source operand to the result.
12292 Bits 2 through 7 of the shuffle operand are reserved.
12295 \S{insSHUFPS} \i\c{SHUFPS}: Shuffle Packed Single-Precision FP Values
12297 \c SHUFPS xmm1,xmm2/m128,imm8 ; 0F C6 /r ib [KATMAI,SSE]
12299 \c{SHUFPS} moves two of the packed single-precision FP values from
12300 the destination operand into the low quadword of the destination
12301 operand; the upper quadword is generated by moving two of the
12302 single-precision FP values from the source operand into the
12303 destination. The select (third) operand selects which of the
12304 values are moved to the destination register.
12306 The select operand is an 8-bit immediate: bits 0 and 1 select the
12307 value to be moved from the destination operand the low doubleword of
12308 the result, bits 2 and 3 select the value to be moved from the
12309 destination operand the second doubleword of the result, bits 4 and
12310 5 select the value to be moved from the source operand the third
12311 doubleword of the result, and bits 6 and 7 select the value to be
12312 moved from the source operand to the high doubleword of the result.
12315 \S{insSMI} \i\c{SMI}: System Management Interrupt
12317 \c SMI ; F1 [386,UNDOC]
12319 \c{SMI} puts some AMD processors into SMM mode. It is available on some
12320 386 and 486 processors, and is only available when DR7 bit 12 is set,
12321 otherwise it generates an Int 1.
12324 \S{insSMINT} \i\c{SMINT}, \i\c{SMINTOLD}: Software SMM Entry (CYRIX)
12326 \c SMINT ; 0F 38 [PENT,CYRIX]
12327 \c SMINTOLD ; 0F 7E [486,CYRIX]
12329 \c{SMINT} puts the processor into SMM mode. The CPU state information is
12330 saved in the SMM memory header, and then execution begins at the SMM base
12333 \c{SMINTOLD} is the same as \c{SMINT}, but was the opcode used on the 486.
12335 This pair of opcodes are specific to the Cyrix and compatible range of
12336 processors (Cyrix, IBM, Via).
12339 \S{insSMSW} \i\c{SMSW}: Store Machine Status Word
12341 \c SMSW r/m16 ; 0F 01 /4 [286,PRIV]
12343 \c{SMSW} stores the bottom half of the \c{CR0} control register (or
12344 the Machine Status Word, on 286 processors) into the destination
12345 operand. See also \c{LMSW} (\k{insLMSW}).
12347 For 32-bit code, this would use the low 16-bits of the specified
12348 register (or a 16bit memory location), without needing an operand
12349 size override byte.
12352 \S{insSQRTPD} \i\c{SQRTPD}: Packed Double-Precision FP Square Root
12354 \c SQRTPD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 51 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
12356 \c{SQRTPD} calculates the square root of the packed double-precision
12357 FP value from the source operand, and stores the double-precision
12358 results in the destination register.
12361 \S{insSQRTPS} \i\c{SQRTPS}: Packed Single-Precision FP Square Root
12363 \c SQRTPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 51 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
12365 \c{SQRTPS} calculates the square root of the packed single-precision
12366 FP value from the source operand, and stores the single-precision
12367 results in the destination register.
12370 \S{insSQRTSD} \i\c{SQRTSD}: Scalar Double-Precision FP Square Root
12372 \c SQRTSD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; F2 0F 51 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
12374 \c{SQRTSD} calculates the square root of the low-order double-precision
12375 FP value from the source operand, and stores the double-precision
12376 result in the destination register. The high-quadword remains unchanged.
12379 \S{insSQRTSS} \i\c{SQRTSS}: Scalar Single-Precision FP Square Root
12381 \c SQRTSS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; F3 0F 51 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
12383 \c{SQRTSS} calculates the square root of the low-order single-precision
12384 FP value from the source operand, and stores the single-precision
12385 result in the destination register. The three high doublewords remain
12389 \S{insSTC} \i\c{STC}, \i\c{STD}, \i\c{STI}: Set Flags
12395 These instructions set various flags. \c{STC} sets the carry flag;
12396 \c{STD} sets the direction flag; and \c{STI} sets the interrupt flag
12397 (thus enabling interrupts).
12399 To clear the carry, direction, or interrupt flags, use the \c{CLC},
12400 \c{CLD} and \c{CLI} instructions (\k{insCLC}). To invert the carry
12401 flag, use \c{CMC} (\k{insCMC}).
12404 \S{insSTMXCSR} \i\c{STMXCSR}: Store Streaming SIMD Extension
12407 \c STMXCSR m32 ; 0F AE /3 [KATMAI,SSE]
12409 \c{STMXCSR} stores the contents of the \c{MXCSR} control/status
12410 register to the specified memory location. \c{MXCSR} is used to
12411 enable masked/unmasked exception handling, to set rounding modes,
12412 to set flush-to-zero mode, and to view exception status flags.
12413 The reserved bits in the \c{MXCSR} register are stored as 0s.
12415 For details of the \c{MXCSR} register, see the Intel processor docs.
12417 See also \c{LDMXCSR} (\k{insLDMXCSR}).
12420 \S{insSTOSB} \i\c{STOSB}, \i\c{STOSW}, \i\c{STOSD}: Store Byte to String
12422 \c STOSB ; AA [8086]
12423 \c STOSW ; o16 AB [8086]
12424 \c STOSD ; o32 AB [386]
12426 \c{STOSB} stores the byte in \c{AL} at \c{[ES:DI]} or \c{[ES:EDI]},
12427 and sets the flags accordingly. It then increments or decrements
12428 (depending on the direction flag: increments if the flag is clear,
12429 decrements if it is set) \c{DI} (or \c{EDI}).
12431 The register used is \c{DI} if the address size is 16 bits, and
12432 \c{EDI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
12433 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
12434 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
12436 Segment override prefixes have no effect for this instruction: the
12437 use of \c{ES} for the store to \c{[DI]} or \c{[EDI]} cannot be
12440 \c{STOSW} and \c{STOSD} work in the same way, but they store the
12441 word in \c{AX} or the doubleword in \c{EAX} instead of the byte in
12442 \c{AL}, and increment or decrement the addressing registers by 2 or
12445 The \c{REP} prefix may be used to repeat the instruction \c{CX} (or
12446 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times.
12449 \S{insSTR} \i\c{STR}: Store Task Register
12451 \c STR r/m16 ; 0F 00 /1 [286,PRIV]
12453 \c{STR} stores the segment selector corresponding to the contents of
12454 the Task Register into its operand. When the operand size is a 16-bit
12455 register, the upper 16-bits are cleared to 0s. When the destination
12456 operand is a memory location, 16 bits are written regardless of the
12460 \S{insSUB} \i\c{SUB}: Subtract Integers
12462 \c SUB r/m8,reg8 ; 28 /r [8086]
12463 \c SUB r/m16,reg16 ; o16 29 /r [8086]
12464 \c SUB r/m32,reg32 ; o32 29 /r [386]
12466 \c SUB reg8,r/m8 ; 2A /r [8086]
12467 \c SUB reg16,r/m16 ; o16 2B /r [8086]
12468 \c SUB reg32,r/m32 ; o32 2B /r [386]
12470 \c SUB r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /5 ib [8086]
12471 \c SUB r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /5 iw [8086]
12472 \c SUB r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /5 id [386]
12474 \c SUB r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /5 ib [8086]
12475 \c SUB r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /5 ib [386]
12477 \c SUB AL,imm8 ; 2C ib [8086]
12478 \c SUB AX,imm16 ; o16 2D iw [8086]
12479 \c SUB EAX,imm32 ; o32 2D id [386]
12481 \c{SUB} performs integer subtraction: it subtracts its second
12482 operand from its first, and leaves the result in its destination
12483 (first) operand. The flags are set according to the result of the
12484 operation: in particular, the carry flag is affected and can be used
12485 by a subsequent \c{SBB} instruction (\k{insSBB}).
12487 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
12488 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
12489 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
12490 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
12491 form of the instruction.
12494 \S{insSUBPD} \i\c{SUBPD}: Packed Double-Precision FP Subtract
12496 \c SUBPD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 5C /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
12498 \c{SUBPD} subtracts the packed double-precision FP values of
12499 the source operand from those of the destination operand, and
12500 stores the result in the destination operation.
12503 \S{insSUBPS} \i\c{SUBPS}: Packed Single-Precision FP Subtract
12505 \c SUBPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 5C /r [KATMAI,SSE]
12507 \c{SUBPS} subtracts the packed single-precision FP values of
12508 the source operand from those of the destination operand, and
12509 stores the result in the destination operation.
12512 \S{insSUBSD} \i\c{SUBSD}: Scalar Single-FP Subtract
12514 \c SUBSD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; F2 0F 5C /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
12516 \c{SUBSD} subtracts the low-order double-precision FP value of
12517 the source operand from that of the destination operand, and
12518 stores the result in the destination operation. The high
12519 quadword is unchanged.
12522 \S{insSUBSS} \i\c{SUBSS}: Scalar Single-FP Subtract
12524 \c SUBSS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; F3 0F 5C /r [KATMAI,SSE]
12526 \c{SUBSS} subtracts the low-order single-precision FP value of
12527 the source operand from that of the destination operand, and
12528 stores the result in the destination operation. The three high
12529 doublewords are unchanged.
12532 \S{insSVDC} \i\c{SVDC}: Save Segment Register and Descriptor
12534 \c SVDC m80,segreg ; 0F 78 /r [486,CYRIX,SMM]
12536 \c{SVDC} saves a segment register (DS, ES, FS, GS, or SS) and its
12537 descriptor to mem80.
12540 \S{insSVLDT} \i\c{SVLDT}: Save LDTR and Descriptor
12542 \c SVLDT m80 ; 0F 7A /0 [486,CYRIX,SMM]
12544 \c{SVLDT} saves the Local Descriptor Table (LDTR) to mem80.
12547 \S{insSVTS} \i\c{SVTS}: Save TSR and Descriptor
12549 \c SVTS m80 ; 0F 7C /0 [486,CYRIX,SMM]
12551 \c{SVTS} saves the Task State Register (TSR) to mem80.
12554 \S{insSYSCALL} \i\c{SYSCALL}: Call Operating System
12556 \c SYSCALL ; 0F 05 [P6,AMD]
12558 \c{SYSCALL} provides a fast method of transferring control to a fixed
12559 entry point in an operating system.
12561 \b The \c{EIP} register is copied into the \c{ECX} register.
12563 \b Bits [31-0] of the 64-bit SYSCALL/SYSRET Target Address Register
12564 (\c{STAR}) are copied into the \c{EIP} register.
12566 \b Bits [47-32] of the \c{STAR} register specify the selector that is
12567 copied into the \c{CS} register.
12569 \b Bits [47-32]+1000b of the \c{STAR} register specify the selector that
12570 is copied into the SS register.
12572 The \c{CS} and \c{SS} registers should not be modified by the operating
12573 system between the execution of the \c{SYSCALL} instruction and its
12574 corresponding \c{SYSRET} instruction.
12576 For more information, see the \c{SYSCALL and SYSRET Instruction Specification}
12577 (AMD document number 21086.pdf).
12580 \S{insSYSENTER} \i\c{SYSENTER}: Fast System Call
12582 \c SYSENTER ; 0F 34 [P6]
12584 \c{SYSENTER} executes a fast call to a level 0 system procedure or
12585 routine. Before using this instruction, various MSRs need to be set
12588 \b \c{SYSENTER_CS_MSR} contains the 32-bit segment selector for the
12589 privilege level 0 code segment. (This value is also used to compute
12590 the segment selector of the privilege level 0 stack segment.)
12592 \b \c{SYSENTER_EIP_MSR} contains the 32-bit offset into the privilege
12593 level 0 code segment to the first instruction of the selected operating
12594 procedure or routine.
12596 \b \c{SYSENTER_ESP_MSR} contains the 32-bit stack pointer for the
12597 privilege level 0 stack.
12599 \c{SYSENTER} performs the following sequence of operations:
12601 \b Loads the segment selector from the \c{SYSENTER_CS_MSR} into the
12604 \b Loads the instruction pointer from the \c{SYSENTER_EIP_MSR} into
12605 the \c{EIP} register.
12607 \b Adds 8 to the value in \c{SYSENTER_CS_MSR} and loads it into the
12610 \b Loads the stack pointer from the \c{SYSENTER_ESP_MSR} into the
12613 \b Switches to privilege level 0.
12615 \b Clears the \c{VM} flag in the \c{EFLAGS} register, if the flag
12618 \b Begins executing the selected system procedure.
12620 In particular, note that this instruction des not save the values of
12621 \c{CS} or \c{(E)IP}. If you need to return to the calling code, you
12622 need to write your code to cater for this.
12624 For more information, see the Intel Architecture Software Developer's
12628 \S{insSYSEXIT} \i\c{SYSEXIT}: Fast Return From System Call
12630 \c SYSEXIT ; 0F 35 [P6,PRIV]
12632 \c{SYSEXIT} executes a fast return to privilege level 3 user code.
12633 This instruction is a companion instruction to the \c{SYSENTER}
12634 instruction, and can only be executed by privilege level 0 code.
12635 Various registers need to be set up before calling this instruction:
12637 \b \c{SYSENTER_CS_MSR} contains the 32-bit segment selector for the
12638 privilege level 0 code segment in which the processor is currently
12639 executing. (This value is used to compute the segment selectors for
12640 the privilege level 3 code and stack segments.)
12642 \b \c{EDX} contains the 32-bit offset into the privilege level 3 code
12643 segment to the first instruction to be executed in the user code.
12645 \b \c{ECX} contains the 32-bit stack pointer for the privilege level 3
12648 \c{SYSEXIT} performs the following sequence of operations:
12650 \b Adds 16 to the value in \c{SYSENTER_CS_MSR} and loads the sum into
12651 the \c{CS} selector register.
12653 \b Loads the instruction pointer from the \c{EDX} register into the
12656 \b Adds 24 to the value in \c{SYSENTER_CS_MSR} and loads the sum
12657 into the \c{SS} selector register.
12659 \b Loads the stack pointer from the \c{ECX} register into the \c{ESP}
12662 \b Switches to privilege level 3.
12664 \b Begins executing the user code at the \c{EIP} address.
12666 For more information on the use of the \c{SYSENTER} and \c{SYSEXIT}
12667 instructions, see the Intel Architecture Software Developer's
12671 \S{insSYSRET} \i\c{SYSRET}: Return From Operating System
12673 \c SYSRET ; 0F 07 [P6,AMD,PRIV]
12675 \c{SYSRET} is the return instruction used in conjunction with the
12676 \c{SYSCALL} instruction to provide fast entry/exit to an operating system.
12678 \b The \c{ECX} register, which points to the next sequential instruction
12679 after the corresponding \c{SYSCALL} instruction, is copied into the \c{EIP}
12682 \b Bits [63-48] of the \c{STAR} register specify the selector that is copied
12683 into the \c{CS} register.
12685 \b Bits [63-48]+1000b of the \c{STAR} register specify the selector that is
12686 copied into the \c{SS} register.
12688 \b Bits [1-0] of the \c{SS} register are set to 11b (RPL of 3) regardless of
12689 the value of bits [49-48] of the \c{STAR} register.
12691 The \c{CS} and \c{SS} registers should not be modified by the operating
12692 system between the execution of the \c{SYSCALL} instruction and its
12693 corresponding \c{SYSRET} instruction.
12695 For more information, see the \c{SYSCALL and SYSRET Instruction Specification}
12696 (AMD document number 21086.pdf).
12699 \S{insTEST} \i\c{TEST}: Test Bits (notional bitwise AND)
12701 \c TEST r/m8,reg8 ; 84 /r [8086]
12702 \c TEST r/m16,reg16 ; o16 85 /r [8086]
12703 \c TEST r/m32,reg32 ; o32 85 /r [386]
12705 \c TEST r/m8,imm8 ; F6 /0 ib [8086]
12706 \c TEST r/m16,imm16 ; o16 F7 /0 iw [8086]
12707 \c TEST r/m32,imm32 ; o32 F7 /0 id [386]
12709 \c TEST AL,imm8 ; A8 ib [8086]
12710 \c TEST AX,imm16 ; o16 A9 iw [8086]
12711 \c TEST EAX,imm32 ; o32 A9 id [386]
12713 \c{TEST} performs a `mental' bitwise AND of its two operands, and
12714 affects the flags as if the operation had taken place, but does not
12715 store the result of the operation anywhere.
12718 \S{insUCOMISD} \i\c{UCOMISD}: Unordered Scalar Double-Precision FP
12719 compare and set EFLAGS
12721 \c UCOMISD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 2E /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
12723 \c{UCOMISD} compares the low-order double-precision FP numbers in the
12724 two operands, and sets the \c{ZF}, \c{PF} and \c{CF} bits in the
12725 \c{EFLAGS} register. In addition, the \c{OF}, \c{SF} and \c{AF} bits
12726 in the \c{EFLAGS} register are zeroed out. The unordered predicate
12727 (\c{ZF}, \c{PF} and \c{CF} all set) is returned if either source
12728 operand is a \c{NaN} (\c{qNaN} or \c{sNaN}).
12731 \S{insUCOMISS} \i\c{UCOMISS}: Unordered Scalar Single-Precision FP
12732 compare and set EFLAGS
12734 \c UCOMISS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 2E /r [KATMAI,SSE]
12736 \c{UCOMISS} compares the low-order single-precision FP numbers in the
12737 two operands, and sets the \c{ZF}, \c{PF} and \c{CF} bits in the
12738 \c{EFLAGS} register. In addition, the \c{OF}, \c{SF} and \c{AF} bits
12739 in the \c{EFLAGS} register are zeroed out. The unordered predicate
12740 (\c{ZF}, \c{PF} and \c{CF} all set) is returned if either source
12741 operand is a \c{NaN} (\c{qNaN} or \c{sNaN}).
12744 \S{insUD2} \i\c{UD0}, \i\c{UD1}, \i\c{UD2}: Undefined Instruction
12746 \c UD0 ; 0F FF [186,UNDOC]
12747 \c UD1 ; 0F B9 [186,UNDOC]
12748 \c UD2 ; 0F 0B [186]
12750 \c{UDx} can be used to generate an invalid opcode exception, for testing
12753 \c{UD0} is specifically documented by AMD as being reserved for this
12756 \c{UD1} is documented by Intel as being available for this purpose.
12758 \c{UD2} is specifically documented by Intel as being reserved for this
12759 purpose. Intel document this as the preferred method of generating an
12760 invalid opcode exception.
12762 All these opcodes can be used to generate invalid opcode exceptions on
12763 all currently available processors.
12766 \S{insUMOV} \i\c{UMOV}: User Move Data
12768 \c UMOV r/m8,reg8 ; 0F 10 /r [386,UNDOC]
12769 \c UMOV r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F 11 /r [386,UNDOC]
12770 \c UMOV r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F 11 /r [386,UNDOC]
12772 \c UMOV reg8,r/m8 ; 0F 12 /r [386,UNDOC]
12773 \c UMOV reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F 13 /r [386,UNDOC]
12774 \c UMOV reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F 13 /r [386,UNDOC]
12776 This undocumented instruction is used by in-circuit emulators to
12777 access user memory (as opposed to host memory). It is used just like
12778 an ordinary memory/register or register/register \c{MOV}
12779 instruction, but accesses user space.
12781 This instruction is only available on some AMD and IBM 386 and 486
12785 \S{insUNPCKHPD} \i\c{UNPCKHPD}: Unpack and Interleave High Packed
12786 Double-Precision FP Values
12788 \c UNPCKHPD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 15 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
12790 \c{UNPCKHPD} performs an interleaved unpack of the high-order data
12791 elements of the source and destination operands, saving the result
12792 in \c{xmm1}. It ignores the lower half of the sources.
12794 The operation of this instruction is:
12796 \c dst[63-0] := dst[127-64];
12797 \c dst[127-64] := src[127-64].
12800 \S{insUNPCKHPS} \i\c{UNPCKHPS}: Unpack and Interleave High Packed
12801 Single-Precision FP Values
12803 \c UNPCKHPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 15 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
12805 \c{UNPCKHPS} performs an interleaved unpack of the high-order data
12806 elements of the source and destination operands, saving the result
12807 in \c{xmm1}. It ignores the lower half of the sources.
12809 The operation of this instruction is:
12811 \c dst[31-0] := dst[95-64];
12812 \c dst[63-32] := src[95-64];
12813 \c dst[95-64] := dst[127-96];
12814 \c dst[127-96] := src[127-96].
12817 \S{insUNPCKLPD} \i\c{UNPCKLPD}: Unpack and Interleave Low Packed
12818 Double-Precision FP Data
12820 \c UNPCKLPD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 14 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
12822 \c{UNPCKLPD} performs an interleaved unpack of the low-order data
12823 elements of the source and destination operands, saving the result
12824 in \c{xmm1}. It ignores the lower half of the sources.
12826 The operation of this instruction is:
12828 \c dst[63-0] := dst[63-0];
12829 \c dst[127-64] := src[63-0].
12832 \S{insUNPCKLPS} \i\c{UNPCKLPS}: Unpack and Interleave Low Packed
12833 Single-Precision FP Data
12835 \c UNPCKLPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 14 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
12837 \c{UNPCKLPS} performs an interleaved unpack of the low-order data
12838 elements of the source and destination operands, saving the result
12839 in \c{xmm1}. It ignores the lower half of the sources.
12841 The operation of this instruction is:
12843 \c dst[31-0] := dst[31-0];
12844 \c dst[63-32] := src[31-0];
12845 \c dst[95-64] := dst[63-32];
12846 \c dst[127-96] := src[63-32].
12849 \S{insVERR} \i\c{VERR}, \i\c{VERW}: Verify Segment Readability/Writability
12851 \c VERR r/m16 ; 0F 00 /4 [286,PRIV]
12853 \c VERW r/m16 ; 0F 00 /5 [286,PRIV]
12855 \b \c{VERR} sets the zero flag if the segment specified by the selector
12856 in its operand can be read from at the current privilege level.
12857 Otherwise it is cleared.
12859 \b \c{VERW} sets the zero flag if the segment can be written.
12862 \S{insWAIT} \i\c{WAIT}: Wait for Floating-Point Processor
12864 \c WAIT ; 9B [8086]
12865 \c FWAIT ; 9B [8086]
12867 \c{WAIT}, on 8086 systems with a separate 8087 FPU, waits for the
12868 FPU to have finished any operation it is engaged in before
12869 continuing main processor operations, so that (for example) an FPU
12870 store to main memory can be guaranteed to have completed before the
12871 CPU tries to read the result back out.
12873 On higher processors, \c{WAIT} is unnecessary for this purpose, and
12874 it has the alternative purpose of ensuring that any pending unmasked
12875 FPU exceptions have happened before execution continues.
12878 \S{insWBINVD} \i\c{WBINVD}: Write Back and Invalidate Cache
12880 \c WBINVD ; 0F 09 [486]
12882 \c{WBINVD} invalidates and empties the processor's internal caches,
12883 and causes the processor to instruct external caches to do the same.
12884 It writes the contents of the caches back to memory first, so no
12885 data is lost. To flush the caches quickly without bothering to write
12886 the data back first, use \c{INVD} (\k{insINVD}).
12889 \S{insWRMSR} \i\c{WRMSR}: Write Model-Specific Registers
12891 \c WRMSR ; 0F 30 [PENT]
12893 \c{WRMSR} writes the value in \c{EDX:EAX} to the processor
12894 Model-Specific Register (MSR) whose index is stored in \c{ECX}.
12895 See also \c{RDMSR} (\k{insRDMSR}).
12898 \S{insWRSHR} \i\c{WRSHR}: Write SMM Header Pointer Register
12900 \c WRSHR r/m32 ; 0F 37 /0 [386,CYRIX,SMM]
12902 \c{WRSHR} loads the contents of either a 32-bit memory location or a
12903 32-bit register into the SMM header pointer register.
12905 See also \c{RDSHR} (\k{insRDSHR}).
12908 \S{insXADD} \i\c{XADD}: Exchange and Add
12910 \c XADD r/m8,reg8 ; 0F C0 /r [486]
12911 \c XADD r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F C1 /r [486]
12912 \c XADD r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F C1 /r [486]
12914 \c{XADD} exchanges the values in its two operands, and then adds
12915 them together and writes the result into the destination (first)
12916 operand. This instruction can be used with a \c{LOCK} prefix for
12917 multi-processor synchronisation purposes.
12920 \S{insXBTS} \i\c{XBTS}: Extract Bit String
12922 \c XBTS reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F A6 /r [386,UNDOC]
12923 \c XBTS reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F A6 /r [386,UNDOC]
12925 The implied operation of this instruction is:
12927 \c XBTS r/m16,reg16,AX,CL
12928 \c XBTS r/m32,reg32,EAX,CL
12930 Writes a bit string from the source operand to the destination. \c{CL}
12931 indicates the number of bits to be copied, and \c{(E)AX} indicates the
12932 low order bit offset in the source. The bits are written to the low
12933 order bits of the destination register. For example, if \c{CL} is set
12934 to 4 and \c{AX} (for 16-bit code) is set to 5, bits 5-8 of \c{src} will
12935 be copied to bits 0-3 of \c{dst}. This instruction is very poorly
12936 documented, and I have been unable to find any official source of
12937 documentation on it.
12939 \c{XBTS} is supported only on the early Intel 386s, and conflicts with
12940 the opcodes for \c{CMPXCHG486} (on early Intel 486s). NASM supports it
12941 only for completeness. Its counterpart is \c{IBTS} (see \k{insIBTS}).
12944 \S{insXCHG} \i\c{XCHG}: Exchange
12946 \c XCHG reg8,r/m8 ; 86 /r [8086]
12947 \c XCHG reg16,r/m8 ; o16 87 /r [8086]
12948 \c XCHG reg32,r/m32 ; o32 87 /r [386]
12950 \c XCHG r/m8,reg8 ; 86 /r [8086]
12951 \c XCHG r/m16,reg16 ; o16 87 /r [8086]
12952 \c XCHG r/m32,reg32 ; o32 87 /r [386]
12954 \c XCHG AX,reg16 ; o16 90+r [8086]
12955 \c XCHG EAX,reg32 ; o32 90+r [386]
12956 \c XCHG reg16,AX ; o16 90+r [8086]
12957 \c XCHG reg32,EAX ; o32 90+r [386]
12959 \c{XCHG} exchanges the values in its two operands. It can be used
12960 with a \c{LOCK} prefix for purposes of multi-processor
12963 \c{XCHG AX,AX} or \c{XCHG EAX,EAX} (depending on the \c{BITS}
12964 setting) generates the opcode \c{90h}, and so is a synonym for
12965 \c{NOP} (\k{insNOP}).
12968 \S{insXLATB} \i\c{XLATB}: Translate Byte in Lookup Table
12970 \c XLAT ; D7 [8086]
12971 \c XLATB ; D7 [8086]
12973 \c{XLATB} adds the value in \c{AL}, treated as an unsigned byte, to
12974 \c{BX} or \c{EBX}, and loads the byte from the resulting address (in
12975 the segment specified by \c{DS}) back into \c{AL}.
12977 The base register used is \c{BX} if the address size is 16 bits, and
12978 \c{EBX} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
12979 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
12980 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
12982 The segment register used to load from \c{[BX+AL]} or \c{[EBX+AL]}
12983 can be overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
12984 example, \c{es xlatb}).
12987 \S{insXOR} \i\c{XOR}: Bitwise Exclusive OR
12989 \c XOR r/m8,reg8 ; 30 /r [8086]
12990 \c XOR r/m16,reg16 ; o16 31 /r [8086]
12991 \c XOR r/m32,reg32 ; o32 31 /r [386]
12993 \c XOR reg8,r/m8 ; 32 /r [8086]
12994 \c XOR reg16,r/m16 ; o16 33 /r [8086]
12995 \c XOR reg32,r/m32 ; o32 33 /r [386]
12997 \c XOR r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /6 ib [8086]
12998 \c XOR r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /6 iw [8086]
12999 \c XOR r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /6 id [386]
13001 \c XOR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /6 ib [8086]
13002 \c XOR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /6 ib [386]
13004 \c XOR AL,imm8 ; 34 ib [8086]
13005 \c XOR AX,imm16 ; o16 35 iw [8086]
13006 \c XOR EAX,imm32 ; o32 35 id [386]
13008 \c{XOR} performs a bitwise XOR operation between its two operands
13009 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if exactly one of the
13010 corresponding bits of the two inputs was 1), and stores the result
13011 in the destination (first) operand.
13013 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
13014 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
13015 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
13016 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
13017 form of the instruction.
13019 The \c{MMX} instruction \c{PXOR} (see \k{insPXOR}) performs the same
13020 operation on the 64-bit \c{MMX} registers.
13023 \S{insXORPD} \i\c{XORPD}: Bitwise Logical XOR of Double-Precision FP Values
13025 \c XORPD xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 66 0F 57 /r [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]
13027 \c{XORPD} returns a bit-wise logical XOR between the source and
13028 destination operands, storing the result in the destination operand.
13031 \S{insXORPS} \i\c{XORPS}: Bitwise Logical XOR of Single-Precision FP Values
13033 \c XORPS xmm1,xmm2/m128 ; 0F 57 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
13035 \c{XORPS} returns a bit-wise logical XOR between the source and
13036 destination operands, storing the result in the destination operand.